2009-01-30 Julian Brown <julian@codesourcery.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @copying
47 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
48 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
49 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
50
51 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
52 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
53 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
54 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
55 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
56 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
57
58 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
59 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
60 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
61 @end copying
62
63 @ifnottex
64 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
65
66 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
67 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
68 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
69 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
70 @end ifset
71 Version @value{GDBVN}.
72
73 @insertcopying
74 @end ifnottex
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
82 @sp 1
83 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
84 @end ifset
85 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
86 @page
87 @tex
88 {\parskip=0pt
89 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
90 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
91 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
92 }
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
97 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
98 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
99 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
101 @insertcopying
102 @page
103 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
104 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
105 software in general. We will miss him.
106 @end titlepage
107 @page
108
109 @ifnottex
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
111
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
113
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
115
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
119 @end ifset
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Stack:: Examining the stack
138 * Source:: Examining source files
139 * Data:: Examining data
140 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
141 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
142 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
143
144 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
145
146 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
147 * Altering:: Altering execution
148 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
149 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
150 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
151 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
152 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
153 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
154 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
155 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
156 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
157 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
158 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
159
160 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
161
162 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
163 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
164 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
165 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
166 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
167 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
168 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
169 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
170 @value{GDBN}
171 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
172 the operating system
173 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
174 how you can copy and share GDB
175 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
176 * Index:: Index
177 @end menu
178
179 @end ifnottex
180
181 @contents
182
183 @node Summary
184 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
185
186 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
187 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
188 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
189
190 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
191 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
192
193 @itemize @bullet
194 @item
195 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
196
197 @item
198 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
199
200 @item
201 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
202
203 @item
204 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
205 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
206 @end itemize
207
208 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
209 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
210 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
211
212 @cindex Modula-2
213 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
214 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
215
216 @cindex Pascal
217 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
218 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
219 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
220 syntax.
221
222 @cindex Fortran
223 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
224 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
225 underscore.
226
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
228 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
229
230 @menu
231 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
232 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
233 @end menu
234
235 @node Free Software
236 @unnumberedsec Free Software
237
238 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
239 General Public License
240 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
241 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
242 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
243 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
244 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
245 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
246
247 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
248 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
249 from anyone else.
250
251 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
252
253 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
254 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
255 include with the free software. Many of our most important
256 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
257 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
258 when an important free software package does not come with a free
259 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
260 gaps today.
261
262 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
263 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
264 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
265 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
266 them from the free software world.
267
268 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
269 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
270 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
271 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
272 contract to make it non-free.
273
274 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
275 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
276 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
277 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
278 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
279 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
280 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
281
282 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
283 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
284 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
285 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
286
287 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
288 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
289 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
290 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
291 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
292 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
293 community.
294
295 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
296 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
297 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
298 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
299 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
300 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
301 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
302 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
303 of the manual.
304
305 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
306 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
307 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
308 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
309 manual to replace it.
310
311 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
312 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
313 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
314 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
315 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
316 the free software community.
317
318 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
319 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
320 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
321 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
322 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
323 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
324 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
325 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
326 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
327
328 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
329 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
330 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
331 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
332 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
333 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
334 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
335 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
336
337 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
338 published by other publishers, at
339 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
340
341 @node Contributors
342 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
343
344 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
345 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
346 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
347 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
348 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
349 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
350 blow-by-blow account.
351
352 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
353
354 @quotation
355 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
356 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
357 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
358 @end quotation
359
360 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
361 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
362 releases:
363 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
364 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
365 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
366 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
367 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
368 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
369 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
370 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
371 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
372
373 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
374 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
375
376 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
377 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
378 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
379 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
380 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
381
382 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
383 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
384 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
385
386 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
387 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
388
389 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
390
391 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
392 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
393 support.
394 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
395 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
396 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
397 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
398 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
399 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
400 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
401 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
402 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
403 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
404 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
405 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
406 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
407 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
408 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
409 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
410
411 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
412
413 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
414 libraries.
415
416 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
417 about several machine instruction sets.
418
419 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
420 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
421 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
422 and RDI targets, respectively.
423
424 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
425 command-line editing and command history.
426
427 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
428 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
429
430 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
431 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
432 symbols.
433
434 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
435 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
436
437 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
438
439 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
440 processors.
441
442 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
443
444 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
445
446 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
447
448 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
449 watchpoints.
450
451 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
452
453 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
454
455 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
456 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
457
458 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
459 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
460 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
461 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
462 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
463 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
464 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
465
466 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
467 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
468
469 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
470 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
471 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
472 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
473 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
474 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
475 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
476 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
477 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
478 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
479 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
480 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
481 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
482 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
483 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
484
485 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
486 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
487
488 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
489 Hat.
490
491 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
492 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
493 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
494 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
495 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
496 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
497
498 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
499 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
500 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
501 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
502 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
503 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
504 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
505 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
506 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
507 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
508 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
509 Weigand.
510
511 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
512 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
513 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
514 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
515
516 @node Sample Session
517 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
518
519 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
520 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
521 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
522
523 @iftex
524 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
525 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
526 @end iftex
527
528 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
529 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
530
531 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
532 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
533 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
534 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
535 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
536 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
537 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
538 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
539 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
540
541 @smallexample
542 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
543 $ @b{./m4}
544 @b{define(foo,0000)}
545
546 @b{foo}
547 0000
548 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
549
550 @b{bar}
551 0000
552 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
553
554 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
555 @b{baz}
556 @b{Ctrl-d}
557 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
558 @end smallexample
559
560 @noindent
561 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
562
563 @smallexample
564 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
565 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
566 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
567 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
568 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
569 the conditions.
570 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
571 for details.
572
573 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
574 (@value{GDBP})
575 @end smallexample
576
577 @noindent
578 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
579 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
580 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
581 that examples fit in this manual.
582
583 @smallexample
584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
589 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
590 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
591 @code{break} command.
592
593 @smallexample
594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
595 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
600 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
601 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
602
603 @smallexample
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
605 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
606 @b{define(foo,0000)}
607
608 @b{foo}
609 0000
610 @end smallexample
611
612 @noindent
613 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
614 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
615 context where it stops.
616
617 @smallexample
618 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
619
620 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
621 at builtin.c:879
622 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
627 the next line of the current function.
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
632 : nil,
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @noindent
636 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
637 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
638 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
639 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
643 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
644 at input.c:530
645 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
646 @end smallexample
647
648 @noindent
649 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
650 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
651 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
652 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
653 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
654 stack frame for each active subroutine.
655
656 @smallexample
657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
658 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
659 at input.c:530
660 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
661 at builtin.c:882
662 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
663 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
664 at macro.c:71
665 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
666 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
671 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
672 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
678 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
679 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
682 : xstrdup(rq);
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
685 @end smallexample
686
687 @noindent
688 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
689 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
690 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
691 (@code{print}) to see their values.
692
693 @smallexample
694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
695 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
697 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
698 @end smallexample
699
700 @noindent
701 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
702 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
703 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
704
705 @smallexample
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
707 533 xfree(rquote);
708 534
709 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
710 : xstrdup (lq);
711 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
712 : xstrdup (rq);
713 537
714 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
715 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
716 540 @}
717 541
718 542 void
719 @end smallexample
720
721 @noindent
722 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
723 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
724
725 @smallexample
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
727 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
729 540 @}
730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
731 $3 = 9
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
733 $4 = 7
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @noindent
737 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
738 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
739 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
740 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
741 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
742 assignments.
743
744 @smallexample
745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
746 $5 = 7
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
748 $6 = 9
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
753 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
754 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
755 example that caused trouble initially:
756
757 @smallexample
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
759 Continuing.
760
761 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
762
763 baz
764 0000
765 @end smallexample
766
767 @noindent
768 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
769 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
770 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
771
772 @smallexample
773 @b{Ctrl-d}
774 Program exited normally.
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @noindent
778 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
779 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
780 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
784 @end smallexample
785
786 @node Invocation
787 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
788
789 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
790 The essentials are:
791 @itemize @bullet
792 @item
793 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
794 @item
795 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
796 @end itemize
797
798 @menu
799 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
800 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
801 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
802 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
803 @end menu
804
805 @node Invoking GDB
806 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
807
808 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
809 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
810
811 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
812 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
813
814 The command-line options described here are designed
815 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
816 options may effectively be unavailable.
817
818 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
819 specifying an executable program:
820
821 @smallexample
822 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
823 @end smallexample
824
825 @noindent
826 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
827 specified:
828
829 @smallexample
830 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
831 @end smallexample
832
833 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
834 to debug a running process:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
838 @end smallexample
839
840 @noindent
841 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
842 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
843
844 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
845 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
846 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
847 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
848 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
849
850 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
851 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
852 option processing.
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
855 @end smallexample
856 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
857 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
858
859 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
860 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -silent
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
868 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
869
870 @noindent
871 Type
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} -help
875 @end smallexample
876
877 @noindent
878 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
879 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
880
881 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
882 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
883 @samp{-x} option is used.
884
885
886 @menu
887 * File Options:: Choosing files
888 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
889 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
890 @end menu
891
892 @node File Options
893 @subsection Choosing Files
894
895 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
896 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
897 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
898 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
899 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
900 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
901 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
902 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
903 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
904 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
905 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
906 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
907 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
908
909 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
910 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
911 argument and ignore it.
912
913 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
914 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
915 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
916 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
917 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
918
919 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
920 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
921 @c it.
922
923 @table @code
924 @item -symbols @var{file}
925 @itemx -s @var{file}
926 @cindex @code{--symbols}
927 @cindex @code{-s}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
929
930 @item -exec @var{file}
931 @itemx -e @var{file}
932 @cindex @code{--exec}
933 @cindex @code{-e}
934 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
935 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
936
937 @item -se @var{file}
938 @cindex @code{--se}
939 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
940 file.
941
942 @item -core @var{file}
943 @itemx -c @var{file}
944 @cindex @code{--core}
945 @cindex @code{-c}
946 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
947
948 @item -pid @var{number}
949 @itemx -p @var{number}
950 @cindex @code{--pid}
951 @cindex @code{-p}
952 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
953
954 @item -command @var{file}
955 @itemx -x @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--command}
957 @cindex @code{-x}
958 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
959 Files,, Command files}.
960
961 @item -eval-command @var{command}
962 @itemx -ex @var{command}
963 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
964 @cindex @code{-ex}
965 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
966
967 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
968 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
969
970 @smallexample
971 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
972 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
973 @end smallexample
974
975 @item -directory @var{directory}
976 @itemx -d @var{directory}
977 @cindex @code{--directory}
978 @cindex @code{-d}
979 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
980
981 @item -r
982 @itemx -readnow
983 @cindex @code{--readnow}
984 @cindex @code{-r}
985 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
986 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
987 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
988
989 @end table
990
991 @node Mode Options
992 @subsection Choosing Modes
993
994 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
995 batch mode or quiet mode.
996
997 @table @code
998 @item -nx
999 @itemx -n
1000 @cindex @code{--nx}
1001 @cindex @code{-n}
1002 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1003 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1004 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1005 Files}.
1006
1007 @item -quiet
1008 @itemx -silent
1009 @itemx -q
1010 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1011 @cindex @code{--silent}
1012 @cindex @code{-q}
1013 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1014 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1015
1016 @item -batch
1017 @cindex @code{--batch}
1018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1019 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1020 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1021 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1022 in the command files.
1023
1024 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1025 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1026 make this more useful, the message
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 Program exited normally.
1030 @end smallexample
1031
1032 @noindent
1033 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1034 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1035 mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch-silent
1038 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1039 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1040 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1041 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1042 for an interactive session.
1043
1044 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1045 messages, for example.
1046
1047 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1048 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1049
1050 @item -return-child-result
1051 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1052 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1053 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1054
1055 @itemize @bullet
1056 @item
1057 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1058 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1059 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1060 @item
1061 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1062 @item
1063 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1064 the exit code will be -1.
1065 @end itemize
1066
1067 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1068 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1069 interface.
1070
1071 @item -nowindows
1072 @itemx -nw
1073 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1074 @cindex @code{-nw}
1075 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1076 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1077 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1078
1079 @item -windows
1080 @itemx -w
1081 @cindex @code{--windows}
1082 @cindex @code{-w}
1083 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1084 used if possible.
1085
1086 @item -cd @var{directory}
1087 @cindex @code{--cd}
1088 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1089 instead of the current directory.
1090
1091 @item -fullname
1092 @itemx -f
1093 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1094 @cindex @code{-f}
1095 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1096 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1097 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1098 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1099 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1100 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1101 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1102 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1103 frame.
1104
1105 @item -epoch
1106 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1107 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1108 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1109 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1110 separate window.
1111
1112 @item -annotate @var{level}
1113 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1114 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1115 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1116 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1117 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1118 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1119 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1120 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1121 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1122
1123 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1124 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1125
1126 @item --args
1127 @cindex @code{--args}
1128 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1129 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1130 This option stops option processing.
1131
1132 @item -baud @var{bps}
1133 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1134 @cindex @code{--baud}
1135 @cindex @code{-b}
1136 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1137 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1138
1139 @item -l @var{timeout}
1140 @cindex @code{-l}
1141 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1142 for remote debugging.
1143
1144 @item -tty @var{device}
1145 @itemx -t @var{device}
1146 @cindex @code{--tty}
1147 @cindex @code{-t}
1148 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1149 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1150
1151 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1152 @item -tui
1153 @cindex @code{--tui}
1154 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1155 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1156 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1157 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1158 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1159 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1160 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1161
1162 @c @item -xdb
1163 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1164 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1165 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1166 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1167 @c systems.
1168
1169 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1170 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1171 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1172 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1173 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1174 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1175
1176 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1177 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1178 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1179 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1180 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1181 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1182
1183 @item -write
1184 @cindex @code{--write}
1185 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1186 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1187 (@pxref{Patching}).
1188
1189 @item -statistics
1190 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1191 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1192 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1193
1194 @item -version
1195 @cindex @code{--version}
1196 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1197 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1198
1199 @end table
1200
1201 @node Startup
1202 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1203 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1204
1205 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1206
1207 @enumerate
1208 @item
1209 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1210 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1211
1212 @item
1213 @cindex init file
1214 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1215 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1216 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1217 that file.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1221 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1222 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1223 that file.
1224
1225 @item
1226 Processes command line options and operands.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1230 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1231 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1232 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1233 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1234 @value{GDBN}.
1235
1236 @item
1237 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1238 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1239
1240 @item
1241 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1242 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1243 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1244 @end enumerate
1245
1246 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1247 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1248 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1249 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1250 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1251 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1252
1253 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1254 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1255
1256 @cindex init file name
1257 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1258 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1259 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1260 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1261 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1262 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1263 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1264 the file to the standard name.
1265
1266
1267 @node Quitting GDB
1268 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1269 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1270 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1271
1272 @table @code
1273 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1275 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @itemx q
1277 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1278 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1279 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1280 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1281 error code.
1282 @end table
1283
1284 @cindex interrupt
1285 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1286 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1287 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1288 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1289 until a time when it is safe.
1290
1291 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1292 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1293 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1294
1295 @node Shell Commands
1296 @section Shell Commands
1297
1298 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1299 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1300 just use the @code{shell} command.
1301
1302 @table @code
1303 @kindex shell
1304 @cindex shell escape
1305 @item shell @var{command string}
1306 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1307 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1308 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1309 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1310 @end table
1311
1312 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1313 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1314 @value{GDBN}:
1315
1316 @table @code
1317 @kindex make
1318 @cindex calling make
1319 @item make @var{make-args}
1320 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1321 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1322 @end table
1323
1324 @node Logging Output
1325 @section Logging Output
1326 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1327 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1328
1329 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1330 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1331
1332 @table @code
1333 @kindex set logging
1334 @item set logging on
1335 Enable logging.
1336 @item set logging off
1337 Disable logging.
1338 @cindex logging file name
1339 @item set logging file @var{file}
1340 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1341 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1342 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1343 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1344 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1345 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1346 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1347 @kindex show logging
1348 @item show logging
1349 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1350 @end table
1351
1352 @node Commands
1353 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1354
1355 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1356 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1357 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1358 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1359 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1360
1361 @menu
1362 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1363 * Completion:: Command completion
1364 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1365 @end menu
1366
1367 @node Command Syntax
1368 @section Command Syntax
1369
1370 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1371 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1372 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1373 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1374 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1375 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1376
1377 @cindex abbreviation
1378 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1379 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1380 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1381 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1382 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1383 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1384 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1385
1386 @cindex repeating commands
1387 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1388 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1389 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1390 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1391 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1392 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1393 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1394
1395 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1396 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1397 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1398
1399 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1400 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1401 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1402 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1403 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1404
1405 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1406 @cindex comment
1407 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1408 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1409 Files,,Command Files}).
1410
1411 @cindex repeating command sequences
1412 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1413 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1414 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1415 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1416 for editing.
1417
1418 @node Completion
1419 @section Command Completion
1420
1421 @cindex completion
1422 @cindex word completion
1423 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1424 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1425 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1426 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1427
1428 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1429 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1430 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1431 enter it). For example, if you type
1432
1433 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1434 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1435 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1436 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1437 @smallexample
1438 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1439 @end smallexample
1440
1441 @noindent
1442 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1443 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1444
1445 @smallexample
1446 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1447 @end smallexample
1448
1449 @noindent
1450 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1451 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1452 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1453 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1454 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1455 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1456
1457 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1458 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1459 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1460 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1461 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1462 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1463 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1464 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1465 example:
1466
1467 @smallexample
1468 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1469 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1470 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1471 make_abs_section make_function_type
1472 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1473 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1474 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1476 @end smallexample
1477
1478 @noindent
1479 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1480 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1481 command.
1482
1483 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1484 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1485 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1486 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1487 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1488
1489 @cindex quotes in commands
1490 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1491 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1492 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1493 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1494 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1495 @value{GDBN} commands.
1496
1497 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1498 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1499 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1500 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1501 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1502 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1503 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1504 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1505 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1506 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1507 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1511 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1513 @end smallexample
1514
1515 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1516 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1517 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1518 place:
1519
1520 @smallexample
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1522 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1524 @end smallexample
1525
1526 @noindent
1527 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1528 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1529 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1530
1531 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1532 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1533 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1534 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1535
1536 @cindex completion of structure field names
1537 @cindex structure field name completion
1538 @cindex completion of union field names
1539 @cindex union field name completion
1540 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1541 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1542 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1543 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1544 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1545 left-hand-side:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1549 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1550 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1555 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1556 follows:
1557
1558 @smallexample
1559 struct ui_file
1560 @{
1561 int *magic;
1562 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1563 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1564 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1565 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1566 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1567 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1568 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1569 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1570 void *to_data;
1571 @}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574
1575 @node Help
1576 @section Getting Help
1577 @cindex online documentation
1578 @kindex help
1579
1580 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1581 using the command @code{help}.
1582
1583 @table @code
1584 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1585 @item help
1586 @itemx h
1587 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1588 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1589
1590 @smallexample
1591 (@value{GDBP}) help
1592 List of classes of commands:
1593
1594 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1595 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1596 data -- Examining data
1597 files -- Specifying and examining files
1598 internals -- Maintenance commands
1599 obscure -- Obscure features
1600 running -- Running the program
1601 stack -- Examining the stack
1602 status -- Status inquiries
1603 support -- Support facilities
1604 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1605 stopping the program
1606 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1607
1608 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1609 commands in that class.
1610 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1611 documentation.
1612 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1613 (@value{GDBP})
1614 @end smallexample
1615 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1616
1617 @item help @var{class}
1618 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1619 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1620 help display for the class @code{status}:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1624 Status inquiries.
1625
1626 List of commands:
1627
1628 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1629 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1630 info -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the program being debugged
1632 show -- Generic command for showing things
1633 about the debugger
1634
1635 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1636 documentation.
1637 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1638 (@value{GDBP})
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @item help @var{command}
1642 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1643 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1644
1645 @kindex apropos
1646 @item apropos @var{args}
1647 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1648 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1649 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1650
1651 @smallexample
1652 apropos reload
1653 @end smallexample
1654
1655 @noindent
1656 results in:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 @c @group
1660 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1663 multiple times in one run
1664 @c @end group
1665 @end smallexample
1666
1667 @kindex complete
1668 @item complete @var{args}
1669 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1670 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1671 command you want completed. For example:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 complete i
1675 @end smallexample
1676
1677 @noindent results in:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 @group
1681 if
1682 ignore
1683 info
1684 inspect
1685 @end group
1686 @end smallexample
1687
1688 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1689 @end table
1690
1691 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1692 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1693 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1694 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1695 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1696 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1697
1698 @c @group
1699 @table @code
1700 @kindex info
1701 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1702 @item info
1703 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1704 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1705 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1706 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1707 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1708 @w{@code{help info}}.
1709
1710 @kindex set
1711 @item set
1712 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1713 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1714 @code{set prompt $}.
1715
1716 @kindex show
1717 @item show
1718 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1719 @value{GDBN} itself.
1720 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1721 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1722 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1723 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1724
1725 @kindex info set
1726 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1727 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1728 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1729 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1730 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1731 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1732 @end table
1733 @c @end group
1734
1735 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1736 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1737
1738 @table @code
1739 @kindex show version
1740 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1741 @item show version
1742 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1743 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1744 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1745 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1746 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1747 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1748 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1749 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1750 @value{GDBN}.
1751
1752 @kindex show copying
1753 @kindex info copying
1754 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1755 @item show copying
1756 @itemx info copying
1757 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1758
1759 @kindex show warranty
1760 @kindex info warranty
1761 @item show warranty
1762 @itemx info warranty
1763 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1764 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1765
1766 @end table
1767
1768 @node Running
1769 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1770
1771 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1772 debugging information when you compile it.
1773
1774 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1775 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1776 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1777 kill a child process.
1778
1779 @menu
1780 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1781 * Starting:: Starting your program
1782 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1783 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1784
1785 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1786 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1787 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1788 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1789
1790 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1791 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1792 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1793 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1794 @end menu
1795
1796 @node Compilation
1797 @section Compiling for Debugging
1798
1799 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1800 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1801 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1802 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1803 and addresses in the executable code.
1804
1805 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1806 the compiler.
1807
1808 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1809 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1810 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1811 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1812 executables containing debugging information.
1813
1814 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1815 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1816 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1817 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1818 in pushing your luck.
1819
1820 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1821 @cindex debugging optimized code
1822 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1823 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1824 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1825 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1826 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1827 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1828
1829 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1830 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1831 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1832 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1833 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1834
1835 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1836 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1837 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1838
1839 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1840 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1841 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1842 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1843 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1844 provides macro information if you specify the options
1845 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1846 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1847 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1848 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1849 @option{-g} alone.
1850
1851 @need 2000
1852 @node Starting
1853 @section Starting your Program
1854 @cindex starting
1855 @cindex running
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex run
1859 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1860 @item run
1861 @itemx r
1862 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1863 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1864 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1865 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1866 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1867
1868 @end table
1869
1870 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1871 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1872 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1873 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1874 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1875 message like this one:
1876
1877 @smallexample
1878 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1879 Try "help target" or "continue".
1880 @end smallexample
1881
1882 @noindent
1883 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1884 first (@pxref{load}).
1885
1886 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1887 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1888 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1889 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1890 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1891 divided into four categories:
1892
1893 @table @asis
1894 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1895 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1896 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1897 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1898 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1899 the arguments.
1900 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1901 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1902 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1903
1904 @item The @emph{environment.}
1905 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1906 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1907 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1908 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1909
1910 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1911 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1912 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1913 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1914
1915 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1916 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1917 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1918 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1919 set a different device for your program.
1920 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1921
1922 @cindex pipes
1923 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1924 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1925 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1926 wrong program.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1930 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1931 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1932 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1933 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1934
1935 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1936 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1937 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1938 your current breakpoints.
1939
1940 @table @code
1941 @kindex start
1942 @item start
1943 @cindex run to main procedure
1944 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1945 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1946 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1947 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1948 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1949 procedure, depending on the language used.
1950
1951 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1952 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1953 the @samp{run} command.
1954
1955 @cindex elaboration phase
1956 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1957 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1958 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1959 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1960 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1961 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1962 will remain to halt execution.
1963
1964 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1965 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1966 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1967 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1968 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1969
1970 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1971 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1972 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1973 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1974 elaboration code before running your program.
1975
1976 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1977 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1978 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1979 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1980 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1981 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1982 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1983 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1984 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1985 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1986 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1987
1988 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1989 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1990 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1991 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1992
1993 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1994 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1995 environment:
1996
1997 @smallexample
1998 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1999 (@value{GDBP}) run
2000 @end smallexample
2001
2002 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2003 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2004
2005 @kindex set disable-randomization
2006 @item set disable-randomization
2007 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2008 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2009 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2010 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2011 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2012
2013 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2014 behavior using
2015
2016 @smallexample
2017 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2018 @end smallexample
2019
2020 @item set disable-randomization off
2021 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2022 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2023 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2024 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2025 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2026 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2027
2028 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2029 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2030 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2031 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2032 a code at its expected addresses.
2033
2034 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2035 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2036 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2037 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2038 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2039 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2040 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2041 a randomly chosen address.
2042
2043 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2044 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2045 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2046 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2047 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2048
2049 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2050 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2051
2052 @item show disable-randomization
2053 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2054 the virtual address space of the started program.
2055
2056 @end table
2057
2058 @node Arguments
2059 @section Your Program's Arguments
2060
2061 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2062 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2063 @code{run} command.
2064 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2065 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2066 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2067 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2068 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2069
2070 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2071 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2072 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2073 the program, not by the shell.
2074
2075 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2076 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2077
2078 @table @code
2079 @kindex set args
2080 @item set args
2081 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2082 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2083 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2084 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2085 it again without arguments.
2086
2087 @kindex show args
2088 @item show args
2089 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2090 @end table
2091
2092 @node Environment
2093 @section Your Program's Environment
2094
2095 @cindex environment (of your program)
2096 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2097 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2098 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2099 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2100 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2101 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2102 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2103
2104 @table @code
2105 @kindex path
2106 @item path @var{directory}
2107 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2108 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2109 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2110 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2111 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2112 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2113 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2114
2115 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2116 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2117 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2118 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2119 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2120 @var{directory} to the search path.
2121 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2122 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2123
2124 @kindex show paths
2125 @item show paths
2126 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2127 environment variable).
2128
2129 @kindex show environment
2130 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2131 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2132 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2133 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2134 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2135
2136 @kindex set environment
2137 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2138 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2139 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2140 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2141 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2142 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2143 null value.
2144 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2145 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2146
2147 For example, this command:
2148
2149 @smallexample
2150 set env USER = foo
2151 @end smallexample
2152
2153 @noindent
2154 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2155 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2156 are not actually required.)
2157
2158 @kindex unset environment
2159 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2160 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2161 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2162 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2163 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2164 @end table
2165
2166 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2167 the shell indicated
2168 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2169 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2170 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2171 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2172 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2173 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2174 @file{.profile}.
2175
2176 @node Working Directory
2177 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2178
2179 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2180 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2181 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2182 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2183 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2184 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2185
2186 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2187 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2188 Specify Files}.
2189
2190 @table @code
2191 @kindex cd
2192 @cindex change working directory
2193 @item cd @var{directory}
2194 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2195
2196 @kindex pwd
2197 @item pwd
2198 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2202 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2203 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2204 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2205 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2206 current working directory of the debuggee.
2207
2208 @node Input/Output
2209 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2210
2211 @cindex redirection
2212 @cindex i/o
2213 @cindex terminal
2214 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2215 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2216 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2217 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2218 running your program.
2219
2220 @table @code
2221 @kindex info terminal
2222 @item info terminal
2223 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2224 program is using.
2225 @end table
2226
2227 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2228 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2229
2230 @smallexample
2231 run > outfile
2232 @end smallexample
2233
2234 @noindent
2235 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2236
2237 @kindex tty
2238 @cindex controlling terminal
2239 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2240 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2241 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2242 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2243 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 tty /dev/ttyb
2247 @end smallexample
2248
2249 @noindent
2250 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2251 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2252 that as their controlling terminal.
2253
2254 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2255 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2256 terminal.
2257
2258 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2259 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2260 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2261 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2262
2263 @cindex inferior tty
2264 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2265 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2266 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2267 program.
2268
2269 @table @code
2270 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2271 @kindex set inferior-tty
2272 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2273
2274 @item show inferior-tty
2275 @kindex show inferior-tty
2276 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2277 @end table
2278
2279 @node Attach
2280 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2281 @kindex attach
2282 @cindex attach
2283
2284 @table @code
2285 @item attach @var{process-id}
2286 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2287 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2288 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2289 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2290 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2291
2292 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2293 executing the command.
2294 @end table
2295
2296 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2297 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2298 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2299 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2300
2301 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2302 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2303 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2304 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2305 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2306 Specify Files}.
2307
2308 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2309 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2310 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2311 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2312 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2313 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2314 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2315
2316 @table @code
2317 @kindex detach
2318 @item detach
2319 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2320 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2321 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2322 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2323 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2324 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2325 executing the command.
2326 @end table
2327
2328 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2329 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2330 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2331 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2332 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2333 Messages}).
2334
2335 @node Kill Process
2336 @section Killing the Child Process
2337
2338 @table @code
2339 @kindex kill
2340 @item kill
2341 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2342 @end table
2343
2344 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2345 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2346 is running.
2347
2348 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2349 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2350 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2351 outside the debugger.
2352
2353 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2354 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2355 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2356 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2357 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2358 breakpoint settings).
2359
2360 @node Inferiors
2361 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2362
2363 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2364 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2365 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2366 protocol.
2367
2368 @cindex inferior
2369 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2370 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2371 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2372 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2373 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2374 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2375 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2376 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2377 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2378 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2379 different parts of a single space.
2380
2381 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2382
2383 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2384
2385 @table @code
2386 @kindex info inferiors
2387 @item info inferiors
2388 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2389
2390 @kindex set print inferior-events
2391 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2392 @item set print inferior-events
2393 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2394 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2395 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2396 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2397 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2398 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2399
2400 @kindex show print inferior-events
2401 @item show print inferior-events
2402 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2403 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2404 @end table
2405
2406 @node Threads
2407 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2408
2409 @cindex threads of execution
2410 @cindex multiple threads
2411 @cindex switching threads
2412 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2413 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2414 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2415 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2416 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2417 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2418 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2419
2420 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2421 programs:
2422
2423 @itemize @bullet
2424 @item automatic notification of new threads
2425 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2426 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2427 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2428 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2429 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2430 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2431 messages on thread start and exit.
2432 @end itemize
2433
2434 @quotation
2435 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2436 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2437 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2438 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2439 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2440 like this:
2441
2442 @smallexample
2443 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2444 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2445 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2446 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2447 @end smallexample
2448 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2449 @c doesn't support threads"?
2450 @end quotation
2451
2452 @cindex focus of debugging
2453 @cindex current thread
2454 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2455 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2456 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2457 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2458 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2459
2460 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2461 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2462 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2463 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2464 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2465 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2466 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2467 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2468 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2469 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2470
2471 @smallexample
2472 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2473 @end smallexample
2474
2475 @noindent
2476 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2477 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2478 further qualifier.
2479
2480 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2481 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2482 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2483 @c program?
2484 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2485 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2486 @c threads ab initio?
2487
2488 @cindex thread number
2489 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2490 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2491 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2492
2493 @table @code
2494 @kindex info threads
2495 @item info threads
2496 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2497 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2498
2499 @enumerate
2500 @item
2501 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2502
2503 @item
2504 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2505
2506 @item
2507 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2508 @end enumerate
2509
2510 @noindent
2511 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2512 indicates the current thread.
2513
2514 For example,
2515 @end table
2516 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2517
2518 @smallexample
2519 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2520 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2521 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2522 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2523 at threadtest.c:68
2524 @end smallexample
2525
2526 On HP-UX systems:
2527
2528 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2529 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2530 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2531 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2532 thread in your program.
2533
2534 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2535 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2536 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2537 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2538 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2539 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2540 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2541 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2542 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2543 HP-UX, you see
2544
2545 @smallexample
2546 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2547 @end smallexample
2548
2549 @noindent
2550 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2551
2552 @table @code
2553 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2554 @item info threads
2555 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2556 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2557
2558 @enumerate
2559 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2560
2561 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2562
2563 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2564 @end enumerate
2565
2566 @noindent
2567 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2568 indicates the current thread.
2569
2570 For example,
2571 @end table
2572 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2576 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2577 at quicksort.c:137
2578 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2579 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2580 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2581 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2582 @end smallexample
2583
2584 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2585 Solaris-specific command:
2586
2587 @table @code
2588 @item maint info sol-threads
2589 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2590 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2591 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @table @code
2595 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2596 @item thread @var{threadno}
2597 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2598 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2599 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2600 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2601 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2602
2603 @smallexample
2604 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2605 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2606 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2607 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2608 @end smallexample
2609
2610 @noindent
2611 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2612 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2613 threads.
2614
2615 @kindex thread apply
2616 @cindex apply command to several threads
2617 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2618 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2619 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2620 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2621 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2622 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2623 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2624 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2625
2626 @kindex set print thread-events
2627 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2628 @item set print thread-events
2629 @itemx set print thread-events on
2630 @itemx set print thread-events off
2631 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2632 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2633 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2634 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2635 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2636
2637 @kindex show print thread-events
2638 @item show print thread-events
2639 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2640 have started and exited.
2641 @end table
2642
2643 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2644 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2645 programs with multiple threads.
2646
2647 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2648 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2649
2650 @node Processes
2651 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2652
2653 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2654 @cindex multiple processes
2655 @cindex processes, multiple
2656 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2657 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2658 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2659 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2660 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2661 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2662 will cause it to terminate.
2663
2664 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2665 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2666 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2667 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2668 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2669 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2670 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2671 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2672 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2673 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2674
2675 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2676 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2677 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2678 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2679
2680 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2681 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2682
2683 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2684 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2688 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2689 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2690 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2691 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2692
2693 @table @code
2694 @item parent
2695 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2696 unimpeded. This is the default.
2697
2698 @item child
2699 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2700 unimpeded.
2701
2702 @end table
2703
2704 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2705 @item show follow-fork-mode
2706 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2707 @end table
2708
2709 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2710 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2711 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2715 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2716 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2717 retain debugger control over them both.
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @item on
2721 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2722 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2723 independently. This is the default.
2724
2725 @item off
2726 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2727 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2728 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2729 is held suspended.
2730
2731 @end table
2732
2733 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2734 @item show detach-on-fork
2735 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2736 @end table
2737
2738 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2739 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2740 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2741 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2742 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex info forks
2746 @item info forks
2747 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2748 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2749 position (program counter) of the process.
2750
2751 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2752 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2753 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2754 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2755 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2756
2757 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2758 @item process @var{process-id}
2759 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2760 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2761 @samp{info forks}.
2762
2763 @end table
2764
2765 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2766 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2767 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2768 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2769
2770 @table @code
2771 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2772 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2773 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2774 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2775 allowed to run independently.
2776
2777 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2778 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2779 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2780 and remove it from the fork list.
2781
2782 @end table
2783
2784 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2785 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2786 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2787 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2788 the child process's @code{main}.
2789
2790 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2791 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2792
2793 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2794 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2795 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2796 argument.
2797
2798 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2799 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2800 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2801
2802 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2803 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2804
2805 @cindex checkpoint
2806 @cindex restart
2807 @cindex bookmark
2808 @cindex snapshot of a process
2809 @cindex rewind program state
2810
2811 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2812 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2813 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2814 later.
2815
2816 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2817 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2818 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2819 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2820 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2821
2822 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2823 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2824 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2825 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2826 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2827 start again from there.
2828
2829 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2830 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2831
2832 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2833
2834 @table @code
2835 @kindex checkpoint
2836 @item checkpoint
2837 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2838 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2839 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2840
2841 @kindex info checkpoints
2842 @item info checkpoints
2843 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2844 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2845 listed:
2846
2847 @table @code
2848 @item Checkpoint ID
2849 @item Process ID
2850 @item Code Address
2851 @item Source line, or label
2852 @end table
2853
2854 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2855 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2856 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2857 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2858 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2859 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2860 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2861
2862 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2863 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2864 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2865 the debugger.
2866
2867 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2868 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2869 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2870
2871 @end table
2872
2873 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2874 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2875 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2876 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2877 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2878 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2879 previously read data can be read again.
2880
2881 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2882 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2883 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2884 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2885 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2886 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2887
2888 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2889 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2890 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2891 different execution path this time.
2892
2893 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2894 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2895 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2896 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2897 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2898 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2899 potentially pose a problem.
2900
2901 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2902
2903 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2904 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2905 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2906 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2907 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2908 next.
2909
2910 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2911 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2912 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2913 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2914 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2915
2916 @node Stopping
2917 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2918
2919 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2920 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2921 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2922
2923 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2924 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2925 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2926 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2927 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2928 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2929 explicitly request this information at any time.
2930
2931 @table @code
2932 @kindex info program
2933 @item info program
2934 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2935 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2936 @end table
2937
2938 @menu
2939 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2940 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2941 * Signals:: Signals
2942 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2943 @end menu
2944
2945 @node Breakpoints
2946 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2947
2948 @cindex breakpoints
2949 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2950 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2951 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2952 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2954 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2955 program.
2956
2957 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2958 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2959 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2960 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2961 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2962 call).
2963
2964 @cindex watchpoints
2965 @cindex data breakpoints
2966 @cindex memory tracing
2967 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2968 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2969 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2970 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2971 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2972 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2973 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2974 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2975 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2976 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2977 same commands.
2978
2979 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2980 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2981 Automatic Display}.
2982
2983 @cindex catchpoints
2984 @cindex breakpoint on events
2985 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2986 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2987 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2988 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2989 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2990 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2991 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2992
2993 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2994 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2995 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2996 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2997 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2998 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2999 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3000 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3001 enable it again.
3002
3003 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3004 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3005 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3006 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3007 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3008 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3009 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3010
3011 @menu
3012 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3013 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3014 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3015 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3016 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3017 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3018 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3019 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3020 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3021 @end menu
3022
3023 @node Set Breaks
3024 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3025
3026 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3027 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3028 @c
3029 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3030
3031 @kindex break
3032 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3033 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3034 @cindex latest breakpoint
3035 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3036 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3037 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3038 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3039 convenience variables.
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @item break @var{location}
3043 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3044 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3045 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3046 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3047 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3048
3049 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3050 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3051 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3052 that situation.
3053
3054 @item break
3055 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3056 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3057 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3058 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3059 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3060 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3061 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3062 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3063 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3064 inside loops.
3065
3066 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3067 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3068 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3069 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3070 existed when your program stopped.
3071
3072 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3073 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3074 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3075 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3076 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3077 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3078 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3079
3080 @kindex tbreak
3081 @item tbreak @var{args}
3082 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3083 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3084 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3085 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3086
3087 @kindex hbreak
3088 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3089 @item hbreak @var{args}
3090 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3091 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3092 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3093 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3094 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3095 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3096 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3097 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3098 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3099 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3100 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3101 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3102 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3103 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3104 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3105 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3106 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3107 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3108
3109 @kindex thbreak
3110 @item thbreak @var{args}
3111 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3112 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3113 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3114 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3115 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3116 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3117 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3118 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3119
3120 @kindex rbreak
3121 @cindex regular expression
3122 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3123 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3124 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3125 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3126 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3127 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3128 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3129 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3130 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3131
3132 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3133 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3134 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3135 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3136 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3137 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3138
3139 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3140 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3141 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3142 classes.
3143
3144 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3145 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3146 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3147
3148 @smallexample
3149 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3150 @end smallexample
3151
3152 @kindex info breakpoints
3153 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3154 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3155 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3156 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3157 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3158 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3159 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3160 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3161
3162 @table @emph
3163 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3164 @item Type
3165 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3166 @item Disposition
3167 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3168 @item Enabled or Disabled
3169 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3170 that are not enabled.
3171 @item Address
3172 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3173 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3174 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3175 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3176 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3177 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3178 @item What
3179 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3180 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3181 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3182 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3183 @end table
3184
3185 @noindent
3186 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3187 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3188 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3189 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3190 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3191 valid location.
3192
3193 @noindent
3194 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3195 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3196 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3197 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3198 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3199
3200 @noindent
3201 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3202 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3203 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3204 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3205 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3206 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3207 @end table
3208
3209 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3210 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3211 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3212 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3213
3214 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3215 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3216 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3217 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3218
3219 @itemize @bullet
3220 @item
3221 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3222 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3223
3224 @item
3225 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3226 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3227
3228 @item
3229 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3230 several places where that function is inlined.
3231 @end itemize
3232
3233 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3234 the relevant locations@footnote{
3235 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3236 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3237 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3238 info with line numbers for them.}.
3239
3240 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3241 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3242 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3243 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3244 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3245 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3246 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3247
3248 For example:
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3252 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3253 stop only if i==1
3254 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3255 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3256 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3257 @end smallexample
3258
3259 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3260 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3261 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3262 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3263 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3264 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3265 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3266 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3267 that belong to that breakpoint.
3268
3269 @cindex pending breakpoints
3270 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3271 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3272 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3273 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3274 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3275 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3276 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3277 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3278 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3279 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3280 is not yet resolved.
3281
3282 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3283 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3284 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3285 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3286 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3287 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3288
3289 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3290 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3291 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3292 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3293
3294 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3295 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3296 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3297
3298 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3299 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3300 address specification to an address:
3301
3302 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3303 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3304 @table @code
3305 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3306 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3307 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3308
3309 @item set breakpoint pending on
3310 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3311 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3312
3313 @item set breakpoint pending off
3314 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3315 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3316 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3317
3318 @item show breakpoint pending
3319 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3320 @end table
3321
3322 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3323 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3324 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3325
3326 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3327 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3328 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3329 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3330 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3331 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3332 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3333 breakpoints.
3334
3335 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3336
3337 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3338 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3339 @table @code
3340 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3341 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3342 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3343 breakpoint must be used.
3344
3345 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3346 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3347 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3348 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3349 @end table
3350
3351 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3352 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3353 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3354 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3355 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3356 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3357 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3358 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3359 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3360
3361 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3362 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3363 @table @code
3364 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3365 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3366 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3367 removed from the target when it stops.
3368
3369 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3370 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3371 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3372 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3373 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3374
3375 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3376 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3377 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3378 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3379 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3380 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3381 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3382 @end table
3383
3384 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3385 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3386 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3387 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3388 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3389 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3390 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3391 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3392
3393
3394 @node Set Watchpoints
3395 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3396
3397 @cindex setting watchpoints
3398 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3399 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3400 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3401 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3402 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3403
3404 @itemize @bullet
3405 @item
3406 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3407
3408 @item
3409 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3410 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3411 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3412
3413 @item
3414 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3415 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3416 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3417 @end itemize
3418
3419 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3420 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3421 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3422 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3423 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3424 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3425 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3426 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3427 the expression changes.
3428
3429 @cindex software watchpoints
3430 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3431 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3432 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3433 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3434 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3435 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3436 culprit.)
3437
3438 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3439 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3440 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3441
3442 @table @code
3443 @kindex watch
3444 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3445 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3446 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3447 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3448 to watch the value of a single variable:
3449
3450 @smallexample
3451 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3452 @end smallexample
3453
3454 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3455 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3456 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3457 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3458 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3459 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3460
3461 @kindex rwatch
3462 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3463 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3464 by the program.
3465
3466 @kindex awatch
3467 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3468 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3469 or written into by the program.
3470
3471 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3472 @item info watchpoints
3473 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3474 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3475 @end table
3476
3477 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3478 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3479 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3480 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3481 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3482 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3483
3484 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3485 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3486 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3487 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3488 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3489 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3490 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3491 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3492
3493 @table @code
3494 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3495 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3496 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3497
3498 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3499 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3500 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3501 @end table
3502
3503 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3504 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3505 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3506
3507 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3508
3509 @smallexample
3510 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3511 @end smallexample
3512
3513 @noindent
3514 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3515
3516 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3517 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3518 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3519 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3520 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3521 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3522 will print a message like this:
3523
3524 @smallexample
3525 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3526 @end smallexample
3527
3528 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3529 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3530 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3531 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3532 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3533 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3534 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3535 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3536
3537 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3538 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3539 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3540 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3541 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3542 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3543
3544 @smallexample
3545 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3546 @end smallexample
3547
3548 @noindent
3549 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3550
3551 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3552 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3553 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3554 expression with separately allocated resources.
3555
3556 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3557 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3558 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3559
3560 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3561 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3562 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3563 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3564 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3565 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3566 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3567 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3568 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3569
3570 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3571 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3572 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3573 watched expression from every thread.
3574
3575 @quotation
3576 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3577 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3578 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3579 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3580 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3581 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3582 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3583 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3584 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3585 @end quotation
3586
3587 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3588
3589 @node Set Catchpoints
3590 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3591 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3592 @cindex exception handlers
3593 @cindex event handling
3594
3595 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3596 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3597 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3598
3599 @table @code
3600 @kindex catch
3601 @item catch @var{event}
3602 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3603 @table @code
3604 @item throw
3605 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3606 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3607
3608 @item catch
3609 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3610
3611 @item exception
3612 @cindex Ada exception catching
3613 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3614 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3615 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3616 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3617 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3618
3619 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3620 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3621 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3622 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3623 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3624 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3625 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3626 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3627
3628 @item exception unhandled
3629 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3630
3631 @item assert
3632 A failed Ada assertion.
3633
3634 @item exec
3635 @cindex break on fork/exec
3636 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3637 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3638
3639 @item fork
3640 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3641 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3642
3643 @item vfork
3644 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3645 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3646
3647 @end table
3648
3649 @item tcatch @var{event}
3650 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3651 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3652
3653 @end table
3654
3655 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3656
3657 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3658 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3659
3660 @itemize @bullet
3661 @item
3662 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3663 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3664 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3665 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3666 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3667 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3668 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3669 disabled within interactive calls.
3670
3671 @item
3672 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3673
3674 @item
3675 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3676 @end itemize
3677
3678 @cindex raise exceptions
3679 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3680 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3681 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3682 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3683 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3684 out where the exception was raised.
3685
3686 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3687 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3688 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3689 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3690
3691 @smallexample
3692 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3693 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3694 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3695 @end smallexample
3696
3697 @noindent
3698 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3699 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3700 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3701
3702 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3703 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3704 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3705 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3706 raised.
3707
3708
3709 @node Delete Breaks
3710 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3711
3712 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3713 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3714 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3715 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3716 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3717 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3718
3719 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3720 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3721 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3722 their breakpoint numbers.
3723
3724 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3725 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3726 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3727
3728 @table @code
3729 @kindex clear
3730 @item clear
3731 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3732 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3733 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3734 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3735
3736 @item clear @var{location}
3737 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3738 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3739 most useful ones are listed below:
3740
3741 @table @code
3742 @item clear @var{function}
3743 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3744 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3745
3746 @item clear @var{linenum}
3747 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3748 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3749 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3750 @end table
3751
3752 @cindex delete breakpoints
3753 @kindex delete
3754 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3755 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3757 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3758 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3759 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3760 @end table
3761
3762 @node Disabling
3763 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3764
3765 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3766 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3767 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3768 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3769 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3770
3771 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3772 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3773 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3774 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3775 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3776
3777 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3778 affects all of its locations.
3779
3780 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3781 states of enablement:
3782
3783 @itemize @bullet
3784 @item
3785 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3786 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3787 @item
3788 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3789 @item
3790 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3791 disabled.
3792 @item
3793 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3794 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3795 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3796 @end itemize
3797
3798 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3799 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3800
3801 @table @code
3802 @kindex disable
3803 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3804 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3805 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3806 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3807 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3808 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3809 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3810
3811 @kindex enable
3812 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3813 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3814 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3815
3816 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3817 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3818 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3819
3820 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3821 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3822 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3823 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3824 @end table
3825
3826 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3827 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3828 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3829 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3830 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3831 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3832 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3833 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3834 Stepping}.)
3835
3836 @node Conditions
3837 @subsection Break Conditions
3838 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3839 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3840
3841 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3842 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3843 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3844 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3845 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3846 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3847 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3848 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3849
3850 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3851 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3852 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3853 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3854 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3855
3856 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3857 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3858 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3859 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3860 one.
3861
3862 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3863 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3864 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3865 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3866 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3867 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3868 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3869 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3870 conditions for the
3871 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3872 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3873
3874 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3875 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3876 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3877 with the @code{condition} command.
3878
3879 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3880 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3881 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3882 catchpoint.
3883
3884 @table @code
3885 @kindex condition
3886 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3887 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3888 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3889 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3890 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3891 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3892 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3893 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3894 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3895 prints an error message:
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 @noindent
3902 @value{GDBN} does
3903 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3904 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3905 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3906
3907 @item condition @var{bnum}
3908 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3909 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3910 @end table
3911
3912 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3913 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3914 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3915 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3916 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3917 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3918 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3919 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3920 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3921 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3922 your program reaches it.
3923
3924 @table @code
3925 @kindex ignore
3926 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3927 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3928 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3929 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3930 takes no action.
3931
3932 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3933 a count of zero.
3934
3935 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3936 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3937 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3938 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3939
3940 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3941 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3942 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3943
3944 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3945 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3946 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3947 Variables}.
3948 @end table
3949
3950 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3951
3952
3953 @node Break Commands
3954 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3955
3956 @cindex breakpoint commands
3957 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3958 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3959 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3960 enable other breakpoints.
3961
3962 @table @code
3963 @kindex commands
3964 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3965 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3966 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3967 @itemx end
3968 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3969 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3970 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3971
3972 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3973 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3974
3975 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3976 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3977 recently encountered).
3978 @end table
3979
3980 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3981 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3982
3983 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3984 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3985 that resumes execution.
3986
3987 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3988 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3989 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3990 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3991 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3992
3993 @kindex silent
3994 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3995 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3996 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3997 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3998 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3999 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4000
4001 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4002 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4003 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4004
4005 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4006 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4007
4008 @smallexample
4009 break foo if x>0
4010 commands
4011 silent
4012 printf "x is %d\n",x
4013 cont
4014 end
4015 @end smallexample
4016
4017 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4018 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4019 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4020 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4021 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4022 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4023 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4024
4025 @smallexample
4026 break 403
4027 commands
4028 silent
4029 set x = y + 4
4030 cont
4031 end
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4035 @node Error in Breakpoints
4036 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4037
4038 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4039 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4040
4041 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4042 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4043 @smallexample
4044 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4045 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4046 @end smallexample
4047
4048 @noindent
4049 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4050 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4051 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4052
4053 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4054 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4055
4056 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4057 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4058 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4059
4060 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4061 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4062 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4063 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4064
4065 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4066 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4067 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4068 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4069 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4070 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4071 first in the bundle.
4072
4073 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4074 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4075 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4076 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4077 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4078 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4079 is hit.
4080
4081 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4082 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4083
4084 @smallexample
4085 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4086 @end smallexample
4087
4088 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4089 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4090 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4091 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4092 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4093 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4094 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4095 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4096
4097 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4098 adjusted breakpoints:
4099
4100 @smallexample
4101 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4102 to 0x00010410.
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4106 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4107 frequently than expected.
4108
4109 @node Continuing and Stepping
4110 @section Continuing and Stepping
4111
4112 @cindex stepping
4113 @cindex continuing
4114 @cindex resuming execution
4115 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4116 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4117 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4118 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4119 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4120 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4121 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4122 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4123
4124 @table @code
4125 @kindex continue
4126 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4127 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4128 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4129 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4130 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4131 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4132 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4133 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4134 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4135 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4136
4137 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4138 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4139 @code{continue} is ignored.
4140
4141 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4142 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4143 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4144 @code{continue}.
4145 @end table
4146
4147 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4148 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4149 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4150 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4151
4152 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4153 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4154 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4155 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4156 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4157 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4158
4159 @table @code
4160 @kindex step
4161 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4162 @item step
4163 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4164 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4165 abbreviated @code{s}.
4166
4167 @quotation
4168 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4169 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4170 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4171 @c distinction here.
4172 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4173 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4174 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4175 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4176 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4177 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4178 below.
4179 @end quotation
4180
4181 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4182 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4183 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4184 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4185 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4186 called within the line.
4187
4188 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4189 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4190 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4191 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4192 was any debugging information about the routine.
4193
4194 @item step @var{count}
4195 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4196 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4197 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4198
4199 @kindex next
4200 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4201 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4202 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4203 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4204 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4205 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4206 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4207 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4208
4209 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4210
4211
4212 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4213 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4214 @c
4215 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4216 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4217 @c function are executed without stopping.
4218
4219 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4220 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4221 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4222
4223 @kindex set step-mode
4224 @item set step-mode
4225 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4226 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4227 @itemx set step-mode on
4228 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4229 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4230 information rather than stepping over it.
4231
4232 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4233 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4234 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4235
4236 @item set step-mode off
4237 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4238 debug information. This is the default.
4239
4240 @item show step-mode
4241 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4242 source line debug information.
4243
4244 @kindex finish
4245 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4246 @item finish
4247 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4248 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4249 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4250
4251 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4252 ,Returning from a Function}).
4253
4254 @kindex until
4255 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4256 @cindex run until specified location
4257 @item until
4258 @itemx u
4259 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4260 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4261 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4262 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4263 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4264 than the address of the jump.
4265
4266 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4267 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4268 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4269 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4270 through the next iteration.
4271
4272 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4273 stack frame.
4274
4275 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4276 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4277 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4278 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4279 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4280
4281 @smallexample
4282 (@value{GDBP}) f
4283 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4284 206 expand_input();
4285 (@value{GDBP}) until
4286 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4290 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4291 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4292 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4293 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4294 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4295 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4296
4297 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4298 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4299 argument.
4300
4301 @item until @var{location}
4302 @itemx u @var{location}
4303 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4304 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4305 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4306 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4307 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4308 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4309 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4310 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4311 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4312 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4313 invocations have returned.
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 94 int factorial (int value)
4317 95 @{
4318 96 if (value > 1) @{
4319 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4320 98 @}
4321 99 return (value);
4322 100 @}
4323 @end smallexample
4324
4325
4326 @kindex advance @var{location}
4327 @itemx advance @var{location}
4328 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4329 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4330 @ref{Specify Location}.
4331 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4332 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4333 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4334 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4335
4336
4337 @kindex stepi
4338 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4339 @item stepi
4340 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4341 @itemx si
4342 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4343
4344 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4345 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4346 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4347 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4348
4349 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4350
4351 @need 750
4352 @kindex nexti
4353 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4354 @item nexti
4355 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4356 @itemx ni
4357 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4358 proceed until the function returns.
4359
4360 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4361 @end table
4362
4363 @node Signals
4364 @section Signals
4365 @cindex signals
4366
4367 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4368 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4369 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4370 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4371 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4372 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4373 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4374 requested an alarm).
4375
4376 @cindex fatal signals
4377 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4378 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4379 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4380 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4381 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4382 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4383
4384 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4385 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4386 signal.
4387
4388 @cindex handling signals
4389 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4390 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4391 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4392 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4393 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4394
4395 @table @code
4396 @kindex info signals
4397 @kindex info handle
4398 @item info signals
4399 @itemx info handle
4400 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4401 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4402 the defined types of signals.
4403
4404 @item info signals @var{sig}
4405 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4406
4407 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4408
4409 @kindex handle
4410 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4411 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4412 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4413 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4414 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4415 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4416 say what change to make.
4417 @end table
4418
4419 @c @group
4420 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4421 Their full names are:
4422
4423 @table @code
4424 @item nostop
4425 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4426 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4427
4428 @item stop
4429 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4430 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4431
4432 @item print
4433 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4434
4435 @item noprint
4436 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4437 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4438
4439 @item pass
4440 @itemx noignore
4441 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4442 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4443 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4444
4445 @item nopass
4446 @itemx ignore
4447 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4448 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4449 @end table
4450 @c @end group
4451
4452 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4453 program until you
4454 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4455 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4456 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4457 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4458 program sees that signal when you continue.
4459
4460 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4461 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4462 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4463 erroneous signals.
4464
4465 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4466 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4467 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4468 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4469 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4470 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4471 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4472 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4473 Program a Signal}.
4474
4475 @node Thread Stops
4476 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4477
4478 @cindex stopped threads
4479 @cindex threads, stopped
4480
4481 @cindex continuing threads
4482 @cindex threads, continuing
4483
4484 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4485 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4486 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4487 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4488 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4489 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4490 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4491 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4492 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4493
4494 @menu
4495 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4496 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4497 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4498 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4499 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4500 @end menu
4501
4502 @node All-Stop Mode
4503 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4504
4505 @cindex all-stop mode
4506
4507 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4508 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4509 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4510 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4511 underfoot.
4512
4513 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4514 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4515 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4516
4517 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4518 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4519 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4520 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4521 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4522 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4523 stops.
4524
4525 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4526 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4527 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4528 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4529
4530 @cindex automatic thread selection
4531 @cindex switching threads automatically
4532 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4533 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4534 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4535 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4536 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4537 thread.
4538
4539 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4540 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4541
4542 @table @code
4543 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4544 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4545 @cindex lock scheduler
4546 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4547 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4548 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4549 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4550 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4551 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4552 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4553 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4554 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4555 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4556 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4557 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4558
4559 @item show scheduler-locking
4560 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4561 @end table
4562
4563 @node Non-Stop Mode
4564 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4565
4566 @cindex non-stop mode
4567
4568 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4569 @c with more details.
4570
4571 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4572 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4573 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4574 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4575 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4576 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4577
4578 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4579 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4580 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4581 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4582 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4583 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4584 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4585 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4586 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4587 independently and simultaneously.
4588
4589 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4590 or attach to your program:
4591
4592 @smallexample
4593 # Enable the async interface.
4594 set target-async 1
4595
4596 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4597 set pagination off
4598
4599 # Finally, turn it on!
4600 set non-stop on
4601 @end smallexample
4602
4603 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4604
4605 @table @code
4606 @kindex set non-stop
4607 @item set non-stop on
4608 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4609 @item set non-stop off
4610 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4611 @kindex show non-stop
4612 @item show non-stop
4613 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4617 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4618 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4619 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4620 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4621 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4622 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4623 default.
4624
4625 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4626 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4627 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4628
4629 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4630 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4631 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4632 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4633 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4634
4635 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4636 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4637 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4638 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4639 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4640
4641 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4642
4643 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4644 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4645 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4646 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4647 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4648 previously current thread.
4649
4650 @node Background Execution
4651 @subsection Background Execution
4652
4653 @cindex foreground execution
4654 @cindex background execution
4655 @cindex asynchronous execution
4656 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4657
4658 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4659 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4660 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4661 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4662 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4663 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4664
4665 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4666 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4667 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4668 are:
4669
4670 @table @code
4671 @kindex run&
4672 @item run
4673 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4674
4675 @item attach
4676 @kindex attach&
4677 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4678
4679 @item step
4680 @kindex step&
4681 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4682
4683 @item stepi
4684 @kindex stepi&
4685 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4686
4687 @item next
4688 @kindex next&
4689 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4690
4691 @item nexti
4692 @kindex nexti&
4693 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
4694
4695 @item continue
4696 @kindex continue&
4697 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4698
4699 @item finish
4700 @kindex finish&
4701 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4702
4703 @item until
4704 @kindex until&
4705 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4706
4707 @end table
4708
4709 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4710 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4711 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4712 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4713 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4714 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4715
4716 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4717 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4718
4719 @table @code
4720 @kindex interrupt
4721 @item interrupt
4722 @itemx interrupt -a
4723
4724 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4725 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4726 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4727 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4728 @end table
4729
4730 You may need to explicitly enable async mode before you can use background
4731 execution commands, with the @code{set target-async 1} command. If the
4732 target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error message
4733 if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4734
4735 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4736 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4737
4738 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4739 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4740 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4741
4742 @table @code
4743 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4744 @cindex thread breakpoints
4745 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4746 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4747 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4748 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4749 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4750 specify some source line.
4751
4752 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4753 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4754 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4755 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4756 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4757
4758 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4759 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4760 program.
4761
4762 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4763 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4764 breakpoint condition, like this:
4765
4766 @smallexample
4767 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4768 @end smallexample
4769
4770 @end table
4771
4772 @node Interrupted System Calls
4773 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4774
4775 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4776 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4777 @cindex premature return from system calls
4778 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4779 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4780 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4781 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4782 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4783 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4784 stop execution.
4785
4786 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4787 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4788 style anyways.
4789
4790 For example, do not write code like this:
4791
4792 @smallexample
4793 sleep (10);
4794 @end smallexample
4795
4796 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4797 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4798
4799 Instead, write this:
4800
4801 @smallexample
4802 int unslept = 10;
4803 while (unslept > 0)
4804 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4805 @end smallexample
4806
4807 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4808 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4809 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4810 @value{GDBN}.
4811
4812 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4813 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4814 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4815 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4816
4817
4818 @node Reverse Execution
4819 @chapter Running programs backward
4820 @cindex reverse execution
4821 @cindex running programs backward
4822
4823 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4824 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4825 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4826 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4827
4828 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4829 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4830 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4831 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4832 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4833 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4834
4835 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4836 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4837 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4838 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4839 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4840 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4841 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4842 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4843 prior values@footnote{
4844 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4845 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4846 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4847
4848 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4849 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4850 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4851 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4852 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4853 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4854 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4855 }.
4856
4857 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4858 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
4859
4860 @table @code
4861 @kindex reverse-continue
4862 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
4863 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4864 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4865 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
4866 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
4867 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
4868 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
4869
4870 @kindex reverse-step
4871 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
4872 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4873 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
4874 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
4875
4876 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
4877 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
4878 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
4879 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
4880 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
4881 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
4882
4883 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
4884 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
4885
4886 @kindex reverse-stepi
4887 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
4888 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4889 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
4890 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
4891 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
4892 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
4893 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
4894
4895 @kindex reverse-next
4896 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
4897 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4898 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
4899 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
4900 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
4901 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
4902 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
4903 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
4904 line of a function back to its return to its caller
4905 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
4906
4907 @kindex reverse-nexti
4908 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
4909 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4910 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
4911 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
4912 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
4913 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
4914 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
4915 frame) is reached.
4916
4917 @kindex reverse-finish
4918 @item reverse-finish
4919 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
4920 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
4921 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
4922 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
4923
4924 @kindex set exec-direction
4925 @item set exec-direction
4926 Set the direction of target execution.
4927 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
4928 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
4929 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
4930 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
4931 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
4932 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
4933 @item set exec-direction forward
4934 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
4935 This is the default.
4936 @end table
4937
4938
4939 @node Stack
4940 @chapter Examining the Stack
4941
4942 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4943 stopped and how it got there.
4944
4945 @cindex call stack
4946 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4947 is generated.
4948 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4949 the arguments of the call,
4950 and the local variables of the function being called.
4951 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4952 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4953 stack}.
4954
4955 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4956 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4957
4958 @cindex selected frame
4959 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4960 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4961 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4962 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4963 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4964 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4965
4966 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4967 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4968 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4969
4970 @menu
4971 * Frames:: Stack frames
4972 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4973 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4974 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4975
4976 @end menu
4977
4978 @node Frames
4979 @section Stack Frames
4980
4981 @cindex frame, definition
4982 @cindex stack frame
4983 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4984 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4985 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4986 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4987 which the function is executing.
4988
4989 @cindex initial frame
4990 @cindex outermost frame
4991 @cindex innermost frame
4992 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4993 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4994 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4995 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4996 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4997 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4998 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4999 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5000
5001 @cindex frame pointer
5002 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5003 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5004 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5005 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5006 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5007 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5008
5009 @cindex frame number
5010 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5011 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5012 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5013 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5014 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5015
5016 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5017 @c underflow problems.
5018 @cindex frameless execution
5019 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5020 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5021 @smallexample
5022 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5023 @end smallexample
5024 generates functions without a frame.)
5025 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5026 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5027 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5028 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5029 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5030 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5031 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5032
5033 @table @code
5034 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5035 @cindex current stack frame
5036 @item frame @var{args}
5037 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5038 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5039 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5040 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5041
5042 @kindex select-frame
5043 @cindex selecting frame silently
5044 @item select-frame
5045 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5046 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5047 @code{frame}.
5048 @end table
5049
5050 @node Backtrace
5051 @section Backtraces
5052
5053 @cindex traceback
5054 @cindex call stack traces
5055 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5056 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5057 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5058 stack.
5059
5060 @table @code
5061 @kindex backtrace
5062 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5063 @item backtrace
5064 @itemx bt
5065 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5066 frames in the stack.
5067
5068 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5069 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5070
5071 @item backtrace @var{n}
5072 @itemx bt @var{n}
5073 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5074
5075 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5076 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5077 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5078
5079 @item backtrace full
5080 @itemx bt full
5081 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5082 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5083 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5084 number of frames to print, as described above.
5085 @end table
5086
5087 @kindex where
5088 @kindex info stack
5089 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5090 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5091
5092 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5093 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5094 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5095 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5096 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5097 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5098 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5099 multi-threaded program.
5100
5101 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5102 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5103 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5104 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5105 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5106 line number.
5107
5108 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5109 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5110
5111 @smallexample
5112 @group
5113 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5114 at builtin.c:993
5115 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
5116 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5117 at macro.c:71
5118 (More stack frames follow...)
5119 @end group
5120 @end smallexample
5121
5122 @noindent
5123 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5124 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5125 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5126
5127 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5128 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5129 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5130 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5131 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5132 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5133 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5134 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5135 such a backtrace might look like:
5136
5137 @smallexample
5138 @group
5139 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5140 at builtin.c:993
5141 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5142 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5143 at macro.c:71
5144 (More stack frames follow...)
5145 @end group
5146 @end smallexample
5147
5148 @noindent
5149 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5150 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5151
5152 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5153 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5154 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5155
5156 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5157 @cindex program entry point
5158 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5159 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5160 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5161 @code{main}@footnote{
5162 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5163 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5164 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5165 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5166 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5167 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5168
5169 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5170 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5171
5172 @table @code
5173 @item set backtrace past-main
5174 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5175 @kindex set backtrace
5176 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5177
5178 @item set backtrace past-main off
5179 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5180 default.
5181
5182 @item show backtrace past-main
5183 @kindex show backtrace
5184 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5185
5186 @item set backtrace past-entry
5187 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5188 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5189 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5190 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5191
5192 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5193 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5194 application. This is the default.
5195
5196 @item show backtrace past-entry
5197 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5198
5199 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5200 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5201 @cindex backtrace limit
5202 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5203 unlimited.
5204
5205 @item show backtrace limit
5206 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5207 @end table
5208
5209 @node Selection
5210 @section Selecting a Frame
5211
5212 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5213 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5214 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5215 of the stack frame just selected.
5216
5217 @table @code
5218 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5219 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5220 @item frame @var{n}
5221 @itemx f @var{n}
5222 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5223 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5224 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5225 @code{main}.
5226
5227 @item frame @var{addr}
5228 @itemx f @var{addr}
5229 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5230 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5231 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5232 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5233 switches between them.
5234
5235 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5236 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5237
5238 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5239 pointer and a program counter.
5240
5241 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5242 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5243
5244 @kindex up
5245 @item up @var{n}
5246 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5247 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5248 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5249
5250 @kindex down
5251 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5252 @item down @var{n}
5253 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5254 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5255 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5256 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5257 @end table
5258
5259 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5260 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5261 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5262 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5263
5264 @need 1000
5265 For example:
5266
5267 @smallexample
5268 @group
5269 (@value{GDBP}) up
5270 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5271 at env.c:10
5272 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5273 @end group
5274 @end smallexample
5275
5276 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5277 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5278 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5279 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5280 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5281 for details.
5282
5283 @table @code
5284 @kindex down-silently
5285 @kindex up-silently
5286 @item up-silently @var{n}
5287 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5288 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5289 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5290 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5291 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5292 distracting.
5293 @end table
5294
5295 @node Frame Info
5296 @section Information About a Frame
5297
5298 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5299 stack frame.
5300
5301 @table @code
5302 @item frame
5303 @itemx f
5304 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5305 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5306 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5307 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5308 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5309
5310 @kindex info frame
5311 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5312 @item info frame
5313 @itemx info f
5314 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5315 including:
5316
5317 @itemize @bullet
5318 @item
5319 the address of the frame
5320 @item
5321 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5322 @item
5323 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5324 @item
5325 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5326 @item
5327 the address of the frame's arguments
5328 @item
5329 the address of the frame's local variables
5330 @item
5331 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5332 @item
5333 which registers were saved in the frame
5334 @end itemize
5335
5336 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5337 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5338 the usual conventions.
5339
5340 @item info frame @var{addr}
5341 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5342 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5343 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5344 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5345 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5346 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5347
5348 @kindex info args
5349 @item info args
5350 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5351
5352 @item info locals
5353 @kindex info locals
5354 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5355 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5356 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5357
5358 @kindex info catch
5359 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5360 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5361 @item info catch
5362 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5363 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5364 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5365 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5366 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5367
5368 @end table
5369
5370
5371 @node Source
5372 @chapter Examining Source Files
5373
5374 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5375 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5376 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5377 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5378 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5379 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5380 source files by explicit command.
5381
5382 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5383 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5384 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5385
5386 @menu
5387 * List:: Printing source lines
5388 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5389 * Edit:: Editing source files
5390 * Search:: Searching source files
5391 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5392 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5393 @end menu
5394
5395 @node List
5396 @section Printing Source Lines
5397
5398 @kindex list
5399 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5400 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5401 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5402 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5403 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5404
5405 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5406
5407 @table @code
5408 @item list @var{linenum}
5409 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5410 current source file.
5411
5412 @item list @var{function}
5413 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5414 @var{function}.
5415
5416 @item list
5417 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5418 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5419 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5420 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5421 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5422
5423 @item list -
5424 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5425 @end table
5426
5427 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5428 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5429 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5430
5431 @table @code
5432 @kindex set listsize
5433 @item set listsize @var{count}
5434 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5435 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5436
5437 @kindex show listsize
5438 @item show listsize
5439 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5440 @end table
5441
5442 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5443 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5444 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5445 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5446 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5447
5448 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5449 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5450 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5451 to specify some source line.
5452
5453 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5454
5455 @table @code
5456 @item list @var{linespec}
5457 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5458
5459 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5460 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5461 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5462 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5463 the same source file as the first linespec.
5464
5465 @item list ,@var{last}
5466 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5467
5468 @item list @var{first},
5469 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5470
5471 @item list +
5472 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5473
5474 @item list -
5475 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5476
5477 @item list
5478 As described in the preceding table.
5479 @end table
5480
5481 @node Specify Location
5482 @section Specifying a Location
5483 @cindex specifying location
5484 @cindex linespec
5485
5486 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5487 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5488 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5489 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5490
5491 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5492 @value{GDBN} understands:
5493
5494 @table @code
5495 @item @var{linenum}
5496 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5497
5498 @item -@var{offset}
5499 @itemx +@var{offset}
5500 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5501 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5502 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5503 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5504 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5505 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5506 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5507 linespec.
5508
5509 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5510 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5511
5512 @item @var{function}
5513 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5514 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5515
5516 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5517 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5518 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5519 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5520 functions in different source files.
5521
5522 @item *@var{address}
5523 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5524 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5525 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5526 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5527 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5528 source files.
5529
5530 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5531 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5532 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5533 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5534 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5535 of @var{address}:
5536
5537 @table @code
5538 @item @var{expression}
5539 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5540
5541 @item @var{funcaddr}
5542 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5543 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5544 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5545 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5546 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5547 (although the Pascal form also works).
5548
5549 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5550 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5551
5552 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5553 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5554 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5555 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5556 functions with identical names in different source files.
5557 @end table
5558
5559 @end table
5560
5561
5562 @node Edit
5563 @section Editing Source Files
5564 @cindex editing source files
5565
5566 @kindex edit
5567 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5568 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5569 The editing program of your choice
5570 is invoked with the current line set to
5571 the active line in the program.
5572 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5573 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5574
5575 @table @code
5576 @item edit @var{location}
5577 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5578 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5579 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5580 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5581 command most commonly used:
5582
5583 @table @code
5584 @item edit @var{number}
5585 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5586
5587 @item edit @var{function}
5588 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5589 @end table
5590
5591 @end table
5592
5593 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5594 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5595 @footnote{
5596 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5597 following command-line syntax:
5598 @smallexample
5599 ex +@var{number} file
5600 @end smallexample
5601 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5602 the file where to start editing.}.
5603 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5604 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5605 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5606 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5607 @smallexample
5608 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5609 export EDITOR
5610 gdb @dots{}
5611 @end smallexample
5612 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5613 @smallexample
5614 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5615 gdb @dots{}
5616 @end smallexample
5617
5618 @node Search
5619 @section Searching Source Files
5620 @cindex searching source files
5621
5622 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5623 regular expression.
5624
5625 @table @code
5626 @kindex search
5627 @kindex forward-search
5628 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5629 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5630 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5631 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5632 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5633 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5634 @code{fo}.
5635
5636 @kindex reverse-search
5637 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5638 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5639 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5640 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5641 this command as @code{rev}.
5642 @end table
5643
5644 @node Source Path
5645 @section Specifying Source Directories
5646
5647 @cindex source path
5648 @cindex directories for source files
5649 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5650 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5651 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5652 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5653 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5654 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5655 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5656
5657 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5658 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5659 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5660 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5661 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5662 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5663 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5664 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5665 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5666 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5667 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5668
5669 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5670 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5671 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5672 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5673 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5674 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5675
5676 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5677 source files.
5678
5679 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5680 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5681 each line is in the file.
5682
5683 @kindex directory
5684 @kindex dir
5685 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5686 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5687 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5688
5689 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5690 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5691
5692 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5693 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5694 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5695 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5696 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5697 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5698 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5699 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5700 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5701 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5702 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5703 name to look up the sources.
5704
5705 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5706 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5707 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5708 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5709 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5710 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5711 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5712 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5713
5714 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5715 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5716 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5717 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5718 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5719 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5720 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5721
5722 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5723 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5724 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5725 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5726 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5727 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5728 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5729 command.
5730
5731 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5732 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5733 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5734 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5735 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5736 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5737 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5738
5739 @table @code
5740 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5741 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5742 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5743 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5744 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5745 part of absolute file names) or
5746 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5747 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5748
5749 @kindex cdir
5750 @kindex cwd
5751 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5752 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5753 @cindex compilation directory
5754 @cindex current directory
5755 @cindex working directory
5756 @cindex directory, current
5757 @cindex directory, compilation
5758 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5759 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5760 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5761 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5762 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5763 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5764
5765 @item directory
5766 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5767
5768 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5769 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5770
5771 @item show directories
5772 @kindex show directories
5773 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5774
5775 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5776 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5777 @kindex set substitute-path
5778 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5779 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5780 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5781
5782 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5783 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5784
5785 @smallexample
5786 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5787 @end smallexample
5788
5789 @noindent
5790 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5791 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5792 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5793
5794 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5795 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5796 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5797 the substitution.
5798
5799 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5800
5801 @smallexample
5802 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5803 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5804 @end smallexample
5805
5806 @noindent
5807 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5808 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5809 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5810 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5811
5812
5813 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5814 @kindex unset substitute-path
5815 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5816 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5817 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5818
5819 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5820
5821 @item show substitute-path [path]
5822 @kindex show substitute-path
5823 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5824 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5825
5826 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5827 rules.
5828
5829 @end table
5830
5831 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5832 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5833 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5834
5835 @enumerate
5836 @item
5837 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5838
5839 @item
5840 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5841 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5842 directories in one command.
5843 @end enumerate
5844
5845 @node Machine Code
5846 @section Source and Machine Code
5847 @cindex source line and its code address
5848
5849 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5850 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5851 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5852 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5853 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5854 well as hex.
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex info line
5858 @item info line @var{linespec}
5859 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5860 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5861 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5862 @end table
5863
5864 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5865 the object code for the first line of function
5866 @code{m4_changequote}:
5867
5868 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5869 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5870 @smallexample
5871 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5872 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5873 @end smallexample
5874
5875 @noindent
5876 @cindex code address and its source line
5877 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5878 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5879 @smallexample
5880 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5881 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5882 @end smallexample
5883
5884 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5885 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5886 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5887 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5888 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5889 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5890 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5891 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5892 Variables}).
5893
5894 @table @code
5895 @kindex disassemble
5896 @cindex assembly instructions
5897 @cindex instructions, assembly
5898 @cindex machine instructions
5899 @cindex listing machine instructions
5900 @item disassemble
5901 @itemx disassemble /m
5902 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5903 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5904 the @code{/m} modifier.
5905 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5906 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5907 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5908 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5909 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5910 @end table
5911
5912 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5913 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5914
5915 @smallexample
5916 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5917 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5918 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5919 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5920 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5921 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5922 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5923 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5924 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5925 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5926 End of assembler dump.
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5930
5931 @smallexample
5932 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5933 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5934 5 @{
5935 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
5936 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
5937 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
5938 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
5939 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5940
5941 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
5942 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
5943 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5944
5945 7 return 0;
5946 8 @}
5947 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
5948 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
5949 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5950
5951 End of assembler dump.
5952 @end smallexample
5953
5954 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5955 mnemonics or other syntax.
5956
5957 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5958 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5959 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5960 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5961 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5962
5963 @table @code
5964 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5965 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5966 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5967 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5968 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5969 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5970
5971 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5972 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5973 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5974 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5975
5976 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5977 @item show disassembly-flavor
5978 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5979 @end table
5980
5981
5982 @node Data
5983 @chapter Examining Data
5984
5985 @cindex printing data
5986 @cindex examining data
5987 @kindex print
5988 @kindex inspect
5989 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5990 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5991 @c different window or something like that.
5992 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5993 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5994 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5995 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5996 Different Languages}).
5997
5998 @table @code
5999 @item print @var{expr}
6000 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6001 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6002 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6003 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6004 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6005 Formats}.
6006
6007 @item print
6008 @itemx print /@var{f}
6009 @cindex reprint the last value
6010 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6011 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6012 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6013 @end table
6014
6015 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6016 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6017 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6018
6019 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6020 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6021 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6022 Table}.
6023
6024 @menu
6025 * Expressions:: Expressions
6026 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6027 * Variables:: Program variables
6028 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6029 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6030 * Memory:: Examining memory
6031 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6032 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6033 * Value History:: Value history
6034 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6035 * Registers:: Registers
6036 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6037 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6038 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6039 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6040 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6041 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6042 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6043 character set than GDB does
6044 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6045 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6046 @end menu
6047
6048 @node Expressions
6049 @section Expressions
6050
6051 @cindex expressions
6052 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6053 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6054 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6055 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6056 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6057 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6058 @ref{Compilation}.
6059
6060 @cindex arrays in expressions
6061 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6062 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6063 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6064 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6065 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6066 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6067
6068 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6069 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6070 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6071 languages.
6072
6073 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6074 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6075
6076 @cindex casts, in expressions
6077 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6078 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6079 at that address in memory.
6080 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6081
6082 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6083 to programming languages:
6084
6085 @table @code
6086 @item @@
6087 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6088 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6089
6090 @item ::
6091 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6092 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6093
6094 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6095 @cindex type casting memory
6096 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6097 @cindex casts, to view memory
6098 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6099 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6100 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6101 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6102 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6103 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6104 @end table
6105
6106 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6107 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6108 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6109
6110 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6111 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6112 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6113 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6114 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6115 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6116 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6117
6118 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6119 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6120 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6121 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6122 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6123 as well.
6124
6125 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6126 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6127 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6128 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6129 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6130 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6131 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6132 choices.
6133
6134 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6135 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6136 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6137
6138 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6139 @smallexample
6140 @group
6141 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6142 [0] cancel
6143 [1] all
6144 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6145 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6146 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6147 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6148 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6149 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6150 > 2 4 6
6151 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6152 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6153 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6154 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6155 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6156 breakpoints.
6157 (@value{GDBP})
6158 @end group
6159 @end smallexample
6160
6161 @table @code
6162 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6163 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6164 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6165
6166 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6167 is ambiguous.
6168
6169 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6170 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6171 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6172 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6173 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6174 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6175 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6176 in the use of the menu.
6177
6178 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6179 when an ambiguity is detected.
6180
6181 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6182 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6183
6184 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6185 @item show multiple-symbols
6186 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6187 @end table
6188
6189 @node Variables
6190 @section Program Variables
6191
6192 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6193 in your program.
6194
6195 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6196 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6197
6198 @itemize @bullet
6199 @item
6200 global (or file-static)
6201 @end itemize
6202
6203 @noindent or
6204
6205 @itemize @bullet
6206 @item
6207 visible according to the scope rules of the
6208 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6209 @end itemize
6210
6211 @noindent This means that in the function
6212
6213 @smallexample
6214 foo (a)
6215 int a;
6216 @{
6217 bar (a);
6218 @{
6219 int b = test ();
6220 bar (b);
6221 @}
6222 @}
6223 @end smallexample
6224
6225 @noindent
6226 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6227 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6228 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6229 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6230
6231 @cindex variable name conflict
6232 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6233 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6234 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6235 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6236 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6237 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6238 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6239
6240 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6241 @ifnotinfo
6242 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6243 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6244 @end ifnotinfo
6245 @smallexample
6246 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6247 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6248 @end smallexample
6249
6250 @noindent
6251 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6252 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6253 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6254 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6255
6256 @smallexample
6257 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6258 @end smallexample
6259
6260 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6261 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6262 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6263 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6264 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6265 @c conflict?? --mew
6266
6267 @cindex wrong values
6268 @cindex variable values, wrong
6269 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6270 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6271 @quotation
6272 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6273 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6274 scope, and just before exit.
6275 @end quotation
6276 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6277 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6278 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6279 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6280 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6281 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6282 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6283 variable definitions may be gone.
6284
6285 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6286 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6287 when compiling.
6288
6289 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6290 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6291 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6292 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6293 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6294 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6295 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6296
6297 @smallexample
6298 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6299 @end smallexample
6300
6301 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6302 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6303 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6304 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6305 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6306 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6307 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6308 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6309 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6310 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6311 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6312
6313 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6314 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6315 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6316 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6317
6318 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6319 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6320 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6321 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6322 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6323 For program code
6324
6325 @smallexample
6326 char var0[] = "A";
6327 signed char var1[] = "A";
6328 @end smallexample
6329
6330 You get during debugging
6331 @smallexample
6332 (gdb) print var0
6333 $1 = "A"
6334 (gdb) print var1
6335 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6336 @end smallexample
6337
6338 @node Arrays
6339 @section Artificial Arrays
6340
6341 @cindex artificial array
6342 @cindex arrays
6343 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6344 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6345 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6346 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6347 program.
6348
6349 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6350 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6351 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6352 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6353 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6354 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6355 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6356 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6357 example. If a program says
6358
6359 @smallexample
6360 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6361 @end smallexample
6362
6363 @noindent
6364 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6365
6366 @smallexample
6367 p *array@@len
6368 @end smallexample
6369
6370 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6371 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6372 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6373 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6374 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6375
6376 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6377 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6378 The value need not be in memory:
6379 @smallexample
6380 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6381 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6382 @end smallexample
6383
6384 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6385 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6386 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6387 @smallexample
6388 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6389 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6390 @end smallexample
6391
6392 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6393 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6394 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6395 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6396 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6397 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6398 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6399 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6400 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6401 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6402
6403 @smallexample
6404 set $i = 0
6405 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6406 @key{RET}
6407 @key{RET}
6408 @dots{}
6409 @end smallexample
6410
6411 @node Output Formats
6412 @section Output Formats
6413
6414 @cindex formatted output
6415 @cindex output formats
6416 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6417 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6418 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6419 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6420 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6421
6422 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6423 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6424 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6425 letters supported are:
6426
6427 @table @code
6428 @item x
6429 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6430 hexadecimal.
6431
6432 @item d
6433 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6434
6435 @item u
6436 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6437
6438 @item o
6439 Print as integer in octal.
6440
6441 @item t
6442 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6443 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6444 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6445 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6446
6447 @item a
6448 @cindex unknown address, locating
6449 @cindex locate address
6450 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6451 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6452 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6453
6454 @smallexample
6455 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6456 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6457 @end smallexample
6458
6459 @noindent
6460 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6461 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6462
6463 @item c
6464 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6465 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6466 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6467 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6468
6469 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6470 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6471 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6472 data.
6473
6474 @item f
6475 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6476 using typical floating point syntax.
6477
6478 @item s
6479 @cindex printing strings
6480 @cindex printing byte arrays
6481 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6482 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6483 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6484 natural types.
6485
6486 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6487 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6488 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6489 array.
6490 @end table
6491
6492 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 p/x $pc
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @noindent
6499 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6500 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6501
6502 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6503 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6504 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6505
6506 @node Memory
6507 @section Examining Memory
6508
6509 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6510 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6511
6512 @cindex examining memory
6513 @table @code
6514 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6515 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6516 @itemx x @var{addr}
6517 @itemx x
6518 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6519 @end table
6520
6521 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6522 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6523 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6524 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6525 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6526
6527 @table @r
6528 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6529 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6530 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6531 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6532 @c 4.1.2.
6533
6534 @item @var{f}, the display format
6535 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6536 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6537 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6538 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6539 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6540
6541 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6542 The unit size is any of
6543
6544 @table @code
6545 @item b
6546 Bytes.
6547 @item h
6548 Halfwords (two bytes).
6549 @item w
6550 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6551 @item g
6552 Giant words (eight bytes).
6553 @end table
6554
6555 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6556 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6557 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6558
6559 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6560 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6561 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6562 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6563 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6564 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6565 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6566 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6567 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6568 a value from memory).
6569 @end table
6570
6571 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6572 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6573 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6574 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6575 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6576
6577 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6578 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6579 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6580 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6581 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6582
6583 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6584 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6585 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6586 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6587 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6588 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6589 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6590 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6591 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6592
6593 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6594 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6595 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6596 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6597 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6598 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6599 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6600
6601 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6602 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6603 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6604 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6605 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6606 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6607 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6608 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6609 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6610
6611 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6612 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6613 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6614
6615 @cindex remote memory comparison
6616 @cindex verify remote memory image
6617 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6618 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6619 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6620 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6621 situations.
6622
6623 @table @code
6624 @kindex compare-sections
6625 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6626 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6627 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6628 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6629 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6630 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6631 remote request.
6632 @end table
6633
6634 @node Auto Display
6635 @section Automatic Display
6636 @cindex automatic display
6637 @cindex display of expressions
6638
6639 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6640 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6641 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6642 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6643 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6644 The automatic display looks like this:
6645
6646 @smallexample
6647 2: foo = 38
6648 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6649 @end smallexample
6650
6651 @noindent
6652 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6653 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6654 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6655 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6656 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6657 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6658
6659 @table @code
6660 @kindex display
6661 @item display @var{expr}
6662 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6663 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6664
6665 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6666
6667 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6668 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6669 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6670 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6671 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6672
6673 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6674 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6675 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6676 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6677 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6678 @end table
6679
6680 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6681 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6682 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6683
6684 @table @code
6685 @kindex delete display
6686 @kindex undisplay
6687 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6688 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6689 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6690
6691 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6692 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6693
6694 @kindex disable display
6695 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6696 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6697 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6698 enabled again later.
6699
6700 @kindex enable display
6701 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6702 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6703 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6704
6705 @item display
6706 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6707 done when your program stops.
6708
6709 @kindex info display
6710 @item info display
6711 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6712 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6713 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6714 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6715 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6716 @end table
6717
6718 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6719 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6720 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6721 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6722 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6723 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6724 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6725 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6726 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6727 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6728 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6729
6730 @node Print Settings
6731 @section Print Settings
6732
6733 @cindex format options
6734 @cindex print settings
6735 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6736 and symbols are printed.
6737
6738 @noindent
6739 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6740
6741 @table @code
6742 @kindex set print
6743 @item set print address
6744 @itemx set print address on
6745 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6746 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6747 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6748 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6749 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6750 @code{set print address on}:
6751
6752 @smallexample
6753 @group
6754 (@value{GDBP}) f
6755 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6756 at input.c:530
6757 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6758 @end group
6759 @end smallexample
6760
6761 @item set print address off
6762 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6763 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6764
6765 @smallexample
6766 @group
6767 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6768 (@value{GDBP}) f
6769 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6770 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6771 @end group
6772 @end smallexample
6773
6774 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6775 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6776 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6777 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6778
6779 @kindex show print
6780 @item show print address
6781 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6782 @end table
6783
6784 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6785 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6786 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6787 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6788 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6789 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6790 it prints a symbolic address:
6791
6792 @table @code
6793 @item set print symbol-filename on
6794 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6795 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6796 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6797 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6798
6799 @item set print symbol-filename off
6800 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6801 default.
6802
6803 @item show print symbol-filename
6804 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6805 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6806 @end table
6807
6808 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6809 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6810 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6811
6812 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6813 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6817 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6818 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6819 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6820 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6821 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6822
6823 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6824 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6825 symbolic address.
6826 @end table
6827
6828 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6829 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6830 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6831 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6832 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6833 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6834 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6835 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6836
6837 @smallexample
6838 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6839 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6840 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6841 @end smallexample
6842
6843 @quotation
6844 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6845 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6846 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6847 @end quotation
6848
6849 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6850
6851 @table @code
6852 @item set print array
6853 @itemx set print array on
6854 @cindex pretty print arrays
6855 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6856 but uses more space. The default is off.
6857
6858 @item set print array off
6859 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6860
6861 @item show print array
6862 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6863 arrays.
6864
6865 @cindex print array indexes
6866 @item set print array-indexes
6867 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6868 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6869 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6870 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6871
6872 @item set print array-indexes off
6873 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6874
6875 @item show print array-indexes
6876 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6877 arrays.
6878
6879 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6880 @cindex number of array elements to print
6881 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6882 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6883 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6884 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6885 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6886 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6887 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6888
6889 @item show print elements
6890 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6891 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6892
6893 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6894 @cindex printing frame argument values
6895 @cindex print all frame argument values
6896 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6897 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6898 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6899 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6900 values are:
6901
6902 @table @code
6903 @item all
6904 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6905
6906 @item scalars
6907 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6908 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6909 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6910
6911 @smallexample
6912 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6913 at frame-args.c:23
6914 @end smallexample
6915
6916 @item none
6917 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6918 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6919
6920 @smallexample
6921 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6922 at frame-args.c:23
6923 @end smallexample
6924 @end table
6925
6926 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6927 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6928 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6929 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6930 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6931 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6932 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6933 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6934
6935 @item show print frame-arguments
6936 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6937
6938 @item set print repeats
6939 @cindex repeated array elements
6940 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6941 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6942 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6943 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6944 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6945 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6946 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6947
6948 @item show print repeats
6949 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6950 elements.
6951
6952 @item set print null-stop
6953 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6954 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6955 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6956 contain only short strings.
6957 The default is off.
6958
6959 @item show print null-stop
6960 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6961 @sc{null} character.
6962
6963 @item set print pretty on
6964 @cindex print structures in indented form
6965 @cindex indentation in structure display
6966 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6967 per line, like this:
6968
6969 @smallexample
6970 @group
6971 $1 = @{
6972 next = 0x0,
6973 flags = @{
6974 sweet = 1,
6975 sour = 1
6976 @},
6977 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6978 @}
6979 @end group
6980 @end smallexample
6981
6982 @item set print pretty off
6983 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6984
6985 @smallexample
6986 @group
6987 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6988 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6989 @end group
6990 @end smallexample
6991
6992 @noindent
6993 This is the default format.
6994
6995 @item show print pretty
6996 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6997
6998 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6999 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7000 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7001 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7002 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7003 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7004 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7005 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7006
7007 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7008 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7009 international character sets, and is the default.
7010
7011 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7012 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7013
7014 @item set print union on
7015 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7016 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7017 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7018
7019 @item set print union off
7020 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7021 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7022 instead.
7023
7024 @item show print union
7025 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7026 structures and other unions.
7027
7028 For example, given the declarations
7029
7030 @smallexample
7031 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7032 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7033 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7034 Bug_forms;
7035
7036 struct thing @{
7037 Species it;
7038 union @{
7039 Tree_forms tree;
7040 Bug_forms bug;
7041 @} form;
7042 @};
7043
7044 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7045 @end smallexample
7046
7047 @noindent
7048 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7049
7050 @smallexample
7051 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7052 @end smallexample
7053
7054 @noindent
7055 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7059 @end smallexample
7060
7061 @noindent
7062 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7063 and in Pascal.
7064 @end table
7065
7066 @need 1000
7067 @noindent
7068 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7069
7070 @table @code
7071 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7072 @item set print demangle
7073 @itemx set print demangle on
7074 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7075 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7076 linkage. The default is on.
7077
7078 @item show print demangle
7079 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7080
7081 @item set print asm-demangle
7082 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7083 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7084 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7085 The default is off.
7086
7087 @item show print asm-demangle
7088 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7089 or demangled form.
7090
7091 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7092 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7093 @kindex set demangle-style
7094 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7095 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7096 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7097
7098 @table @code
7099 @item auto
7100 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7101
7102 @item gnu
7103 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7104 This is the default.
7105
7106 @item hp
7107 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7108
7109 @item lucid
7110 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7111
7112 @item arm
7113 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7114 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7115 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7116 require further enhancement to permit that.
7117
7118 @end table
7119 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7120
7121 @item show demangle-style
7122 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7123
7124 @item set print object
7125 @itemx set print object on
7126 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7127 @cindex display derived types
7128 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7129 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7130 the virtual function table.
7131
7132 @item set print object off
7133 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7134 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7135
7136 @item show print object
7137 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7138
7139 @item set print static-members
7140 @itemx set print static-members on
7141 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7142 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7143
7144 @item set print static-members off
7145 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7146
7147 @item show print static-members
7148 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7149
7150 @item set print pascal_static-members
7151 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7152 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7153 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7154 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7155
7156 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7157 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7158
7159 @item show print pascal_static-members
7160 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7161
7162 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7163 @item set print vtbl
7164 @itemx set print vtbl on
7165 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7166 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7167 @cindex VTBL display
7168 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7169 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7170 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7171
7172 @item set print vtbl off
7173 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7174
7175 @item show print vtbl
7176 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7177 @end table
7178
7179 @node Value History
7180 @section Value History
7181
7182 @cindex value history
7183 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7184 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7185 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7186 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7187 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7188 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7189 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7190 symbol table.
7191
7192 @cindex @code{$}
7193 @cindex @code{$$}
7194 @cindex history number
7195 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7196 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7197 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7198 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7199 history number.
7200
7201 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7202 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7203 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7204 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7205 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7206 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7207 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7208
7209 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7210 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7211
7212 @smallexample
7213 p *$
7214 @end smallexample
7215
7216 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7217 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7218
7219 @smallexample
7220 p *$.next
7221 @end smallexample
7222
7223 @noindent
7224 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7225 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7226
7227 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7228 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7229
7230 @smallexample
7231 print x
7232 set x=5
7233 @end smallexample
7234
7235 @noindent
7236 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7237 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7238
7239 @table @code
7240 @kindex show values
7241 @item show values
7242 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7243 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7244 values} does not change the history.
7245
7246 @item show values @var{n}
7247 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7248
7249 @item show values +
7250 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7251 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7252 @end table
7253
7254 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7255 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7256
7257 @node Convenience Vars
7258 @section Convenience Variables
7259
7260 @cindex convenience variables
7261 @cindex user-defined variables
7262 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7263 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7264 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7265 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7266 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7267
7268 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7269 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7270 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7271 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7272 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7273
7274 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7275 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7276 For example:
7277
7278 @smallexample
7279 set $foo = *object_ptr
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7284 @code{object_ptr}.
7285
7286 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7287 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7288 value with another assignment at any time.
7289
7290 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7291 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7292 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7293 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7294
7295 @table @code
7296 @kindex show convenience
7297 @cindex show all user variables
7298 @item show convenience
7299 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7300 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7301
7302 @kindex init-if-undefined
7303 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7304 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7305 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7306 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7307 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7308 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7309 override default values used in a command script.
7310
7311 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7312 any side-effects do not occur.
7313 @end table
7314
7315 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7316 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7317 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7318
7319 @smallexample
7320 set $i = 0
7321 print bar[$i++]->contents
7322 @end smallexample
7323
7324 @noindent
7325 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7326
7327 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7328 values likely to be useful.
7329
7330 @table @code
7331 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7332 @item $_
7333 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7334 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7335 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7336 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7337 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7338 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7339 to the type of @code{$__}.
7340
7341 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7342 @item $__
7343 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7344 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7345 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7346
7347 @item $_exitcode
7348 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7349 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7350 the program being debugged terminates.
7351 @end table
7352
7353 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7354 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7355 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7356
7357 @node Registers
7358 @section Registers
7359
7360 @cindex registers
7361 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7362 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7363 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7364 your machine.
7365
7366 @table @code
7367 @kindex info registers
7368 @item info registers
7369 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7370 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7371
7372 @kindex info all-registers
7373 @cindex floating point registers
7374 @item info all-registers
7375 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7376 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7377
7378 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7379 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7380 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7381 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7382 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7383 @end table
7384
7385 @cindex stack pointer register
7386 @cindex program counter register
7387 @cindex process status register
7388 @cindex frame pointer register
7389 @cindex standard registers
7390 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7391 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7392 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7393 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7394 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7395 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7396 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7397 you could print the program counter in hex with
7398
7399 @smallexample
7400 p/x $pc
7401 @end smallexample
7402
7403 @noindent
7404 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7405
7406 @smallexample
7407 x/i $pc
7408 @end smallexample
7409
7410 @noindent
7411 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7412 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7413 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7414 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7415 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7416 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7417 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7418
7419 @smallexample
7420 set $sp += 4
7421 @end smallexample
7422
7423 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7424 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7425 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7426 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7427 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7428 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7429 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7430
7431 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7432 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7433 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7434 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7435 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7436 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7437 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7438
7439 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7440 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7441 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7442 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7443 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7444 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7445 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7446 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7447 prints the data in both formats.
7448
7449 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7450 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7451 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7452 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7453 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7454 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7455 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7456
7457 @smallexample
7458 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7459 $1 = @{
7460 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7461 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7462 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7463 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7464 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7465 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7466 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7467 @}
7468 @end smallexample
7469
7470 @noindent
7471 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7472 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7473 value to a @code{struct} member:
7474
7475 @smallexample
7476 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7477 @end smallexample
7478
7479 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7480 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7481 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7482 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7483 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7484 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7485
7486 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7487 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7488 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7489 frame makes no difference.
7490
7491 @node Floating Point Hardware
7492 @section Floating Point Hardware
7493 @cindex floating point
7494
7495 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7496 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7497
7498 @table @code
7499 @kindex info float
7500 @item info float
7501 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7502 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7503 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7504 the ARM and x86 machines.
7505 @end table
7506
7507 @node Vector Unit
7508 @section Vector Unit
7509 @cindex vector unit
7510
7511 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7512 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7513
7514 @table @code
7515 @kindex info vector
7516 @item info vector
7517 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7518 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7519 @end table
7520
7521 @node OS Information
7522 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7523 @cindex OS information
7524
7525 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7526 you debug your program.
7527
7528 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7529 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7530 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7531 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7532 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7533 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7534 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7535 structure.
7536
7537 @table @code
7538 @item info udot
7539 @kindex info udot
7540 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7541 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7542 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7543 the @code{examine} command.
7544 @end table
7545
7546 @cindex auxiliary vector
7547 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7548 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7549 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7550 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7551 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7552 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7553 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7554 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7555 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7556 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7557 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7558 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7559
7560 @table @code
7561 @kindex info auxv
7562 @item info auxv
7563 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7564 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7565 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7566 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7567 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7568 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7569 an unrecognized tag.
7570 @end table
7571
7572 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7573 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7574 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7575 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7576
7577 @table @code
7578 @kindex info os processes
7579 @item info os processes
7580 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7581 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7582 the command corresponding to the process.
7583 @end table
7584
7585 @node Memory Region Attributes
7586 @section Memory Region Attributes
7587 @cindex memory region attributes
7588
7589 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7590 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7591 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7592 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7593 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7594 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7595 user can override the fetched regions.
7596
7597 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7598 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7599 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7600 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7601 all memory.
7602
7603 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7604 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7605
7606 @table @code
7607 @kindex mem
7608 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7609 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7610 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7611 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7612 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7613 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7614
7615 @item mem auto
7616 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7617 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7618
7619 @kindex delete mem
7620 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7621 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7622 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7623
7624 @kindex disable mem
7625 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7626 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7627 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7628 It may be enabled again later.
7629
7630 @kindex enable mem
7631 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7632 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7633
7634 @kindex info mem
7635 @item info mem
7636 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7637 for each region:
7638
7639 @table @emph
7640 @item Memory Region Number
7641 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7642 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7643 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7644
7645 @item Lo Address
7646 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7647
7648 @item Hi Address
7649 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7650
7651 @item Attributes
7652 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7653 @end table
7654 @end table
7655
7656
7657 @subsection Attributes
7658
7659 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7660 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7661 write accesses to a memory region.
7662
7663 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7664 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7665 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7666
7667 @table @code
7668 @item ro
7669 Memory is read only.
7670 @item wo
7671 Memory is write only.
7672 @item rw
7673 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7674 @end table
7675
7676 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7677 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7678 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7679 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7680 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7681
7682 @table @code
7683 @item 8
7684 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7685 @item 16
7686 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7687 @item 32
7688 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7689 @item 64
7690 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7691 @end table
7692
7693 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7694 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7695 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7696 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7697 @c
7698 @c @table @code
7699 @c @item hwbreak
7700 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7701 @c @item swbreak (default)
7702 @c @end table
7703
7704 @subsubsection Data Cache
7705 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7706 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7707 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7708 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7709 registers.
7710
7711 @table @code
7712 @item cache
7713 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7714 @item nocache
7715 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7716 @end table
7717
7718 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7719 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7720 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7721 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7722 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7723
7724 @table @code
7725 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7726 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7727 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7728 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7729 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7730 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7731 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7732 The default value is @code{on}.
7733 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7734 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7735 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7736 @end table
7737
7738
7739 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7740 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7741 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7742 @c
7743 @c @table @code
7744 @c @item verify
7745 @c @item noverify (default)
7746 @c @end table
7747
7748 @node Dump/Restore Files
7749 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7750 @cindex dump/restore files
7751 @cindex append data to a file
7752 @cindex dump data to a file
7753 @cindex restore data from a file
7754
7755 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7756 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7757 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7758 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7759 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7760 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7761 files.
7762
7763 @table @code
7764
7765 @kindex dump
7766 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7767 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7768 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7769 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7770
7771 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7772 @table @code
7773 @item binary
7774 Raw binary form.
7775 @item ihex
7776 Intel hex format.
7777 @item srec
7778 Motorola S-record format.
7779 @item tekhex
7780 Tektronix Hex format.
7781 @end table
7782
7783 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7784 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7785 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7786 form.
7787
7788 @kindex append
7789 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7790 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7791 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7792 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7793 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7794
7795 @kindex restore
7796 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7797 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7798 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7799 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7800 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7801
7802 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7803 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7804 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7805 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7806 from that location.
7807
7808 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7809 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7810 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7811 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7812
7813 @end table
7814
7815 @node Core File Generation
7816 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7817 @cindex dump core from inferior
7818
7819 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7820 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7821 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7822 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7823 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7824 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7825 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7826
7827 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7828 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7829 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7830
7831 @table @code
7832 @kindex gcore
7833 @kindex generate-core-file
7834 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7835 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7836 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7837 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7838 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7839 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7840
7841 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7842 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7843 @end table
7844
7845 @node Character Sets
7846 @section Character Sets
7847 @cindex character sets
7848 @cindex charset
7849 @cindex translating between character sets
7850 @cindex host character set
7851 @cindex target character set
7852
7853 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7854 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7855 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7856 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7857 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7858 @dfn{target character set}.
7859
7860 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7861 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7862 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7863 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7864 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7865 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7866 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7867 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7868 character and string literals in expressions.
7869
7870 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7871 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7872 target-charset} command, described below.
7873
7874 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7875 support:
7876
7877 @table @code
7878 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7879 @kindex set target-charset
7880 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7881 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7882 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7883 list the target character sets it supports.
7884 @end table
7885
7886 @table @code
7887 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7888 @kindex set host-charset
7889 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7890
7891 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7892 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7893 @code{set host-charset} command.
7894
7895 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7896 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7897 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7898 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7899 list the host character sets it supports.
7900
7901 @item set charset @var{charset}
7902 @kindex set charset
7903 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7904 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7905 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7906 for both host and target.
7907
7908
7909 @item show charset
7910 @kindex show charset
7911 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7912
7913 @itemx show host-charset
7914 @kindex show host-charset
7915 Show the name of the current host charset.
7916
7917 @itemx show target-charset
7918 @kindex show target-charset
7919 Show the name of the current target charset.
7920
7921 @end table
7922
7923 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7924 sets:
7925
7926 @table @code
7927
7928 @item ASCII
7929 @cindex ASCII character set
7930 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7931 character set.
7932
7933 @item ISO-8859-1
7934 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7935 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7936 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7937 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7938 this as its host character set.
7939
7940 @item EBCDIC-US
7941 @itemx IBM1047
7942 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7943 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7944 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7945 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7946 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7947
7948 @end table
7949
7950 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7951 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7952 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7953
7954 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7955 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7956 @file{charset-test.c}:
7957
7958 @smallexample
7959 #include <stdio.h>
7960
7961 char ascii_hello[]
7962 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7963 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7964 char ibm1047_hello[]
7965 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7966 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7967
7968 main ()
7969 @{
7970 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7971 @}
7972 @end smallexample
7973
7974 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7975 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7976 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7977
7978 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7979
7980 @smallexample
7981 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7982 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7983 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7984 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7985 @dots{}
7986 (@value{GDBP})
7987 @end smallexample
7988
7989 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7990 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7991 strings:
7992
7993 @smallexample
7994 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7995 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7996 (@value{GDBP})
7997 @end smallexample
7998
7999 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8000 initial character set:
8001 @smallexample
8002 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8003 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8004 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8005 (@value{GDBP})
8006 @end smallexample
8007
8008 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8009 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8010 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8011 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8012 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8013
8014 @smallexample
8015 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8016 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8017 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8018 $2 = 72 'H'
8019 (@value{GDBP})
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8023 literals you use in expressions:
8024
8025 @smallexample
8026 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8027 $3 = 43 '+'
8028 (@value{GDBP})
8029 @end smallexample
8030
8031 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8032 character.
8033
8034 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8035 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8036 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8037
8038 @smallexample
8039 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8040 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8041 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8042 $5 = 200 '\310'
8043 (@value{GDBP})
8044 @end smallexample
8045
8046 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8047 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8048
8049 @smallexample
8050 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8051 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8052 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8053 @end smallexample
8054
8055 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8056 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8057 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8058 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8059 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8060
8061 @smallexample
8062 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8063 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8064 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8065 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8066 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8067 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8068 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8069 $7 = 72 '\110'
8070 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8071 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8072 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8073 $9 = 200 'H'
8074 (@value{GDBP})
8075 @end smallexample
8076
8077 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8078 string literals you use in expressions:
8079
8080 @smallexample
8081 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8082 $10 = 78 '+'
8083 (@value{GDBP})
8084 @end smallexample
8085
8086 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8087 character.
8088
8089 @node Caching Remote Data
8090 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8091 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8092
8093 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8094 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8095 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8096 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8097 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8098 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8099 volatile registers are in use.
8100
8101 @table @code
8102 @kindex set remotecache
8103 @item set remotecache on
8104 @itemx set remotecache off
8105 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8106 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8107
8108 @kindex show remotecache
8109 @item show remotecache
8110 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8111
8112 @kindex info dcache
8113 @item info dcache
8114 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8115 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8116 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8117 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8118 the data cache operation.
8119 @end table
8120
8121 @node Searching Memory
8122 @section Search Memory
8123 @cindex searching memory
8124
8125 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8126 @code{find} command.
8127
8128 @table @code
8129 @kindex find
8130 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8131 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8132 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8133 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8134 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8135 @end table
8136
8137 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8138 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8139
8140 @table @r
8141 @item @var{s}, search query size
8142 The size of each search query value.
8143
8144 @table @code
8145 @item b
8146 bytes
8147 @item h
8148 halfwords (two bytes)
8149 @item w
8150 words (four bytes)
8151 @item g
8152 giant words (eight bytes)
8153 @end table
8154
8155 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8156 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8157 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8158
8159 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8160 value's type in the current language.
8161 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8162 pattern as a mixture of types.
8163 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8164 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8165 which is typically four bytes.
8166
8167 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8168 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8169 @end table
8170
8171 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8172 (@code{"}).
8173 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8174 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8175
8176 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8177 number of matches found.
8178
8179 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8180 @samp{$_}.
8181 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8182
8183 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8184
8185 @smallexample
8186 void
8187 hello ()
8188 @{
8189 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8190 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8191 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8192 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8193 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8194 @}
8195 @end smallexample
8196
8197 @noindent
8198 you get during debugging:
8199
8200 @smallexample
8201 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8202 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8203 1 pattern found
8204 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8205 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8206 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8207 2 patterns found
8208 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8209 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8210 1 pattern found
8211 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8212 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8213 1 pattern found
8214 (gdb) print $numfound
8215 $1 = 1
8216 (gdb) print $_
8217 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8218 @end smallexample
8219
8220 @node Macros
8221 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8222
8223 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8224 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8225 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8226 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8227 where it was defined.
8228
8229 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8230 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8231 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8232 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8233
8234 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8235 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8236 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8237 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8238 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8239 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8240 see @ref{List}.
8241
8242 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8243 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8244 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8245
8246 @table @code
8247
8248 @kindex macro expand
8249 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8250 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8251 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8252 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8253 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8254 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8255 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8256 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8257 it can be any string of tokens.
8258
8259 @kindex macro exp1
8260 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8261 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8262 @cindex expand macro once
8263 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8264 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8265 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8266 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8267 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8268 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8269 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8270 can be any string of tokens.
8271
8272 @kindex info macro
8273 @cindex macro definition, showing
8274 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8275 @item info macro @var{macro}
8276 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8277 source location where that definition was established.
8278
8279 @kindex macro define
8280 @cindex user-defined macros
8281 @cindex defining macros interactively
8282 @cindex macros, user-defined
8283 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8284 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8285 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8286 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8287 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8288 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8289 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8290 @var{arglist}.
8291
8292 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8293 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8294 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8295 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8296 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8297
8298 @kindex macro undef
8299 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8300 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8301 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8302 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8303 in the program being debugged.
8304
8305 @kindex macro list
8306 @item macro list
8307 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8308 @end table
8309
8310 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8311 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8312 show our source files:
8313
8314 @smallexample
8315 $ cat sample.c
8316 #include <stdio.h>
8317 #include "sample.h"
8318
8319 #define M 42
8320 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8321
8322 main ()
8323 @{
8324 #define N 28
8325 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8326 #undef N
8327 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8328 #define N 1729
8329 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8330 @}
8331 $ cat sample.h
8332 #define Q <
8333 $
8334 @end smallexample
8335
8336 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8337 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8338 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8339 information.
8340
8341 @smallexample
8342 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8343 $
8344 @end smallexample
8345
8346 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8347
8348 @smallexample
8349 $ gdb -nw sample
8350 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8351 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8352 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8353 (@value{GDBP})
8354 @end smallexample
8355
8356 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8357 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8358 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8359
8360 @smallexample
8361 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8362 3
8363 4 #define M 42
8364 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8365 6
8366 7 main ()
8367 8 @{
8368 9 #define N 28
8369 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8370 11 #undef N
8371 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8372 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8373 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8374 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8375 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8376 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8377 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8378 #define Q <
8379 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8380 expands to: (42 + 1)
8381 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8382 expands to: once (M + 1)
8383 (@value{GDBP})
8384 @end smallexample
8385
8386 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8387 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8388 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8389 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8390
8391 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8392 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8396 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8397 (@value{GDBP}) run
8398 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8399
8400 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8401 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8402 (@value{GDBP})
8403 @end smallexample
8404
8405 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8406
8407 @smallexample
8408 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8409 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8410 #define N 28
8411 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8412 expands to: 28 < 42
8413 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8414 $1 = 1
8415 (@value{GDBP})
8416 @end smallexample
8417
8418 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8419 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8420 thereof) in force at each point:
8421
8422 @smallexample
8423 (@value{GDBP}) next
8424 Hello, world!
8425 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8426 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8427 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8428 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8429 (@value{GDBP}) next
8430 We're so creative.
8431 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8432 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8433 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8434 #define N 1729
8435 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8436 expands to: 1729 < 42
8437 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8438 $2 = 0
8439 (@value{GDBP})
8440 @end smallexample
8441
8442
8443 @node Tracepoints
8444 @chapter Tracepoints
8445 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8446 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8447
8448 @cindex tracepoints
8449 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8450 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8451 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8452 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8453 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8454 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8455 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8456
8457 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8458 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8459 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8460 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8461 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8462 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8463 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8464 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8465 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8466 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8467 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8468
8469 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8470 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8471 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8472 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8473 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8474 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8475 Packets}.
8476
8477 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8478
8479 @menu
8480 * Set Tracepoints::
8481 * Analyze Collected Data::
8482 * Tracepoint Variables::
8483 @end menu
8484
8485 @node Set Tracepoints
8486 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8487
8488 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8489 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8490 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8491 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8492 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8493 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8494 work on.
8495
8496 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8497 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8498 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8499 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8500 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8501 tracepoint was hit.
8502
8503 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8504 conditions and actions.
8505
8506 @menu
8507 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8508 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8509 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8510 * Tracepoint Actions::
8511 * Listing Tracepoints::
8512 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8513 @end menu
8514
8515 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8516 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8517
8518 @table @code
8519 @cindex set tracepoint
8520 @kindex trace
8521 @item trace
8522 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8523 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8524 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8525 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8526 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8527 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8528 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8529 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8530 running.
8531
8532 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8533
8534 @smallexample
8535 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8536
8537 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8538
8539 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8540
8541 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8542
8543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8544 @end smallexample
8545
8546 @noindent
8547 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8548
8549 @vindex $tpnum
8550 @cindex last tracepoint number
8551 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8552 @cindex tracepoint number
8553 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8554 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8555
8556 @kindex delete tracepoint
8557 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8558 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8559 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8560 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8561
8562 Examples:
8563
8564 @smallexample
8565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8566
8567 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8568 @end smallexample
8569
8570 @noindent
8571 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8572 @end table
8573
8574 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8575 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8576
8577 @table @code
8578 @kindex disable tracepoint
8579 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8580 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8581 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8582 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8583 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8584
8585 @kindex enable tracepoint
8586 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8587 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8588 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8589 run.
8590 @end table
8591
8592 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8593 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8594
8595 @table @code
8596 @kindex passcount
8597 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8598 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8599 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8600 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8601 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8602 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8603 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8604 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8605 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8606 user.
8607
8608 Examples:
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8612 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8613
8614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8615 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8622 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8623 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8624 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8625 @end smallexample
8626 @end table
8627
8628 @node Tracepoint Actions
8629 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8630
8631 @table @code
8632 @kindex actions
8633 @cindex tracepoint actions
8634 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8635 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8636 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8637 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8638 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8639 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8640 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8641 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8642 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8643 @code{while-stepping}.
8644
8645 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8646 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8647 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8648
8649 @smallexample
8650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8651
8652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8653
8654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8655 @end smallexample
8656
8657 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8658 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8659 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8660 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8661 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8662 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8663 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8664 @code{end} command.
8665
8666 @smallexample
8667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8669 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8670 > collect bar,baz
8671 > collect $regs
8672 > while-stepping 12
8673 > collect $fp, $sp
8674 > end
8675 end
8676 @end smallexample
8677
8678 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8679 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8680 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8681 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8682 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8683 special arguments are supported:
8684
8685 @table @code
8686 @item $regs
8687 collect all registers
8688
8689 @item $args
8690 collect all function arguments
8691
8692 @item $locals
8693 collect all local variables.
8694 @end table
8695
8696 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8697 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8698 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8699
8700 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8701 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8702
8703 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8704 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8705 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8706 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8707 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8708 its own @code{end} command):
8709
8710 @smallexample
8711 > while-stepping 12
8712 > collect $regs, myglobal
8713 > end
8714 >
8715 @end smallexample
8716
8717 @noindent
8718 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8719 @code{stepping}.
8720 @end table
8721
8722 @node Listing Tracepoints
8723 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8724
8725 @table @code
8726 @kindex info tracepoints
8727 @kindex info tp
8728 @cindex information about tracepoints
8729 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8730 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8731 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8732 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8733 shown:
8734
8735 @itemize @bullet
8736 @item
8737 its number
8738 @item
8739 whether it is enabled or disabled
8740 @item
8741 its address
8742 @item
8743 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8744 @item
8745 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8746 @item
8747 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8748 @item
8749 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8750 @end itemize
8751
8752 @smallexample
8753 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8754 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8755 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8756 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8757 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8758 (@value{GDBP})
8759 @end smallexample
8760
8761 @noindent
8762 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8763 @end table
8764
8765 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8766 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8767
8768 @table @code
8769 @kindex tstart
8770 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8771 @cindex collected data discarded
8772 @item tstart
8773 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8774 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8775 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8776 experiment.
8777
8778 @kindex tstop
8779 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8780 @item tstop
8781 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8782 stops collecting data.
8783
8784 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8785 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8786 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8787
8788 @kindex tstatus
8789 @cindex status of trace data collection
8790 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8791 @item tstatus
8792 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8793 collection.
8794 @end table
8795
8796 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8797
8798 @smallexample
8799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8801 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8802 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8803 > while-stepping 11
8804 > collect $regs
8805 > end
8806 > end
8807 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8808 [time passes @dots{}]
8809 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8810 @end smallexample
8811
8812
8813 @node Analyze Collected Data
8814 @section Using the Collected Data
8815
8816 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8817 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8818 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8819 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8820 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8821 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8822 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8823 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8824 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8825 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8826 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8827 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8828 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8829 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8830 the buffer will fail.
8831
8832 @menu
8833 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8834 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8835 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8836 @end menu
8837
8838 @node tfind
8839 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8840
8841 @kindex tfind
8842 @cindex select trace snapshot
8843 @cindex find trace snapshot
8844 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8845 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8846 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8847 snapshot is selected.
8848
8849 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8850
8851 @table @code
8852 @item tfind start
8853 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8854 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8855
8856 @item tfind none
8857 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8858
8859 @item tfind end
8860 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8861
8862 @item tfind
8863 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8864
8865 @item tfind -
8866 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8867 retracing earlier steps.
8868
8869 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8870 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8871 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8872 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8873 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8874
8875 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8876 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8877 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8878 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8879 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8880
8881 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8882 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8883 addresses.
8884
8885 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8886 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8887 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8888
8889 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8890 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8891 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8892 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8893 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8894 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8895 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8896 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8897 @end table
8898
8899 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8900 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8901 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8902 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8903 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8904 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8905 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8906 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8907 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8908 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8909 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8910 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8911 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8912 tracepoint as the current one.
8913
8914 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8915 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8916 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8917 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8918 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8919
8920 @smallexample
8921 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8923 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8924 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8925 > tfind
8926 > end
8927
8928 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8929 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8930 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8931 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8932 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8933 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8934 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8935 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8936 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8937 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8938 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8939 @end smallexample
8940
8941 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8942 the buffer:
8943
8944 @smallexample
8945 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8946 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8947 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8948 > tfind line
8949 > end
8950
8951 Frame 0, X = 1
8952 Frame 7, X = 2
8953 Frame 13, X = 255
8954 @end smallexample
8955
8956 @node tdump
8957 @subsection @code{tdump}
8958 @kindex tdump
8959 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8960 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8961
8962 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8963 the current trace snapshot.
8964
8965 @smallexample
8966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8967 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8968 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8969 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8970 > end
8971
8972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8973
8974 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8975 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8976 at gdb_test.c:444
8977 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8978
8979 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8980 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8981 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8982 d1 0x18 24
8983 d2 0x80 128
8984 d3 0x33 51
8985 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8986 d5 0x22 34
8987 d6 0xe0 224
8988 d7 0x380035 3670069
8989 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8990 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8991 a2 0x100 256
8992 a3 0x322000 3284992
8993 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8994 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8995 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8996 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8997 ps 0x0 0
8998 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8999 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9000 fpstatus 0x0 0
9001 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9002 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9003 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9004 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9005 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9006 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9007 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9008 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9009 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9010
9011 (@value{GDBP})
9012 @end smallexample
9013
9014 @node save-tracepoints
9015 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9016 @kindex save-tracepoints
9017 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9018
9019 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9020 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9021 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9022 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9023 Files}).
9024
9025 @node Tracepoint Variables
9026 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9027 @cindex tracepoint variables
9028 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9029
9030 @table @code
9031 @vindex $trace_frame
9032 @item (int) $trace_frame
9033 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9034 snapshot is selected.
9035
9036 @vindex $tracepoint
9037 @item (int) $tracepoint
9038 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9039
9040 @vindex $trace_line
9041 @item (int) $trace_line
9042 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9043
9044 @vindex $trace_file
9045 @item (char []) $trace_file
9046 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9047
9048 @vindex $trace_func
9049 @item (char []) $trace_func
9050 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9051 @end table
9052
9053 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9054 use @code{output} instead.
9055
9056 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9057 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9058 data.
9059
9060 @smallexample
9061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9062
9063 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9064 > output $trace_file
9065 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9066 > tfind
9067 > end
9068 @end smallexample
9069
9070 @node Overlays
9071 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9072 @cindex overlays
9073
9074 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9075 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9076 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9077 use overlays.
9078
9079 @menu
9080 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9081 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9082 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9083 mapped by asking the inferior.
9084 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9085 @end menu
9086
9087 @node How Overlays Work
9088 @section How Overlays Work
9089 @cindex mapped overlays
9090 @cindex unmapped overlays
9091 @cindex load address, overlay's
9092 @cindex mapped address
9093 @cindex overlay area
9094
9095 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9096 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9097 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9098 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9099 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9100
9101 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9102 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9103 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9104 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9105 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9106 largest overlay as well.
9107
9108 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9109 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9110 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9111 there.
9112
9113 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9114 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9115 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9116
9117 @smallexample
9118 @group
9119 Data Instruction Larger
9120 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9121 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9122 | | | | | |
9123 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9124 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9125 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9126 | and heap | | | | | |
9127 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9128 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9129 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9130 | | | | | |
9131 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9132 address | | | | | |
9133 | overlay | <-' | | |
9134 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9135 | | <---. | | load address
9136 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9137 | | | |
9138 +-----------+ | |
9139 +-----------+
9140 | |
9141 +-----------+
9142
9143 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9144 @end group
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9148 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9149 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9150 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9151 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9152 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9153 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9154 program and the overlay area.
9155
9156 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9157 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9158 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9159 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9160 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9161 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9162 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9163
9164 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9165 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9166 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9167
9168 @itemize @bullet
9169
9170 @item
9171 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9172 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9173 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9174 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9175
9176 @item
9177 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9178 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9179 your program's performance.
9180
9181 @item
9182 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9183 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9184 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9185 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9186 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9187 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9188 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9189
9190 @item
9191 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9192 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9193 instruction and data spaces.
9194
9195 @end itemize
9196
9197 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9198 improved in many ways:
9199
9200 @itemize @bullet
9201
9202 @item
9203 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9204 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9205 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9206 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9207 area in the usual way.
9208
9209 @item
9210 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9211 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9212
9213 @item
9214 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9215 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9216 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9217 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9218 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9219 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9220 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9221
9222 @end itemize
9223
9224
9225 @node Overlay Commands
9226 @section Overlay Commands
9227
9228 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9229 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9230 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9231 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9232 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9233 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9234
9235 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9236 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9237
9238 @table @code
9239 @item overlay off
9240 @kindex overlay
9241 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9242 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9243 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9244 overlay support is disabled.
9245
9246 @item overlay manual
9247 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9248 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9249 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9250 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9251 commands described below.
9252
9253 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9254 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9255 @cindex map an overlay
9256 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9257 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9258 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9259 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9260 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9261 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9262
9263 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9264 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9265 @cindex unmap an overlay
9266 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9267 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9268 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9269 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9270
9271 @item overlay auto
9272 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9273 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9274 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9275 Overlay Debugging}.
9276
9277 @item overlay load-target
9278 @itemx overlay load
9279 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9280 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9281 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9282 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9283 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9284 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9285
9286 @item overlay list-overlays
9287 @itemx overlay list
9288 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9289 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9290 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9291
9292 @end table
9293
9294 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9295 of the function the address falls in:
9296
9297 @smallexample
9298 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9299 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9300 @end smallexample
9301 @noindent
9302 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9303 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9304 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9305 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9309 No sections are mapped.
9310 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9311 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9312 @end smallexample
9313 @noindent
9314 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9315 name normally:
9316
9317 @smallexample
9318 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9319 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9320 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9321 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9322 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9323 @end smallexample
9324
9325 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9326 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9327 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9328 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9329 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9330
9331 @itemize @bullet
9332 @item
9333 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9334 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9335 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9336 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9337 @item
9338 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9339 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9340 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9341 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9342 breakpoints properly.
9343 @end itemize
9344
9345
9346 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9347 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9348 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9349
9350 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9351 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9352 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9353 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9354 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9355 current state of the overlays.
9356
9357 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9358 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9359
9360 @table @asis
9361
9362 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9363 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9364
9365 @smallexample
9366 struct
9367 @{
9368 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9369 unsigned long vma;
9370
9371 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9372 unsigned long size;
9373
9374 /* The overlay's load address. */
9375 unsigned long lma;
9376
9377 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9378 zero otherwise. */
9379 unsigned long mapped;
9380 @}
9381 @end smallexample
9382
9383 @item @code{_novlys}:
9384 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9385 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9386
9387 @end table
9388
9389 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9390 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9391 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9392 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9393 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9394 currently mapped.
9395
9396 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9397 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9398 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9399 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9400 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9401 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9402 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9403 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9404 are not being executed.
9405
9406 @node Overlay Sample Program
9407 @section Overlay Sample Program
9408 @cindex overlay example program
9409
9410 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9411 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9412 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9413 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9414 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9415 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9416 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9417
9418 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9419 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9420 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9421 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9422
9423 @table @file
9424 @item overlays.c
9425 The main program file.
9426 @item ovlymgr.c
9427 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9428 @item foo.c
9429 @itemx bar.c
9430 @itemx baz.c
9431 @itemx grbx.c
9432 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9433 @item d10v.ld
9434 @itemx m32r.ld
9435 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9436 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9437 @end table
9438
9439 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9440 cross-compiler like this:
9441
9442 @smallexample
9443 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9444 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9445 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9446 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9447 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9448 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9449 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9450 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9451 @end smallexample
9452
9453 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9454 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9455 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9456
9457
9458 @node Languages
9459 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9460 @cindex languages
9461
9462 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9463 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9464 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9465 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9466 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9467 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9468
9469 @cindex working language
9470 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9471 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9472 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9473 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9474 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9475 language}.
9476
9477 @menu
9478 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9479 * Show:: Displaying the language
9480 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9481 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9482 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9483 @end menu
9484
9485 @node Setting
9486 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9487
9488 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9489 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9490 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9491 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9492 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9493 are printed, etc.
9494
9495 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9496 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9497 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9498 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9499 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9500 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9501 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9502 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9503 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9504 Displaying the Language}.
9505
9506 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9507 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9508 another language. In that case, make the
9509 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9510 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9511 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9512
9513 @menu
9514 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9515 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9516 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9517 @end menu
9518
9519 @node Filenames
9520 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9521
9522 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9523 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9524
9525 @table @file
9526 @item .ada
9527 @itemx .ads
9528 @itemx .adb
9529 @itemx .a
9530 Ada source file.
9531
9532 @item .c
9533 C source file
9534
9535 @item .C
9536 @itemx .cc
9537 @itemx .cp
9538 @itemx .cpp
9539 @itemx .cxx
9540 @itemx .c++
9541 C@t{++} source file
9542
9543 @item .m
9544 Objective-C source file
9545
9546 @item .f
9547 @itemx .F
9548 Fortran source file
9549
9550 @item .mod
9551 Modula-2 source file
9552
9553 @item .s
9554 @itemx .S
9555 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9556 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9557 @end table
9558
9559 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9560 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9561
9562 @node Manually
9563 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9564
9565 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9566 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9567 your program.
9568
9569 @kindex set language
9570 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9571 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9572 a language, such as
9573 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9574 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9575
9576 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9577 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9578 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9579 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9580 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9581 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9582 command such as:
9583
9584 @smallexample
9585 print a = b + c
9586 @end smallexample
9587
9588 @noindent
9589 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9590 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9591 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9592 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9593
9594 @node Automatically
9595 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9596
9597 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9598 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9599 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9600 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9601 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9602 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9603 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9604 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9605 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9606
9607 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9608 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9609 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9610 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9611 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9612
9613 @node Show
9614 @section Displaying the Language
9615
9616 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9617 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9618
9619 @table @code
9620 @item show language
9621 @kindex show language
9622 Display the current working language. This is the
9623 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9624 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9625
9626 @item info frame
9627 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9628 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9629 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9630 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9631 information listed here.
9632
9633 @item info source
9634 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9635 Display the source language of this source file.
9636 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9637 information listed here.
9638 @end table
9639
9640 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9641 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9642 with a language explicitly:
9643
9644 @table @code
9645 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9646 @kindex set extension-language
9647 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9648 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9649
9650 @item info extensions
9651 @kindex info extensions
9652 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9653 @end table
9654
9655 @node Checks
9656 @section Type and Range Checking
9657
9658 @quotation
9659 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9660 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9661 section documents the intended facilities.
9662 @end quotation
9663 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9664
9665 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9666 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9667 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9668 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9669 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9670 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9671 errors when your program is running.
9672
9673 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9674 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9675 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9676 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9677 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9678 automatically based on your program's source language.
9679 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9680 settings of supported languages.
9681
9682 @menu
9683 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9684 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9685 @end menu
9686
9687 @cindex type checking
9688 @cindex checks, type
9689 @node Type Checking
9690 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9691
9692 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9693 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9694 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9695 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9696
9697 @smallexample
9698 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9699 @exdent but
9700 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9701 @end smallexample
9702
9703 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9704 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9705
9706 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9707 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9708 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9709 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9710 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9711 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9712 also issues a warning.
9713
9714 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9715 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9716 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9717 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9718 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9719 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9720
9721 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9722 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9723 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9724 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9725 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9726 details on specific languages.
9727
9728 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9729
9730 @kindex set check type
9731 @kindex show check type
9732 @table @code
9733 @item set check type auto
9734 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9735 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9736 each language.
9737
9738 @item set check type on
9739 @itemx set check type off
9740 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9741 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9742 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9743 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9744 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9745
9746 @item set check type warn
9747 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9748 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9749 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9750 numbers and structures.
9751
9752 @item show type
9753 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9754 is setting it automatically.
9755 @end table
9756
9757 @cindex range checking
9758 @cindex checks, range
9759 @node Range Checking
9760 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9761
9762 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9763 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9764 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9765 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9766 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9767
9768 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9769 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9770 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9771 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9772
9773 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9774 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9775 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9776 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9777 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9778 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9779
9780 @smallexample
9781 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9782 @end smallexample
9783
9784 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9785 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9786 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9787
9788 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9789
9790 @kindex set check range
9791 @kindex show check range
9792 @table @code
9793 @item set check range auto
9794 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9795 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9796 each language.
9797
9798 @item set check range on
9799 @itemx set check range off
9800 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9801 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9802 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9803 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9804
9805 @item set check range warn
9806 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9807 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9808 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9809 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9810 systems).
9811
9812 @item show range
9813 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9814 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9815 @end table
9816
9817 @node Supported Languages
9818 @section Supported Languages
9819
9820 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9821 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9822 @c This is false ...
9823 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9824 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9825 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9826 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9827 language.
9828
9829 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9830 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9831 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9832 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9833 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9834 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9835 language reference or tutorial.
9836
9837 @menu
9838 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9839 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9840 * Fortran:: Fortran
9841 * Pascal:: Pascal
9842 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9843 * Ada:: Ada
9844 @end menu
9845
9846 @node C
9847 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9848
9849 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9850 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9851
9852 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9853 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9854 together.
9855
9856 @cindex C@t{++}
9857 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9858 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9859 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9860 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9861 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9862 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9863 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9864
9865 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9866 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9867 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9868 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9869 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9870 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9871
9872 @menu
9873 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9874 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9875 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9876 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9877 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9878 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9879 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9880 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9881 @end menu
9882
9883 @node C Operators
9884 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9885
9886 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9887
9888 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9889 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9890 often defined on groups of types.
9891
9892 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9893
9894 @itemize @bullet
9895
9896 @item
9897 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9898 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9899
9900 @item
9901 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9902 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9903
9904 @item
9905 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9906
9907 @item
9908 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9909
9910 @end itemize
9911
9912 @noindent
9913 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9914 in order of increasing precedence:
9915
9916 @table @code
9917 @item ,
9918 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9919 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9920 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9921
9922 @item =
9923 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9924 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9925
9926 @item @var{op}=
9927 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9928 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9929 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9930 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9931 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9932
9933 @item ?:
9934 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9935 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9936 integral type.
9937
9938 @item ||
9939 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9940
9941 @item &&
9942 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9943
9944 @item |
9945 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9946
9947 @item ^
9948 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9949
9950 @item &
9951 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9952
9953 @item ==@r{, }!=
9954 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9955 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9956
9957 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9958 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9959 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9960 and non-zero for true.
9961
9962 @item <<@r{, }>>
9963 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9964
9965 @item @@
9966 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9967
9968 @item +@r{, }-
9969 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9970 pointer types.
9971
9972 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9973 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9974 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9975 integral types.
9976
9977 @item ++@r{, }--
9978 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9979 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9980 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9981 operation takes place.
9982
9983 @item *
9984 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9985 @code{++}.
9986
9987 @item &
9988 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9989
9990 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9991 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9992 to examine the address
9993 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9994 stored.
9995
9996 @item -
9997 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9998 precedence as @code{++}.
9999
10000 @item !
10001 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10002 @code{++}.
10003
10004 @item ~
10005 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10006 @code{++}.
10007
10008
10009 @item .@r{, }->
10010 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10011 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10012 pointer based on the stored type information.
10013 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10014
10015 @item .*@r{, }->*
10016 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10017
10018 @item []
10019 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10020 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10021
10022 @item ()
10023 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10024
10025 @item ::
10026 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10027 and @code{class} types.
10028
10029 @item ::
10030 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10031 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10032 above.
10033 @end table
10034
10035 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10036 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10037 predefined meaning.
10038
10039 @node C Constants
10040 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10041
10042 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10043
10044 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10045 following ways:
10046
10047 @itemize @bullet
10048 @item
10049 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10050 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10051 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10052 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10053 @code{long} value.
10054
10055 @item
10056 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10057 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10058 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10059 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10060 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10061 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10062 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10063 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10064 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10065 constant.
10066
10067 @item
10068 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10069 integral equivalents.
10070
10071 @item
10072 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10073 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10074 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10075 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10076 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10077 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10078 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10079 @samp{\n} for newline.
10080
10081 @item
10082 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10083 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10084 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10085 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10086 characters.
10087
10088 @item
10089 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10090 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10091
10092 @item
10093 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10094 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10095 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10096 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10097 @end itemize
10098
10099 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10100 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10101
10102 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10103 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10104
10105 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10106 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10107 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10108 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10109 @quotation
10110 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10111 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10112 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10113 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10114 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10115 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10116 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10117 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10118 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10119 C@t{++} code.
10120 @end quotation
10121
10122 @enumerate
10123
10124 @cindex member functions
10125 @item
10126 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10127
10128 @smallexample
10129 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10130 @end smallexample
10131
10132 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10133 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10134 @item
10135 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10136 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10137 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10138 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10139
10140 @cindex call overloaded functions
10141 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10142 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10143 @item
10144 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10145 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10146 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10147 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10148 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10149 default arguments.
10150
10151 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10152 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10153 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10154 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10155 number of function arguments.
10156
10157 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10158 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10159 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10160
10161 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10162 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10163 @smallexample
10164 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10165 @end smallexample
10166
10167 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10168 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10169
10170 @cindex reference declarations
10171 @item
10172 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10173 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10174 dereferenced.
10175
10176 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10177 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10178 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10179 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10180 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10181
10182 @item
10183 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10184 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10185 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10186 necessary, for example in an expression like
10187 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10188 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10189 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10190 @end enumerate
10191
10192 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10193 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10194 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10195 invoking user-defined operators.
10196
10197 @node C Defaults
10198 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10199
10200 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10201
10202 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10203 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10204 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10205 selects the working language.
10206
10207 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10208 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10209 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10210 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10211 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10212 for further details.
10213
10214 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10215 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10216 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10217
10218 @node C Checks
10219 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10220
10221 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10222
10223 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10224 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10225 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10226
10227 @itemize @bullet
10228 @item
10229 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10230 enumerated tag.
10231
10232 @item
10233 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10234 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10235
10236 @ignore
10237 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10238 @c FIXME--beers?
10239 @item
10240 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10241 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10242 compilers.)
10243 @end ignore
10244 @end itemize
10245
10246 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10247 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10248 that is not itself an array.
10249
10250 @node Debugging C
10251 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10252
10253 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10254 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10255 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10256 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10257
10258 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10259 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10260 ,Expressions}.
10261
10262 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10263 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10264
10265 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10266
10267 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10268 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10269
10270 @table @code
10271 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10272 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10273 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10274 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10275 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10276 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10277
10278 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10279 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10280 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10281 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10282 classes.
10283 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10284
10285 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10286 @item catch throw
10287 @itemx catch catch
10288 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10289 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10290
10291 @cindex inheritance
10292 @item ptype @var{typename}
10293 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10294 @var{typename}.
10295 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10296
10297 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10298 @item set print demangle
10299 @itemx show print demangle
10300 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10301 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10302 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10303 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10304 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10305
10306 @item set print object
10307 @itemx show print object
10308 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10309 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10310
10311 @item set print vtbl
10312 @itemx show print vtbl
10313 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10314 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10315 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10316 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10317
10318 @kindex set overload-resolution
10319 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10320 @item set overload-resolution on
10321 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10322 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10323 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10324 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10325 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10326 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10327
10328 @item set overload-resolution off
10329 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10330 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10331 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10332 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10333 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10334 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10335 argument types.
10336
10337 @kindex show overload-resolution
10338 @item show overload-resolution
10339 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10340
10341 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10342 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10343 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10344 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10345 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10346 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10347 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10348 @end table
10349
10350 @node Decimal Floating Point
10351 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10352 @cindex decimal floating point format
10353
10354 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10355 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10356 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10357 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10358
10359 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10360 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10361 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10362 target.
10363
10364 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10365 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10366 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10367
10368 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10369 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10370 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10371
10372 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10373 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10374 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10375
10376 @node Objective-C
10377 @subsection Objective-C
10378
10379 @cindex Objective-C
10380 This section provides information about some commands and command
10381 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10382 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10383 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10384
10385 @menu
10386 * Method Names in Commands::
10387 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10388 @end menu
10389
10390 @node Method Names in Commands
10391 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10392
10393 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10394 names as line specifications:
10395
10396 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10397 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10398 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10399 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10400 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10401 @itemize
10402 @item @code{clear}
10403 @item @code{break}
10404 @item @code{info line}
10405 @item @code{jump}
10406 @item @code{list}
10407 @end itemize
10408
10409 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10410
10411 @smallexample
10412 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10413 @end smallexample
10414
10415 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10416 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10417 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10418 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10419 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10420 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10421 debugged, enter:
10422
10423 @smallexample
10424 break -[Fruit create]
10425 @end smallexample
10426
10427 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10428 enter:
10429
10430 @smallexample
10431 list +[NSText initialize]
10432 @end smallexample
10433
10434 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10435 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10436 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10437 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10438
10439 @smallexample
10440 break create
10441 @end smallexample
10442
10443 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10444 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10445 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10446 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10447 none apply.
10448
10449 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10450 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10451
10452 @smallexample
10453 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10454 @end smallexample
10455
10456 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10457 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10458 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10459 @kindex print-object
10460 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10461
10462 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 print -[@var{object} hash]
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10469 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10470 @noindent
10471 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10472 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10473 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10474 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10475 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10476 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10477
10478 @node Fortran
10479 @subsection Fortran
10480 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10481
10482 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10483 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10484
10485 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10486 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10487 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10488 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10489 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10490 underscore.
10491
10492 @menu
10493 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10494 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10495 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10496 @end menu
10497
10498 @node Fortran Operators
10499 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10500
10501 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10502
10503 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10504 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10505 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10506
10507 @table @code
10508 @item **
10509 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10510 of the second one.
10511
10512 @item :
10513 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10514 represent a section of array.
10515
10516 @item %
10517 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10518 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10519 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10520 union type.
10521 @end table
10522
10523 @node Fortran Defaults
10524 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10525
10526 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10527
10528 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10529 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10530 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10531 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10532
10533 @node Special Fortran Commands
10534 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10535
10536 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10537
10538 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10539 such as displaying common blocks.
10540
10541 @table @code
10542 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10543 @kindex info common
10544 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10545 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10546 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10547 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10548 printed.
10549 @end table
10550
10551 @node Pascal
10552 @subsection Pascal
10553
10554 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10555 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10556 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10557 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10558 syntax.
10559
10560 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10561 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10562 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10563
10564 @node Modula-2
10565 @subsection Modula-2
10566
10567 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10568
10569 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10570 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10571 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10572 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10573 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10574 table.
10575
10576 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10577 @menu
10578 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10579 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10580 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10581 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10582 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10583 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10584 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10585 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10586 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10587 @end menu
10588
10589 @node M2 Operators
10590 @subsubsection Operators
10591 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10592
10593 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10594 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10595 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10596 following definitions hold:
10597
10598 @itemize @bullet
10599
10600 @item
10601 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10602 their subranges.
10603
10604 @item
10605 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10606
10607 @item
10608 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10609
10610 @item
10611 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10612 @var{type}}.
10613
10614 @item
10615 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10616
10617 @item
10618 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10619
10620 @item
10621 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10622 @end itemize
10623
10624 @noindent
10625 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10626 increasing precedence:
10627
10628 @table @code
10629 @item ,
10630 Function argument or array index separator.
10631
10632 @item :=
10633 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10634 @var{value}.
10635
10636 @item <@r{, }>
10637 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10638 types.
10639
10640 @item <=@r{, }>=
10641 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10642 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10643 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10644
10645 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10646 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10647 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10648 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10649 comment character.
10650
10651 @item IN
10652 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10653 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10654
10655 @item OR
10656 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10657
10658 @item AND@r{, }&
10659 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10660
10661 @item @@
10662 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10663
10664 @item +@r{, }-
10665 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10666 and difference on set types.
10667
10668 @item *
10669 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10670 on set types.
10671
10672 @item /
10673 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10674 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10675
10676 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10677 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10678 precedence as @code{*}.
10679
10680 @item -
10681 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10682
10683 @item ^
10684 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10685
10686 @item NOT
10687 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10688 @code{^}.
10689
10690 @item .
10691 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10692 precedence as @code{^}.
10693
10694 @item []
10695 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10696
10697 @item ()
10698 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10699 as @code{^}.
10700
10701 @item ::@r{, }.
10702 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10703 @end table
10704
10705 @quotation
10706 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10707 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10708 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10709 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10710 @end quotation
10711
10712
10713 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10714 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10715 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10716
10717 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10718 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10719
10720 @table @var
10721
10722 @item a
10723 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10724
10725 @item c
10726 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10727
10728 @item i
10729 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10730
10731 @item m
10732 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10733 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10734 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10735
10736 @item n
10737 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10738
10739 @item r
10740 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10741
10742 @item t
10743 represents a type.
10744
10745 @item v
10746 represents a variable.
10747
10748 @item x
10749 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10750 explanation of the function for details.
10751 @end table
10752
10753 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10754
10755 @table @code
10756 @item ABS(@var{n})
10757 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10758
10759 @item CAP(@var{c})
10760 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10761 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10762
10763 @item CHR(@var{i})
10764 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10765
10766 @item DEC(@var{v})
10767 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10768
10769 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10770 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10771 new value.
10772
10773 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10774 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10775 set.
10776
10777 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10778 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10779
10780 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10781 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10782
10783 @item INC(@var{v})
10784 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10785
10786 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10787 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10788 new value.
10789
10790 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10791 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10792 there. Returns the new set.
10793
10794 @item MAX(@var{t})
10795 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10796
10797 @item MIN(@var{t})
10798 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10799
10800 @item ODD(@var{i})
10801 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10802
10803 @item ORD(@var{x})
10804 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10805 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10806 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10807 integral, character and enumerated types.
10808
10809 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10810 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10811
10812 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10813 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10814
10815 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10816 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10817
10818 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10819 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10820 @end table
10821
10822 @quotation
10823 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10824 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10825 an error.
10826 @end quotation
10827
10828 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10829 @node M2 Constants
10830 @subsubsection Constants
10831
10832 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10833 ways:
10834
10835 @itemize @bullet
10836
10837 @item
10838 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10839 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10840 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10841 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10842
10843 @item
10844 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10845 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10846 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10847 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10848 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10849 digits.
10850
10851 @item
10852 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10853 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10854 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10855 followed by a @samp{C}.
10856
10857 @item
10858 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10859 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10860 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10861 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10862 sequences.
10863
10864 @item
10865 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10866
10867 @item
10868 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10869 @code{FALSE}.
10870
10871 @item
10872 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10873
10874 @item
10875 Set constants are not yet supported.
10876 @end itemize
10877
10878 @node M2 Types
10879 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10880 @cindex Modula-2 types
10881
10882 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10883 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10884 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10885 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10886 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10887 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10888
10889 The first example contains the following section of code:
10890
10891 @smallexample
10892 VAR
10893 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10894 r: [20..40] ;
10895 @end smallexample
10896
10897 @noindent
10898 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10899 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10900
10901 @smallexample
10902 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10903 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10904 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10905 SET OF CHAR
10906 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10907 21
10908 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10909 [20..40]
10910 @end smallexample
10911
10912 @noindent
10913 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10914
10915 @smallexample
10916 VAR
10917 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10918 @end smallexample
10919
10920 @noindent
10921 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10922
10923 @smallexample
10924 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10925 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10926 @end smallexample
10927
10928 @noindent
10929 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10930 expressions using the debugger.
10931
10932 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10933 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10934
10935 @smallexample
10936 VAR
10937 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10938 @end smallexample
10939
10940 @smallexample
10941 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10942 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10943 @end smallexample
10944
10945 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10946 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10947 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10948 above.
10949
10950 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10951
10952 @smallexample
10953 TYPE
10954 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10955 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10956 VAR
10957 s: t ;
10958 BEGIN
10959 s := blue ;
10960 @end smallexample
10961
10962 @noindent
10963 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10964 and value of a variable.
10965
10966 @smallexample
10967 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10968 $1 = blue
10969 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10970 type = [blue..yellow]
10971 @end smallexample
10972
10973 @noindent
10974 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10975 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10976 their @code{C} counterparts.
10977
10978 @smallexample
10979 VAR
10980 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10981 BEGIN
10982 s[1] := 1 ;
10983 @end smallexample
10984
10985 @smallexample
10986 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10987 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10988 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10989 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10990 @end smallexample
10991
10992 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10993 pointer types as shown in this example:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 VAR
10997 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10998 BEGIN
10999 NEW(s) ;
11000 s^[1] := 1 ;
11001 @end smallexample
11002
11003 @noindent
11004 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11005
11006 @smallexample
11007 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11008 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11009 @end smallexample
11010
11011 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11012 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11013 types:
11014
11015 @smallexample
11016 TYPE
11017 foo = RECORD
11018 f1: CARDINAL ;
11019 f2: CHAR ;
11020 f3: myarray ;
11021 END ;
11022
11023 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11024 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11025 VAR
11026 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11027 @end smallexample
11028
11029 @noindent
11030 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11031 below.
11032
11033 @smallexample
11034 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11035 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11036 f1 : CARDINAL;
11037 f2 : CHAR;
11038 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11039 END
11040 @end smallexample
11041
11042 @node M2 Defaults
11043 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11044 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11045
11046 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11047 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11048 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11049 selected the working language.
11050
11051 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11052 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11053 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11054 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11055
11056 @node Deviations
11057 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11058 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11059
11060 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11061 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11062
11063 @itemize @bullet
11064 @item
11065 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11066 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11067 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11068 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11069 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11070 returned a pointer.)
11071
11072 @item
11073 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11074 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11075 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11076 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11077
11078 @item
11079 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11080 argument.
11081
11082 @item
11083 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11084 @end itemize
11085
11086 @node M2 Checks
11087 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11088 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11089
11090 @quotation
11091 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11092 range checking.
11093 @end quotation
11094 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11095
11096 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11097
11098 @itemize @bullet
11099 @item
11100 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11101 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11102
11103 @item
11104 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11105 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11106 @end itemize
11107
11108 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11109 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11110
11111 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11112 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11113
11114 @node M2 Scope
11115 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11116 @cindex scope
11117 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11118 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11119 @ifinfo
11120 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11121 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11122 @end ifinfo
11123 @ifnotinfo
11124 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11125 @end ifnotinfo
11126
11127 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11128 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11129 similar syntax:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132
11133 @var{module} . @var{id}
11134 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11135 @end smallexample
11136
11137 @noindent
11138 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11139 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11140 identifier within your program, except another module.
11141
11142 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11143 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11144 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11145 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11146
11147 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11148 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11149 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11150 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11151 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11152 @var{module}.
11153
11154 @node GDB/M2
11155 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11156
11157 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11158 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11159 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11160 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11161 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11162 analogue in Modula-2.
11163
11164 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11165 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11166 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11167 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11168 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11169 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11170
11171 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11172 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11173 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11174
11175 @node Ada
11176 @subsection Ada
11177 @cindex Ada
11178
11179 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11180 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11181 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11182 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11183 to be difficult.
11184
11185
11186 @cindex expressions in Ada
11187 @menu
11188 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11189 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11190 in @value{GDBN}.
11191 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11192 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11193 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11194 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11195 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11196 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11197 @end menu
11198
11199 @node Ada Mode Intro
11200 @subsubsection Introduction
11201 @cindex Ada mode, general
11202
11203 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11204 syntax, with some extensions.
11205 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11206
11207 @itemize @bullet
11208 @item
11209 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11210 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11211 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11212 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11213
11214 @item
11215 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11216 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11217
11218 @item
11219 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11220 @end itemize
11221
11222 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11223 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11224 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11225 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11226 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11227
11228 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11229 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11230 was translated from an Ada source file.
11231
11232 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11233 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11234 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11235 middle (to allow based literals).
11236
11237 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11238 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11239 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11240 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11241 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11242 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11243
11244 @node Omissions from Ada
11245 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11246 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11247
11248 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11249
11250 @itemize @bullet
11251 @item
11252 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11253
11254 @itemize @minus
11255 @item
11256 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11257 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11258
11259 @item
11260 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11261
11262 @item
11263 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11264
11265 @item
11266 @t{'Tag}.
11267
11268 @item
11269 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11270 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11271
11272 @item
11273 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11274 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11275
11276 @item
11277 @t{'Address}.
11278 @end itemize
11279
11280 @item
11281 The names in
11282 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11283 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11284 not currently available.
11285
11286 @item
11287 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11288 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11289 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11290 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11291 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11292 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11293 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11294 indeterminate values.
11295
11296 @item
11297 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11298 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11299 are not implemented.
11300
11301 @item
11302 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11303 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11304 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11305 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11306 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11307
11308 @smallexample
11309 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11310 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11311 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11312 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11313 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11314 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11315 @end smallexample
11316
11317 Changing a
11318 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11319 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11320 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11321 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11322 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11323 declared to have a type such as:
11324
11325 @smallexample
11326 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11327 Id : Integer;
11328 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11329 end record;
11330 @end smallexample
11331
11332 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11333 assignments:
11334
11335 @smallexample
11336 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11337 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11338 @end smallexample
11339
11340 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11341 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11342 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11343 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11344 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11345 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11346 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11347 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11348
11349 @item
11350 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11351
11352 @item
11353 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11354 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11355 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11356 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11357 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11358 the proper resolution.
11359
11360 @item
11361 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11362
11363 @item
11364 Entry calls are not implemented.
11365
11366 @item
11367 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11368 formats are not supported.
11369
11370 @item
11371 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11372
11373 @item
11374 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11375 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11376 context.
11377 Should your program
11378 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11379 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11380 @end itemize
11381
11382 @node Additions to Ada
11383 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11384 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11385
11386 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11387 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11388
11389 @itemize @bullet
11390 @item
11391 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11392 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11393 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11394 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11395 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11396 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11397 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11398 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11399
11400 @item
11401 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11402 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11403 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11404
11405 @item
11406 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11407 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11408
11409 @item
11410 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11411 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11412 @end itemize
11413
11414 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11415 additions specific to Ada:
11416
11417 @itemize @bullet
11418 @item
11419 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11420 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11421
11422 @smallexample
11423 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11424 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11425 @end smallexample
11426
11427 @item
11428 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11429 the value of its right-hand operand.
11430 This allows, for example,
11431 complex conditional breaks:
11432
11433 @smallexample
11434 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11435 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11436 @end smallexample
11437
11438 @item
11439 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11440 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11441 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11442 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11443 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11444 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11445 in strings. For example,
11446 @smallexample
11447 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11448 @end smallexample
11449 @noindent
11450 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11451 after each period.
11452
11453 @item
11454 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11455 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11456 to write
11457
11458 @smallexample
11459 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11460 @end smallexample
11461
11462 @item
11463 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11464 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11465 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11466 of 3 might print as
11467
11468 @smallexample
11469 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11470 @end smallexample
11471
11472 @noindent
11473 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11474 clause.
11475
11476 @item
11477 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11478 multi-character subsequence of
11479 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11480 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11481 in place of @t{a'length}.
11482
11483 @item
11484 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11485 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11486 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11487 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11488 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11489 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11490 For example,
11491 @smallexample
11492 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11493 @end smallexample
11494
11495 @item
11496 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11497 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11498 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11499 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11500 object.
11501
11502 @end itemize
11503
11504 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11505 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11506
11507 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11508 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11509 before reaching the main procedure.
11510 As defined in the Ada Reference
11511 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11512 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11513 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11514 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11515
11516 @node Ada Tasks
11517 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
11518 @cindex Ada, tasking
11519
11520 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
11521 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
11522
11523 @table @code
11524 @kindex info tasks
11525 @item info tasks
11526 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
11527
11528
11529 @smallexample
11530 @iftex
11531 @leftskip=0.5cm
11532 @end iftex
11533 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11534 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11535 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11536 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
11537 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
11538 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Running c
11539
11540 @end smallexample
11541
11542 @noindent
11543 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
11544 task currently being inspected.
11545
11546 @table @asis
11547 @item ID
11548 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
11549
11550 @item TID
11551 The Ada task ID.
11552
11553 @item P-ID
11554 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
11555
11556 @item Pri
11557 The base priority of the task.
11558
11559 @item State
11560 Current state of the task.
11561
11562 @table @code
11563 @item Unactivated
11564 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
11565 executing.
11566
11567 @item Running
11568 The task currently running.
11569
11570 @item Runnable
11571 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
11572 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
11573
11574 @item Terminated
11575 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
11576 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
11577 terminated themselves.
11578
11579 @item Child Activation Wait
11580 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
11581
11582 @item Accept Statement
11583 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
11584
11585 @item Waiting on entry call
11586 The task is waiting on an entry call.
11587
11588 @item Async Select Wait
11589 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
11590 select statement.
11591
11592 @item Delay Sleep
11593 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
11594 alternative open.
11595
11596 @item Child Termination Wait
11597 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
11598 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
11599 waiting on a terminate Phase.
11600
11601 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
11602 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
11603 finish terminating.
11604
11605 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
11606 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
11607 @end table
11608
11609 @item Name
11610 Name of the task in the program.
11611
11612 @end table
11613
11614 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
11615 @item info task @var{taskno}
11616 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
11617 the following example:
11618 @smallexample
11619 @iftex
11620 @leftskip=0.5cm
11621 @end iftex
11622 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11623 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11624 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11625 * 2 807c468 1 15 Running task_1
11626 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
11627 Ada Task: 0x807c468
11628 Name: task_1
11629 Thread: 0x807f378
11630 Parent: 1 (main_task)
11631 Base Priority: 15
11632 State: Runnable
11633 @end smallexample
11634
11635 @item task
11636 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
11637 @cindex current Ada task ID
11638 This command prints the ID of the current task.
11639
11640 @smallexample
11641 @iftex
11642 @leftskip=0.5cm
11643 @end iftex
11644 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11645 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11646 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11647 * 2 807c458 1 15 Running t
11648 (@value{GDBP}) task
11649 [Current task is 2]
11650 @end smallexample
11651
11652 @item task @var{taskno}
11653 @cindex Ada task switching
11654 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
11655 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
11656 from the current task to the given task.
11657
11658 @smallexample
11659 @iftex
11660 @leftskip=0.5cm
11661 @end iftex
11662 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11663 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11664 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11665 * 2 807c458 1 15 Running t
11666 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
11667 [Switching to task 1]
11668 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11669 (@value{GDBP}) bt
11670 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11671 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
11672 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
11673 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
11674 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
11675 @end smallexample
11676
11677 @end table
11678
11679 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
11680 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11681 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
11682
11683 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
11684 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
11685 the platform being used.
11686 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
11687 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
11688 as usual.
11689
11690 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
11691 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
11692 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
11693 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
11694 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
11695 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
11696
11697 @node Ada Glitches
11698 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11699 @cindex Ada, problems
11700
11701 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11702 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11703 @value{GDBN},
11704 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11705 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11706
11707 @itemize @bullet
11708 @item
11709 Currently, the debugger
11710 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11711 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11712 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11713 to get it printed properly.
11714
11715 @item
11716 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11717 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11718
11719 @item
11720 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11721 argument lists are treated as positional).
11722
11723 @item
11724 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11725
11726 @item
11727 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11728 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11729 the host machine.
11730
11731 @item
11732 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11733 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11734 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11735 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11736 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11737 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11738 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11739 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11740 you can usually resolve the confusion
11741 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11742 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11743 @end itemize
11744
11745 @node Unsupported Languages
11746 @section Unsupported Languages
11747
11748 @cindex unsupported languages
11749 @cindex minimal language
11750 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11751 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11752 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11753 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11754 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11755 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11756
11757 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11758 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11759 language.
11760
11761 @node Symbols
11762 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11763
11764 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11765 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11766 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11767 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11768 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11769 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11770 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11771
11772 @cindex symbol names
11773 @cindex names of symbols
11774 @cindex quoting names
11775 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11776 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11777 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11778 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11779 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11780 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11781 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11782 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11783
11784 @smallexample
11785 p 'foo.c'::x
11786 @end smallexample
11787
11788 @noindent
11789 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11790
11791 @table @code
11792 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11793 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11794 @kindex set case-sensitive
11795 @item set case-sensitive on
11796 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11797 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11798 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11799 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11800 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11801 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11802 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11803 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11804 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11805 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11806 case-insensitive matches.
11807
11808 @kindex show case-sensitive
11809 @item show case-sensitive
11810 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11811 lookups.
11812
11813 @kindex info address
11814 @cindex address of a symbol
11815 @item info address @var{symbol}
11816 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11817 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11818 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11819 is always stored.
11820
11821 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11822 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11823 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11824
11825 @kindex info symbol
11826 @cindex symbol from address
11827 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11828 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11829 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11830 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11831 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11832
11833 @smallexample
11834 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11835 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11836 @end smallexample
11837
11838 @noindent
11839 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11840 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11841
11842 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
11843 library containing the symbol is also printed:
11844
11845 @smallexample
11846 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
11847 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
11848 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
11849 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
11850 @end smallexample
11851
11852 @kindex whatis
11853 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11854 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11855 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11856 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11857 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11858 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11859 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11860 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11861 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11862 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11863 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11864
11865 @kindex ptype
11866 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11867 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11868 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11869 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11870
11871 For example, for this variable declaration:
11872
11873 @smallexample
11874 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11875 @end smallexample
11876
11877 @noindent
11878 the two commands give this output:
11879
11880 @smallexample
11881 @group
11882 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11883 type = struct complex
11884 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11885 type = struct complex @{
11886 double real;
11887 double imag;
11888 @}
11889 @end group
11890 @end smallexample
11891
11892 @noindent
11893 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11894 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11895
11896 @cindex incomplete type
11897 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11898 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11899 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11900 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11901 given these declarations:
11902
11903 @smallexample
11904 struct foo;
11905 struct foo *fooptr;
11906 @end smallexample
11907
11908 @noindent
11909 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11910
11911 @smallexample
11912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11913 $1 = <incomplete type>
11914 @end smallexample
11915
11916 @noindent
11917 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11918 completely specified.
11919
11920 @kindex info types
11921 @item info types @var{regexp}
11922 @itemx info types
11923 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11924 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11925 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11926 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11927 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11928 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11929 name is @code{value}.
11930
11931 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11932 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11933 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11934
11935 @kindex info scope
11936 @cindex local variables
11937 @item info scope @var{location}
11938 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11939 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11940 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11941 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11942 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11943
11944 @smallexample
11945 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11946 Scope for command_line_handler:
11947 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11948 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11949 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11950 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11951 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11952 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11953 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11954 @end smallexample
11955
11956 @noindent
11957 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11958 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11959 collect}.
11960
11961 @kindex info source
11962 @item info source
11963 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11964 the function containing the current point of execution:
11965 @itemize @bullet
11966 @item
11967 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11968 @item
11969 the directory it was compiled in,
11970 @item
11971 its length, in lines,
11972 @item
11973 which programming language it is written in,
11974 @item
11975 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11976 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11977 @item
11978 whether the debugging information includes information about
11979 preprocessor macros.
11980 @end itemize
11981
11982
11983 @kindex info sources
11984 @item info sources
11985 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11986 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11987 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11988
11989 @kindex info functions
11990 @item info functions
11991 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11992
11993 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11994 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11995 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11996 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11997 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11998 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11999 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12000 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12001
12002 @kindex info variables
12003 @item info variables
12004 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12005 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12006
12007 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12008 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12009 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12010 @var{regexp}.
12011
12012 @kindex info classes
12013 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12014 @item info classes
12015 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12016 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12017 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12018 expression.
12019
12020 @kindex info selectors
12021 @item info selectors
12022 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12023 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12024 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12025 expression.
12026
12027 @ignore
12028 This was never implemented.
12029 @kindex info methods
12030 @item info methods
12031 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12032 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12033 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12034 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12035 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12036 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12037 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12038 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12039 @end ignore
12040
12041 @cindex reloading symbols
12042 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12043 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12044 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12045 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12046 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12047
12048 @table @code
12049 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12050 @item set symbol-reloading on
12051 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12052 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12053
12054 @item set symbol-reloading off
12055 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12056 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12057 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12058 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12059 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12060 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12061 name.
12062
12063 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12064 @item show symbol-reloading
12065 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12066 @end table
12067
12068 @cindex opaque data types
12069 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12070 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12071 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12072 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12073 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12074 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12075 another source file. The default is on.
12076
12077 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12078 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12079
12080 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12081 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12082 is printed as follows:
12083 @smallexample
12084 @{<no data fields>@}
12085 @end smallexample
12086
12087 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12088 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12089 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12090
12091 @kindex set print symbol-loading
12092 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
12093 @item set print symbol-loading
12094 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
12095 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
12096 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
12097 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12098 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
12099 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
12100 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
12101 annoying than useful.
12102
12103 @kindex show print symbol-loading
12104 @item show print symbol-loading
12105 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12106
12107 @kindex maint print symbols
12108 @cindex symbol dump
12109 @kindex maint print psymbols
12110 @cindex partial symbol dump
12111 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12112 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12113 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12114 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12115 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12116 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12117 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12118 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12119 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12120 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12121 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12122 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12123 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12124 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12125 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12126 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12127 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12128
12129 @kindex maint info symtabs
12130 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12131 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12132 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12133 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12134 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12135 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12136 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12137
12138 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12139 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12140 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12141 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12142 structure in more detail. For example:
12143
12144 @smallexample
12145 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12146 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12147 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12148 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12149 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12150 readin no
12151 fullname (null)
12152 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12153 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12154 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12155 dependencies (none)
12156 @}
12157 @}
12158 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12159 (@value{GDBP})
12160 @end smallexample
12161 @noindent
12162 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12163 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12164 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12165 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12166 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12167
12168 @smallexample
12169 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12170 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12171 line 1574.
12172 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12173 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12174 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12175 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12176 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12177 dirname (null)
12178 fullname (null)
12179 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12180 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12181 debugformat DWARF 2
12182 @}
12183 @}
12184 (@value{GDBP})
12185 @end smallexample
12186 @end table
12187
12188
12189 @node Altering
12190 @chapter Altering Execution
12191
12192 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12193 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12194 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12195 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12196 program.
12197
12198 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12199 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12200 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12201
12202 @menu
12203 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12204 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12205 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12206 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12207 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12208 * Patching:: Patching your program
12209 @end menu
12210
12211 @node Assignment
12212 @section Assignment to Variables
12213
12214 @cindex assignment
12215 @cindex setting variables
12216 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12217 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12218
12219 @smallexample
12220 print x=4
12221 @end smallexample
12222
12223 @noindent
12224 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12225 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12226 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12227 information on operators in supported languages.
12228
12229 @kindex set variable
12230 @cindex variables, setting
12231 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12232 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12233 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12234 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12235 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12236
12237 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12238 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12239 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12240 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12241 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12242 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12243 command @code{set width}:
12244
12245 @smallexample
12246 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12247 type = double
12248 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12249 $4 = 13
12250 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12251 Invalid syntax in expression.
12252 @end smallexample
12253
12254 @noindent
12255 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12256 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12257
12258 @smallexample
12259 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12260 @end smallexample
12261
12262 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12263 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12264 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12265 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12266 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12267 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12268
12269 @smallexample
12270 @group
12271 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12272 type = double
12273 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12274 $1 = 1
12275 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12276 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12277 $2 = 1
12278 (@value{GDBP}) r
12279 The program being debugged has been started already.
12280 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12281 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12282 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12283 Invalid bfd target.
12284 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12285 The current BFD target is "=4".
12286 @end group
12287 @end smallexample
12288
12289 @noindent
12290 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12291 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12292 @code{g}, use
12293
12294 @smallexample
12295 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12296 @end smallexample
12297
12298 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12299 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12300 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12301 same length or shorter.
12302 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12303 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12304
12305 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12306 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12307 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12308 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12309 and representation in memory), and
12310
12311 @smallexample
12312 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12313 @end smallexample
12314
12315 @noindent
12316 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12317
12318 @node Jumping
12319 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12320
12321 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12322 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12323 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12324
12325 @table @code
12326 @kindex jump
12327 @item jump @var{linespec}
12328 @itemx jump @var{location}
12329 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12330 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12331 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12332 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12333 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12334 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12335
12336 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12337 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12338 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12339 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12340 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12341 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12342 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12343 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12344 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12345 @end table
12346
12347 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12348 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12349 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12350 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12351 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12352 example,
12353
12354 @smallexample
12355 set $pc = 0x485
12356 @end smallexample
12357
12358 @noindent
12359 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12360 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12361 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12362
12363 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12364 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12365 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12366 detail.
12367
12368 @c @group
12369 @node Signaling
12370 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12371 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12372
12373 @table @code
12374 @kindex signal
12375 @item signal @var{signal}
12376 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12377 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12378 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12379 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12380
12381 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12382 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12383 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12384 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12385 signal.
12386
12387 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12388 after executing the command.
12389 @end table
12390 @c @end group
12391
12392 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12393 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12394 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12395 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12396 passes the signal directly to your program.
12397
12398
12399 @node Returning
12400 @section Returning from a Function
12401
12402 @table @code
12403 @cindex returning from a function
12404 @kindex return
12405 @item return
12406 @itemx return @var{expression}
12407 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12408 command. If you give an
12409 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12410 value.
12411 @end table
12412
12413 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12414 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12415 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12416 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12417
12418 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12419 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12420 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12421 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12422 of functions.
12423
12424 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12425 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12426 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12427 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12428 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12429
12430 @node Calling
12431 @section Calling Program Functions
12432
12433 @table @code
12434 @cindex calling functions
12435 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12436 @item print @var{expr}
12437 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12438 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12439 debugged.
12440
12441 @kindex call
12442 @item call @var{expr}
12443 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12444 returned values.
12445
12446 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12447 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12448 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12449 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12450 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12451 value history.
12452 @end table
12453
12454 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12455 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12456 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12457 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12458
12459 @table @code
12460 @item set unwindonsignal
12461 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12462 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12463 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12464 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12465 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12466 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12467 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12468 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12469 received.
12470
12471 @item show unwindonsignal
12472 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12473 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12474 @value{GDBN}.
12475 @end table
12476
12477 @cindex weak alias functions
12478 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12479 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12480 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12481 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12482 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12483 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12484 function instead.
12485
12486 @node Patching
12487 @section Patching Programs
12488
12489 @cindex patching binaries
12490 @cindex writing into executables
12491 @cindex writing into corefiles
12492
12493 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12494 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12495 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12496 patching your program's binary.
12497
12498 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12499 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12500 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12501 repairs.
12502
12503 @table @code
12504 @kindex set write
12505 @item set write on
12506 @itemx set write off
12507 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12508 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
12509 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12510
12511 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12512 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12513 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12514
12515 @item show write
12516 @kindex show write
12517 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12518 as well as reading.
12519 @end table
12520
12521 @node GDB Files
12522 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12523
12524 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12525 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12526 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12527 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12528
12529 @menu
12530 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12531 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12532 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12533 @end menu
12534
12535 @node Files
12536 @section Commands to Specify Files
12537
12538 @cindex symbol table
12539 @cindex core dump file
12540
12541 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12542 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12543 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12544 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12545
12546 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12547 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12548 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12549 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12550 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12551 new files are useful.
12552
12553 @table @code
12554 @cindex executable file
12555 @kindex file
12556 @item file @var{filename}
12557 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12558 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12559 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12560 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12561 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12562 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12563 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12564 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12565
12566 @cindex unlinked object files
12567 @cindex patching object files
12568 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12569 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12570 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12571 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12572 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12573 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12574 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12575 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12576
12577 @item file
12578 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12579 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12580
12581 @kindex exec-file
12582 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12583 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12584 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12585 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12586 discard information on the executable file.
12587
12588 @kindex symbol-file
12589 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12590 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12591 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12592 table and program to run from the same file.
12593
12594 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12595 program's symbol table.
12596
12597 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12598 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12599 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12600 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12601 @value{GDBN}.
12602
12603 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12604 executing it once.
12605
12606 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12607 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12608 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12609 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12610 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12611 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12612 optimized code.
12613
12614 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12615 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12616 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12617 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12618 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12619
12620 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12621 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12622 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12623 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12624 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12625 Warnings and Messages}.)
12626
12627 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12628 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12629 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12630 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12631 in stabs format.
12632
12633 @kindex readnow
12634 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12635 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12636 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12637 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12638 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12639 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12640 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12641 entire symbol table available.
12642
12643 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12644 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12645 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12646 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12647 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12648 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12649 @c files.
12650
12651 @kindex core-file
12652 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12653 @itemx core
12654 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12655 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12656 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12657 executable file itself for other parts.
12658
12659 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12660 to be used.
12661
12662 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12663 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12664 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12665 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12666 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12667
12668 @kindex add-symbol-file
12669 @cindex dynamic linking
12670 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12671 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12672 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12673 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12674 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12675 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12676 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12677 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12678 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12679 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12680 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12681 @var{address} as an expression.
12682
12683 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12684 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12685 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12686 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12687 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12688
12689 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12690 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12691 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12692 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12693 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12694 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12695 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12696 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12697 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12698
12699 @itemize @bullet
12700 @item
12701 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12702 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12703 @item
12704 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12705 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12706 @item
12707 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12708 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12709 @end itemize
12710
12711 @noindent
12712 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12713 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12714 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12715 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12716 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12717 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12718 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12719 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12720 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12721 way.
12722
12723 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12724
12725 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12726 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12727 @cindex load symbols from memory
12728 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12729 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12730 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12731 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12732 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12733 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12734 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12735 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12736 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12737
12738 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12739 @kindex assf
12740 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12741 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12742 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12743 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12744 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12745 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12746 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12747 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12748 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12749 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12750
12751 @kindex section
12752 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12753 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12754 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12755 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12756 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12757 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12758 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12759 their addresses.
12760
12761 @kindex info files
12762 @kindex info target
12763 @item info files
12764 @itemx info target
12765 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12766 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12767 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12768 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12769 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12770 current ones.
12771
12772 @kindex maint info sections
12773 @item maint info sections
12774 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12775 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12776 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12777 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12778 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12779 may be arbitrarily combined):
12780
12781 @table @code
12782 @item ALLOBJ
12783 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12784 @item @var{sections}
12785 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12786 @item @var{section-flags}
12787 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12788 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12789 @table @code
12790 @item ALLOC
12791 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12792 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12793 @item LOAD
12794 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12795 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12796 @item RELOC
12797 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12798 @item READONLY
12799 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12800 @item CODE
12801 Section contains executable code only.
12802 @item DATA
12803 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12804 @item ROM
12805 Section will reside in ROM.
12806 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12807 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12808 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12809 Section is not empty.
12810 @item NEVER_LOAD
12811 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12812 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12813 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12814 COFF shared library information.
12815 @item IS_COMMON
12816 Section contains common symbols.
12817 @end table
12818 @end table
12819 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12820 @cindex read-only sections
12821 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12822 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12823 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12824 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12825 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12826 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12827 enhancement to debugging performance.
12828
12829 The default is off.
12830
12831 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12832 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12833 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12834 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12835
12836 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12837 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12838 @end table
12839
12840 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12841 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12842 name and remembers it that way.
12843
12844 @cindex shared libraries
12845 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12846 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12847 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12848
12849 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12850 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12851
12852 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12853 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12854 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12855 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12856 debugging a core file).
12857
12858 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12859 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12860
12861 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12862 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12863 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12864
12865 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12866 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12867 particularly large or there are many of them.
12868
12869 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12870 commands:
12871
12872 @table @code
12873 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12874 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12875 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12876 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12877 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12878 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12879 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12880 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12881
12882 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12883 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12884 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12885 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12886 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12887 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12888 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12889 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12890 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12891
12892 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12893 @item show auto-solib-add
12894 Display the current autoloading mode.
12895 @end table
12896
12897 @cindex load shared library
12898 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12899 command:
12900
12901 @table @code
12902 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12903 @kindex info share
12904 @item info share
12905 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12906 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12907
12908 @kindex sharedlibrary
12909 @kindex share
12910 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12911 @itemx share @var{regex}
12912 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12913 Unix regular expression.
12914 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12915 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12916 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12917 loaded.
12918
12919 @item nosharedlibrary
12920 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12921 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12922 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12923 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12924 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12925 discarded.
12926 @end table
12927
12928 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12929 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12930 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12931
12932 @table @code
12933 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12934 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12935 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12936 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12937 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12938 shared library.
12939
12940 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12941 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12942 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12943 library events happen.
12944 @end table
12945
12946 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12947 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
12948 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
12949 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
12950 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
12951 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12952 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12953 not.
12954
12955 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12956 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12957 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12958 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12959 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12960
12961 @table @code
12962 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12963 @cindex system root, alternate
12964 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12965 @kindex set sysroot
12966 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12967 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12968 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12969 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12970 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12971 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12972 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12973 under @var{path}.
12974
12975 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
12976 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
12977 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
12978 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
12979 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
12980 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
12981 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
12982 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
12983 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
12984
12985 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12986 sysroot}.
12987
12988 @cindex default system root
12989 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12990 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12991 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12992 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12993 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12994 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12995 location.
12996
12997 @kindex show sysroot
12998 @item show sysroot
12999 Display the current shared library prefix.
13000
13001 @kindex set solib-search-path
13002 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13003 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13004 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13005 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13006 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13007 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13008 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13009 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13010 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13011 of shared library symbols.
13012
13013 @kindex show solib-search-path
13014 @item show solib-search-path
13015 Display the current shared library search path.
13016 @end table
13017
13018
13019 @node Separate Debug Files
13020 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13021 @cindex separate debugging information files
13022 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13023 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13024 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13025 @cindex global debugging information directory
13026 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13027 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13028
13029 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13030 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13031 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13032 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13033 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13034 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13035 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13036
13037 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13038 file:
13039
13040 @itemize @bullet
13041 @item
13042 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13043 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13044 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13045 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13046 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13047 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
13048 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
13049 came from the same build.
13050
13051 @item
13052 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13053 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13054 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13055 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13056 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13057 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13058 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13059 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13060 below.
13061 @end itemize
13062
13063 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13064 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13065
13066 @itemize @bullet
13067 @item
13068 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13069 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13070 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13071 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13072 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13073
13074 @item
13075 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13076 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13077 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13078 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13079 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13080 hex characters, not 10.)
13081 @end itemize
13082
13083 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13084 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13085 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13086 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13087 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13088 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13089
13090 @itemize @minus
13091 @item
13092 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13093 @item
13094 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13095 @item
13096 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13097 @item
13098 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13099 @end itemize
13100
13101 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13102 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13103
13104 @table @code
13105
13106 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13107 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13108 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13109 information files to @var{directory}.
13110
13111 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13112 @item show debug-file-directory
13113 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13114 information files.
13115
13116 @end table
13117
13118 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13119 @cindex debug link sections
13120 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13121 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13122
13123 @itemize
13124 @item
13125 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13126 a zero byte,
13127 @item
13128 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13129 boundary within the section, and
13130 @item
13131 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13132 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13133 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13134 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13135 @end itemize
13136
13137 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13138 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13139 described above.
13140
13141 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13142 @cindex build ID sections
13143 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13144 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13145 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13146 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13147 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13148 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13149 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13150 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13151 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13152
13153 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13154 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13155 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13156 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13157 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13158 in an ordinary executable.
13159
13160 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13161 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13162 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13163 following commands:
13164
13165 @smallexample
13166 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13167 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13168 @end smallexample
13169
13170 @noindent
13171 These commands remove the debugging
13172 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13173 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13174 two files:
13175
13176 @itemize @bullet
13177 @item
13178 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13179 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13180
13181 @smallexample
13182 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13183 @end smallexample
13184
13185 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13186 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13187 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13188 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13189
13190 @item
13191 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13192 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13193 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13194 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13195 @end itemize
13196
13197 @noindent
13198
13199 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
13200 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
13201 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
13202 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
13203
13204 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13205 @smallexample
13206 unsigned long
13207 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13208 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13209 @{
13210 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13211 @{
13212 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13213 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13214 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13215 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13216 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13217 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13218 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13219 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13220 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13221 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13222 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13223 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13224 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13225 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13226 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13227 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13228 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13229 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13230 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13231 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13232 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13233 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13234 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13235 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13236 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13237 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13238 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13239 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13240 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13241 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13242 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13243 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13244 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13245 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13246 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13247 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13248 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13249 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13250 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13251 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13252 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13253 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13254 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13255 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13256 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13257 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13258 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13259 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13260 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13261 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13262 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13263 0x2d02ef8d
13264 @};
13265 unsigned char *end;
13266
13267 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13268 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13269 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13270 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13271 @}
13272 @end smallexample
13273
13274 @noindent
13275 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13276
13277
13278 @node Symbol Errors
13279 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13280
13281 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13282 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13283 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13284 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13285 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13286 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13287 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13288 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13289 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13290 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13291 Messages}).
13292
13293 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13294
13295 @table @code
13296 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13297
13298 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13299 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13300 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13301 in its outer scope blocks.
13302
13303 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13304 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13305 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13306 function.
13307
13308 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13309
13310 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13311 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13312 do so.
13313
13314 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13315 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13316 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13317 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13318 Messages}.)
13319
13320 @item bad block start address patched
13321
13322 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13323 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13324 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13325
13326 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13327 starting on the previous source line.
13328
13329 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13330
13331 @cindex foo
13332 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13333 larger than the size of the string table.
13334
13335 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13336 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13337 with this name.
13338
13339 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13340
13341 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13342 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13343 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13344
13345 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13346 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13347 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13348 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13349 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13350 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13351
13352 @item stub type has NULL name
13353
13354 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13355
13356 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13357 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13358 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13359 it.
13360
13361 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13362
13363 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13364
13365 @end table
13366
13367 @node Targets
13368 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13369
13370 @cindex debugging target
13371 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13372
13373 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13374 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13375 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13376 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13377 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13378 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13379 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13380 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13381
13382 @cindex target architecture
13383 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13384 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13385 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13386 command.
13387
13388 @table @code
13389 @kindex set architecture
13390 @kindex show architecture
13391 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13392 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13393 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13394 supported architectures.
13395
13396 @item show architecture
13397 Show the current target architecture.
13398
13399 @item set processor
13400 @itemx processor
13401 @kindex set processor
13402 @kindex show processor
13403 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13404 and @code{show architecture}.
13405 @end table
13406
13407 @menu
13408 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13409 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13410 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13411 @end menu
13412
13413 @node Active Targets
13414 @section Active Targets
13415
13416 @cindex stacking targets
13417 @cindex active targets
13418 @cindex multiple targets
13419
13420 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13421 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13422 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13423 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13424 a core file.
13425
13426 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13427 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13428 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13429 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13430 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13431 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13432 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13433 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13434 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13435
13436 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13437 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13438 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13439 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13440 process target is active.
13441
13442 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13443 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13444 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13445 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13446 Process}).
13447
13448 @node Target Commands
13449 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13450
13451 @table @code
13452 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13453 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13454 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13455 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13456 protocol of the target machine.
13457
13458 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13459 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13460 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13461
13462 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13463 after executing the command.
13464
13465 @kindex help target
13466 @item help target
13467 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13468 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13469 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13470
13471 @item help target @var{name}
13472 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13473 select it.
13474
13475 @kindex set gnutarget
13476 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13477 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13478 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13479 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13480 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13481 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13482
13483 @quotation
13484 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13485 you must know the actual BFD name.
13486 @end quotation
13487
13488 @noindent
13489 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13490
13491 @kindex show gnutarget
13492 @item show gnutarget
13493 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13494 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13495 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13496 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13497 @end table
13498
13499 @cindex common targets
13500 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13501 configuration):
13502
13503 @table @code
13504 @kindex target
13505 @item target exec @var{program}
13506 @cindex executable file target
13507 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13508 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13509
13510 @item target core @var{filename}
13511 @cindex core dump file target
13512 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13513 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13514
13515 @item target remote @var{medium}
13516 @cindex remote target
13517 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13518 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13519 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13520
13521 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13522 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13523
13524 @smallexample
13525 target remote /dev/ttya
13526 @end smallexample
13527
13528 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13529 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13530 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13531 clobbered by the download.
13532
13533 @item target sim
13534 @cindex built-in simulator target
13535 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13536 In general,
13537 @smallexample
13538 target sim
13539 load
13540 run
13541 @end smallexample
13542 @noindent
13543 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13544 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13545 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13546 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13547 Processors}.
13548
13549 @end table
13550
13551 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13552
13553 @table @code
13554
13555 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13556 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13557 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13558
13559 @end table
13560
13561 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13562 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13563
13564 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13565 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13566 various aspects of this process.
13567
13568 @table @code
13569
13570 @item set hash
13571 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13572 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13573 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13574 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13575 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13576 monitor.
13577
13578 @item show hash
13579 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13580 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13581
13582 @item set debug monitor
13583 @kindex set debug monitor
13584 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13585 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13586 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13587
13588 @item show debug monitor
13589 @kindex show debug monitor
13590 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13591 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13592 @end table
13593
13594 @table @code
13595
13596 @kindex load @var{filename}
13597 @item load @var{filename}
13598 @anchor{load}
13599 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13600 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13601 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13602 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13603 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13604 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13605
13606 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13607 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13608 target is @dots{}}''
13609
13610 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13611 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13612 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13613 specifies a fixed address.
13614 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13615
13616 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13617 load programs into flash memory.
13618
13619 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13620 @end table
13621
13622 @node Byte Order
13623 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13624
13625 @cindex choosing target byte order
13626 @cindex target byte order
13627
13628 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13629 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13630 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13631 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13632 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13633 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13634
13635 @table @code
13636 @kindex set endian
13637 @item set endian big
13638 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13639
13640 @item set endian little
13641 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13642
13643 @item set endian auto
13644 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13645 executable.
13646
13647 @item show endian
13648 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13649
13650 @end table
13651
13652 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13653 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13654 target system.
13655
13656
13657 @node Remote Debugging
13658 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13659 @cindex remote debugging
13660
13661 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13662 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13663 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13664 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13665 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13666
13667 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13668 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13669 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13670 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13671 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13672 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13673
13674 Other remote targets may be available in your
13675 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13676
13677 @menu
13678 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13679 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13680 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13681 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13682 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13683 @end menu
13684
13685 @node Connecting
13686 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13687
13688 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13689 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13690 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13691 program as the first argument.
13692
13693 @cindex @code{target remote}
13694 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13695 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13696 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13697 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13698 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13699 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13700
13701 @table @code
13702
13703 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13704 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13705 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13706 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13707
13708 @smallexample
13709 target remote /dev/ttyb
13710 @end smallexample
13711
13712 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13713 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13714 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13715 @code{target} command.
13716
13717 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13718 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13719 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13720 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13721 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13722 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13723 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13724 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13725 target.
13726
13727 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13728 @code{manyfarms}:
13729
13730 @smallexample
13731 target remote manyfarms:2828
13732 @end smallexample
13733
13734 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13735 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13736 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13737 port 1234 on your local machine:
13738
13739 @smallexample
13740 target remote :1234
13741 @end smallexample
13742 @noindent
13743
13744 Note that the colon is still required here.
13745
13746 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13747 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13748 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13749 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13750
13751 @smallexample
13752 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13753 @end smallexample
13754
13755 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13756 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13757 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13758 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13759
13760 @item target remote | @var{command}
13761 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13762 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13763 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13764 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13765 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13766 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13767 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13768 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13769
13770 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13771 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13772 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13773
13774 @end table
13775
13776 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13777 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13778 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13779 need to use @kbd{run}.
13780
13781 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13782 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13783 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13784 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13785 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13786 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13787 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13788
13789 @smallexample
13790 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13791 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13792 @end smallexample
13793
13794 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13795 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13796 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13797 goes back to waiting.
13798
13799 @table @code
13800 @kindex detach (remote)
13801 @item detach
13802 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13803 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13804 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13805 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13806 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13807
13808 @kindex disconnect
13809 @item disconnect
13810 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13811 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13812 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13813 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13814 another target.
13815
13816 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13817 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13818 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13819 @kindex monitor
13820 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13821 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13822 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13823 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13824 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13825 and implement.
13826 @end table
13827
13828 @node File Transfer
13829 @section Sending files to a remote system
13830 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13831 @cindex file transfer
13832 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13833
13834 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13835 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13836 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13837 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13838 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13839 the only way to upload or download files.
13840
13841 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13842
13843 @table @code
13844 @kindex remote put
13845 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13846 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13847 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13848
13849 @kindex remote get
13850 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13851 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13852 on the host system.
13853
13854 @kindex remote delete
13855 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13856 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13857
13858 @end table
13859
13860 @node Server
13861 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13862
13863 @kindex gdbserver
13864 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13865 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13866 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13867 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13868
13869 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13870 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13871 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13872 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13873 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13874 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13875 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13876 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13877 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13878 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13879 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13880 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13881 choice for debugging.
13882
13883 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13884 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13885 protocol.
13886
13887 @quotation
13888 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13889 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13890 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13891 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13892 @code{gdbserver}.
13893 @end quotation
13894
13895 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13896 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13897
13898 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13899 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13900 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13901 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13902 system does all the symbol handling.
13903
13904 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13905 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13906 syntax is:
13907
13908 @smallexample
13909 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13910 @end smallexample
13911
13912 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13913 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13914 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13915 @file{/dev/com1}:
13916
13917 @smallexample
13918 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13919 @end smallexample
13920
13921 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13922 with it.
13923
13924 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13925
13926 @smallexample
13927 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13928 @end smallexample
13929
13930 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13931 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13932 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13933 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13934 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13935 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13936 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13937 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13938 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13939 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13940 @code{target remote} command.
13941
13942 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13943
13944 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13945 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13946
13947 @smallexample
13948 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13949 @end smallexample
13950
13951 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13952 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13953
13954 @pindex pidof
13955 @cindex attach to a program by name
13956 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13957 @code{pidof} utility:
13958
13959 @smallexample
13960 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13961 @end smallexample
13962
13963 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13964 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13965 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13966
13967 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13968 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13969 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13970
13971 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13972 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13973 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13974 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13975
13976 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13977 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13978 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13979 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13980 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13981 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13982 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13983 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13984 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13985
13986 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13987 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13988 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13989 the program you want to debug.
13990
13991 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13992 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13993 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13994
13995 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13996
13997 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
13998 status information about the debugging process. The
13999 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
14000 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
14001 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
14002
14003 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
14004 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
14005 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
14006 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
14007
14008 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
14009 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
14010 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
14011 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
14012
14013 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14014 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14015 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14016 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14017
14018 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14019 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14020 environment:
14021
14022 @smallexample
14023 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14024 @end smallexample
14025
14026 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14027
14028 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14029
14030 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14031 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14032 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14033 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14034
14035 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14036 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14037 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14038 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14039 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14040 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14041 programs.
14042
14043 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14044 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14045 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14046 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14047 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14048 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14049 already on the target.
14050
14051 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14052 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14053 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14054
14055 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14056 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14057 Here are the available commands.
14058
14059 @table @code
14060 @item monitor help
14061 List the available monitor commands.
14062
14063 @item monitor set debug 0
14064 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14065 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14066
14067 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14068 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14069 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14070 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14071
14072 @item monitor exit
14073 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14074 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14075 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14076 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14077 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14078
14079 @end table
14080
14081 @node Remote Configuration
14082 @section Remote Configuration
14083
14084 @kindex set remote
14085 @kindex show remote
14086 This section documents the configuration options available when
14087 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14088 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14089 system-call-allowed}.
14090
14091 @table @code
14092 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14093 @cindex address size for remote targets
14094 @cindex bits in remote address
14095 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14096 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14097 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14098 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14099
14100 @item show remoteaddresssize
14101 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14102
14103 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14104 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14105 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14106 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14107 remote targets.
14108
14109 @item show remotebaud
14110 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14111
14112 @item set remotebreak
14113 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14114 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14115 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14116 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14117 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14118 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14119 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14120 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14121
14122 @item show remotebreak
14123 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14124 interrupt the remote program.
14125
14126 @item set remoteflow on
14127 @itemx set remoteflow off
14128 @kindex set remoteflow
14129 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14130 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14131
14132 @item show remoteflow
14133 @kindex show remoteflow
14134 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14135
14136 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14137 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14138 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14139 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14140 @code{ascii}.
14141
14142 @item show remotelogbase
14143 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14144 protocol.
14145
14146 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14147 @cindex record serial communications on file
14148 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14149 default is not to record at all.
14150
14151 @item show remotelogfile.
14152 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14153 serial communications.
14154
14155 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14156 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14157 @cindex remote timeout
14158 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14159 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14160
14161 @item show remotetimeout
14162 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14163 responses.
14164
14165 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14166 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14167 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14168 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14169 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14170 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14171 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14172 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14173
14174 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14175 @itemx show remote exec-file
14176 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14177 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14178 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14179 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14180 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14181 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14182
14183 @kindex set tcp
14184 @kindex show tcp
14185 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14186 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14187 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14188 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14189 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14190 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14191 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14192 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14193 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14194
14195 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14196 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14197
14198 @item show tcp auto-retry
14199 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14200
14201 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14202 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14203 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14204 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14205 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14206 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14207 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14208 value.
14209
14210 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14211 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14212 @end table
14213
14214 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14215 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14216 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14217 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14218 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14219 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14220 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14221 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14222 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14223
14224 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14225 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14226 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14227 @value{GDBN} developers.
14228
14229 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14230 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14231 are:
14232
14233 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14234 @item Command Name
14235 @tab Remote Packet
14236 @tab Related Features
14237
14238 @item @code{fetch-register}
14239 @tab @code{p}
14240 @tab @code{info registers}
14241
14242 @item @code{set-register}
14243 @tab @code{P}
14244 @tab @code{set}
14245
14246 @item @code{binary-download}
14247 @tab @code{X}
14248 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14249
14250 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14251 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14252 @tab @code{info auxv}
14253
14254 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14255 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14256 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14257
14258 @item @code{attach}
14259 @tab @code{vAttach}
14260 @tab @code{attach}
14261
14262 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14263 @tab @code{vCont}
14264 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14265
14266 @item @code{run}
14267 @tab @code{vRun}
14268 @tab @code{run}
14269
14270 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14271 @tab @code{Z0}
14272 @tab @code{break}
14273
14274 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14275 @tab @code{Z1}
14276 @tab @code{hbreak}
14277
14278 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14279 @tab @code{Z2}
14280 @tab @code{watch}
14281
14282 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14283 @tab @code{Z3}
14284 @tab @code{rwatch}
14285
14286 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14287 @tab @code{Z4}
14288 @tab @code{awatch}
14289
14290 @item @code{target-features}
14291 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14292 @tab @code{set architecture}
14293
14294 @item @code{library-info}
14295 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14296 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14297
14298 @item @code{memory-map}
14299 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14300 @tab @code{info mem}
14301
14302 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14303 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14304 @tab @code{info spu}
14305
14306 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14307 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14308 @tab @code{info spu}
14309
14310 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14311 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14312 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14313
14314 @item @code{search-memory}
14315 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
14316 @tab @code{find}
14317
14318 @item @code{supported-packets}
14319 @tab @code{qSupported}
14320 @tab Remote communications parameters
14321
14322 @item @code{pass-signals}
14323 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14324 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14325
14326 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14327 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14328 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14329
14330 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14331 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14332 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14333
14334 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14335 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14336 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14337
14338 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14339 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14340 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14341
14342 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14343 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14344 @tab @code{remote delete}
14345
14346 @item @code{noack-packet}
14347 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14348 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14349
14350 @item @code{osdata}
14351 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
14352 @tab @code{info os}
14353 @end multitable
14354
14355 @node Remote Stub
14356 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14357
14358 @cindex debugging stub, example
14359 @cindex remote stub, example
14360 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14361 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14362 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14363 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14364 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14365 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14366 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14367 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14368
14369 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14370 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14371 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14372 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14373 program, you need:
14374
14375 @enumerate
14376 @item
14377 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14378 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14379 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14380
14381 @item
14382 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14383 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14384
14385 @item
14386 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14387 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14388 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14389 documentation.
14390 @end enumerate
14391
14392 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14393 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14394 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14395
14396 @table @emph
14397 @item On the host,
14398 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14399 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14400 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14401
14402 @item On the target,
14403 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14404 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14405 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14406
14407 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14408 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14409 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14410 @end table
14411
14412 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14413 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14414 @sc{sparc} boards.
14415
14416 @cindex remote serial stub list
14417 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14418
14419 @table @code
14420
14421 @item i386-stub.c
14422 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14423 @cindex Intel
14424 @cindex i386
14425 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14426
14427 @item m68k-stub.c
14428 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14429 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14430 @cindex m680x0
14431 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14432
14433 @item sh-stub.c
14434 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14435 @cindex Renesas
14436 @cindex SH
14437 For Renesas SH architectures.
14438
14439 @item sparc-stub.c
14440 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14441 @cindex Sparc
14442 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14443
14444 @item sparcl-stub.c
14445 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14446 @cindex Fujitsu
14447 @cindex SparcLite
14448 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14449
14450 @end table
14451
14452 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14453 recently added stubs.
14454
14455 @menu
14456 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14457 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14458 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14459 @end menu
14460
14461 @node Stub Contents
14462 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14463
14464 @cindex remote serial stub
14465 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14466 subroutines:
14467
14468 @table @code
14469 @item set_debug_traps
14470 @findex set_debug_traps
14471 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14472 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14473 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14474 beginning of your program.
14475
14476 @item handle_exception
14477 @findex handle_exception
14478 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14479 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14480 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14481 run when a trap is triggered.
14482
14483 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14484 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14485 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14486 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14487 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14488 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14489 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14490 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14491 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14492 machine.
14493
14494 @item breakpoint
14495 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14496 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14497 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14498 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14499 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14500 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14501 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14502 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14503 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14504 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14505 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14506
14507 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14508 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14509 start of your debugging session.
14510 @end table
14511
14512 @node Bootstrapping
14513 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14514
14515 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14516 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14517 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14518 debugging target machine.
14519
14520 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14521 serial port.
14522
14523 @table @code
14524 @item int getDebugChar()
14525 @findex getDebugChar
14526 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14527 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14528 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14529
14530 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14531 @findex putDebugChar
14532 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14533 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14534 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14535 @end table
14536
14537 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14538 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14539 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14540 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14541 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14542 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14543 remote system to stop.
14544
14545 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14546 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14547 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14548 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14549
14550 Other routines you need to supply are:
14551
14552 @table @code
14553 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14554 @findex exceptionHandler
14555 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14556 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14557 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14558 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14559 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14560 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14561 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14562 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14563 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14564 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14565 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14566 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14567 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14568
14569 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14570 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14571 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14572 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14573 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14574
14575 @item void flush_i_cache()
14576 @findex flush_i_cache
14577 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14578 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14579 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14580
14581 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14582 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14583 @end table
14584
14585 @noindent
14586 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14587
14588 @table @code
14589 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14590 @findex memset
14591 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14592 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14593 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14594 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14595 @end table
14596
14597 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14598 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14599 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14600 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14601
14602
14603 @node Debug Session
14604 @subsection Putting it All Together
14605
14606 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14607 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14608 steps.
14609
14610 @enumerate
14611 @item
14612 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14613 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14614 @display
14615 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14616 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14617 @end display
14618
14619 @item
14620 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14621
14622 @smallexample
14623 set_debug_traps();
14624 breakpoint();
14625 @end smallexample
14626
14627 @item
14628 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14629 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14630
14631 @smallexample
14632 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14633 @end smallexample
14634
14635 @noindent
14636 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14637 function in your program, that function is called when
14638 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14639 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14640 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14641
14642 @item
14643 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14644 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14645
14646 @item
14647 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14648 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14649
14650 @item
14651 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14652 @c document that. FIXME.
14653 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14654 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14655
14656 @item
14657 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14658 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14659
14660 @end enumerate
14661
14662 @node Configurations
14663 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14664
14665 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14666 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14667 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14668
14669 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14670 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14671 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14672 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14673 are quite different from each other.
14674
14675 @menu
14676 * Native::
14677 * Embedded OS::
14678 * Embedded Processors::
14679 * Architectures::
14680 @end menu
14681
14682 @node Native
14683 @section Native
14684
14685 This section describes details specific to particular native
14686 configurations.
14687
14688 @menu
14689 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14690 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14691 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14692 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14693 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14694 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14695 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14696 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
14697 @end menu
14698
14699 @node HP-UX
14700 @subsection HP-UX
14701
14702 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14703 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14704 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14705
14706
14707 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14708 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14709
14710 @cindex libkvm
14711 @cindex kernel memory image
14712 @cindex kernel crash dump
14713
14714 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14715 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14716 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14717 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14718 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14719 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14720 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14721 @code{kvm} target:
14722
14723 @smallexample
14724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14725 @end smallexample
14726
14727 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14728 argument:
14729
14730 @smallexample
14731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14732 @end smallexample
14733
14734 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14735 available:
14736
14737 @table @code
14738 @kindex kvm
14739 @item kvm pcb
14740 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14741
14742 @item kvm proc
14743 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14744 modern FreeBSD systems.
14745 @end table
14746
14747 @node SVR4 Process Information
14748 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14749 @cindex /proc
14750 @cindex examine process image
14751 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14752
14753 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14754 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14755 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14756 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14757 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14758 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14759 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14760 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14761 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14762
14763 @table @code
14764 @kindex info proc
14765 @cindex process ID
14766 @item info proc
14767 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14768 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14769 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14770 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14771 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14772 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14773 executable file's absolute file name.
14774
14775 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14776 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14777 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14778 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14779 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14780 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14781
14782 @item info proc mappings
14783 @cindex memory address space mappings
14784 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14785 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14786 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14787 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14788 memory access rights to that range.
14789
14790 @item info proc stat
14791 @itemx info proc status
14792 @cindex process detailed status information
14793 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14794 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14795 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14796 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14797 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14798 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14799 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14800
14801 @item info proc all
14802 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14803 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14804
14805 @ignore
14806 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14807 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14808 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14809 @kindex info proc times
14810 @item info proc times
14811 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14812 its children.
14813
14814 @kindex info proc id
14815 @item info proc id
14816 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14817 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14818 @end ignore
14819
14820 @item set procfs-trace
14821 @kindex set procfs-trace
14822 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14823 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14824
14825 @item show procfs-trace
14826 @kindex show procfs-trace
14827 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14828
14829 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14830 @kindex set procfs-file
14831 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14832 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14833 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14834 standard output.
14835
14836 @item show procfs-file
14837 @kindex show procfs-file
14838 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14839
14840 @item proc-trace-entry
14841 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14842 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14843 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14844 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14845 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14846 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14847 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14848 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14849 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14850
14851 @item info pidlist
14852 @kindex info pidlist
14853 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14854 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14855 processes and all the threads within each process.
14856
14857 @item info meminfo
14858 @kindex info meminfo
14859 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14860 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14861 @end table
14862
14863 @node DJGPP Native
14864 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14865 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14866 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14867 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14868
14869 @cindex DPMI
14870 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14871 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14872 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14873 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14874
14875 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14876 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14877 subsection describes those commands.
14878
14879 @table @code
14880 @kindex info dos
14881 @item info dos
14882 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14883 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14884
14885 @kindex sysinfo
14886 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14887 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14888 @item info dos sysinfo
14889 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14890 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14891 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14892
14893 @cindex GDT
14894 @cindex LDT
14895 @cindex IDT
14896 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14897 @cindex descriptor tables display
14898 @item info dos gdt
14899 @itemx info dos ldt
14900 @itemx info dos idt
14901 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14902 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14903 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14904 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14905 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14906 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14907 rights.
14908
14909 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14910 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14911 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14912 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14913 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14914
14915 @cindex garbled pointers
14916 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14917 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14918 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14919 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14920 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14921 debugged program's data segment:
14922
14923 @smallexample
14924 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14925 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14926 @end smallexample
14927
14928 @noindent
14929 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14930 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14931
14932 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14933 @item info dos pde
14934 @itemx info dos pte
14935 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14936 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14937 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14938 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14939 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14940 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14941 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14942 that is currently in use.
14943
14944 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14945 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14946 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14947 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14948 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14949 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14950 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14951
14952 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14953 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14954 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14955 controller.
14956
14957 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14958
14959 @cindex physical address from linear address
14960 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14961 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14962 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14963 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14964 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14965 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14966 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14967
14968 @smallexample
14969 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14970 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14971 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14972 @end smallexample
14973
14974 @noindent
14975 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14976 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14977 attributes of that page.
14978
14979 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14980 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14981 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14982 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14983 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14984 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14985
14986 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14987 transfer buffer:
14988
14989 @smallexample
14990 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14991 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14992 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14993 @end smallexample
14994
14995 @noindent
14996 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14997 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14998 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14999 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
15000 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
15001
15002 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
15003 @end table
15004
15005 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
15006 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
15007 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
15008 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
15009
15010 @table @code
15011 @kindex set com1base
15012 @kindex set com1irq
15013 @kindex set com2base
15014 @kindex set com2irq
15015 @kindex set com3base
15016 @kindex set com3irq
15017 @kindex set com4base
15018 @kindex set com4irq
15019 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15020 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15021 port.
15022
15023 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15024 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15025 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15026
15027 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15028 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15029 other 3 COM ports.
15030
15031 @kindex show com1base
15032 @kindex show com1irq
15033 @kindex show com2base
15034 @kindex show com2irq
15035 @kindex show com3base
15036 @kindex show com3irq
15037 @kindex show com4base
15038 @kindex show com4irq
15039 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15040 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15041 lines used by the COM ports.
15042
15043 @item info serial
15044 @kindex info serial
15045 @cindex DOS serial port status
15046 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15047 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15048 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15049 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15050 @end table
15051
15052
15053 @node Cygwin Native
15054 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15055 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15056 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15057 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15058
15059 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15060 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15061 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15062 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15063 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15064
15065 @table @code
15066 @kindex info w32
15067 @item info w32
15068 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15069 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15070
15071 @item info w32 selector
15072 This command displays information returned by
15073 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15074 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15075 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15076 Without argument, this command displays information
15077 about the six segment registers.
15078
15079 @kindex info dll
15080 @item info dll
15081 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15082
15083 @kindex dll-symbols
15084 @item dll-symbols
15085 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15086 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15087
15088 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15089 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15090 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15091 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15092 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15093 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15094 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15095 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15096 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15097 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15098 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15099
15100 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15101 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15102 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15103 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15104
15105 @kindex set new-console
15106 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15107 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15108 be started in a new console on next start.
15109 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15110 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15111
15112 @kindex show new-console
15113 @item show new-console
15114 Displays whether a new console is used
15115 when the debuggee is started.
15116
15117 @kindex set new-group
15118 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15119 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15120 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15121 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15122 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15123
15124 @kindex show new-group
15125 @item show new-group
15126 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15127
15128 @kindex set debugevents
15129 @item set debugevents
15130 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15131 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15132 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15133 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15134 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15135
15136 @kindex set debugexec
15137 @item set debugexec
15138 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15139 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15140
15141 @kindex set debugexceptions
15142 @item set debugexceptions
15143 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15144 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15145
15146 @kindex set debugmemory
15147 @item set debugmemory
15148 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15149 and writes by the debugger.
15150
15151 @kindex set shell
15152 @item set shell
15153 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15154 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15155
15156 @kindex show shell
15157 @item show shell
15158 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15159
15160 @end table
15161
15162 @menu
15163 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15164 @end menu
15165
15166 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15167 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15168 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15169 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15170
15171 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15172 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15173 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15174 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15175 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15176 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15177 ``minimal symbols''.
15178
15179 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15180 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15181 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15182 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15183 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15184 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15185 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15186 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15187 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15188 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15189
15190 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15191
15192 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15193 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15194 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15195 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15196 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15197 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15198 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15199 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15200 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15201
15202 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15203 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15204 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15205 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15206 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15207 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15208
15209 @smallexample
15210 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15211 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15212
15213 Non-debugging symbols:
15214 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15215 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15216 @end smallexample
15217
15218 @smallexample
15219 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15220 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15221
15222 Non-debugging symbols:
15223 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15224 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15225 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15226 [etc...]
15227 @end smallexample
15228
15229 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15230
15231 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15232 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15233 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15234 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15235 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15236 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15237 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15238
15239 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15240 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15241 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15242 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15243 problem:
15244
15245 @smallexample
15246 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15247 $1 = 268572168
15248 @end smallexample
15249
15250 @smallexample
15251 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15252 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15253 @end smallexample
15254
15255 And two possible solutions:
15256
15257 @smallexample
15258 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15259 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15260 @end smallexample
15261
15262 @smallexample
15263 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15264 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15265 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15266 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15267 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15268 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15269 @end smallexample
15270
15271 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15272 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15273 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15274 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15275 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15276
15277 @smallexample
15278 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15279 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15280 @end smallexample
15281
15282 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15283 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15284 safe.
15285
15286 @node Hurd Native
15287 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15288 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15289
15290 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15291 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15292
15293 @table @code
15294 @item set signals
15295 @itemx set sigs
15296 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15297 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15298 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15299 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15300 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15301 @code{signals}.
15302
15303 @item show signals
15304 @itemx show sigs
15305 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15306 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15307 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15308
15309 @item set signal-thread
15310 @itemx set sigthread
15311 @kindex set signal-thread
15312 @kindex set sigthread
15313 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
15314 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
15315 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
15316 signal-thread}.
15317
15318 @item show signal-thread
15319 @itemx show sigthread
15320 @kindex show signal-thread
15321 @kindex show sigthread
15322 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15323 delivered a signal.
15324
15325 @item set stopped
15326 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15327 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15328 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15329 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15330
15331 @item show stopped
15332 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15333 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15334 stopped.
15335
15336 @item set exceptions
15337 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15338 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15339 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15340 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15341 trapping on.
15342
15343 @item show exceptions
15344 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15345 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15346
15347 @item set task pause
15348 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15349 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15350 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15351 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15352 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15353 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15354 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15355 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15356 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15357
15358 @item show task pause
15359 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15360 Show the current state of task suspension.
15361
15362 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15363 @cindex task suspend count
15364 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15365 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15366 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15367
15368 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15369 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15370
15371 @item set task exception-port
15372 @itemx set task excp
15373 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15374 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15375 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15376 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15377
15378 @item set noninvasive
15379 @cindex noninvasive task options
15380 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15381 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15382 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15383 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15384
15385 @item info send-rights
15386 @itemx info receive-rights
15387 @itemx info port-rights
15388 @itemx info port-sets
15389 @itemx info dead-names
15390 @itemx info ports
15391 @itemx info psets
15392 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15393 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15394 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15395 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15396 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15397 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15398 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15399 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15400 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15401
15402 @item set thread pause
15403 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15404 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15405 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15406 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15407 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15408 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15409 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15410 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15411 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15412 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15413 only the current thread.
15414
15415 @item show thread pause
15416 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15417 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15418
15419 @item set thread run
15420 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15421
15422 @item show thread run
15423 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15424
15425 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15426 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15427 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15428 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15429 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15430 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15431 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15432
15433 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15434 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15435 detaching.
15436
15437 @item set thread exception-port
15438 @itemx set thread excp
15439 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15440 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15441 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15442
15443 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15444 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15445 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15446 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15447
15448 @item set thread default
15449 @itemx show thread default
15450 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15451 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15452 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15453 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15454 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15455 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15456 the non-default commands.
15457 @end table
15458
15459
15460 @node Neutrino
15461 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15462 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15463
15464 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15465 Neutrino target:
15466
15467 @table @code
15468 @item set debug nto-debug
15469 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15470 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15471 Neutrino support.
15472
15473 @item show debug nto-debug
15474 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15475 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15476 @end table
15477
15478 @node Darwin
15479 @subsection Darwin
15480 @cindex Darwin
15481
15482 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
15483
15484 @table @code
15485 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
15486 @kindex set debug darwin
15487 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
15488 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
15489
15490 @item show debug darwin
15491 @kindex show debug darwin
15492 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
15493
15494 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
15495 @kindex set debug mach-o
15496 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
15497 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
15498 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
15499 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
15500 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
15501 usage.
15502
15503 @item show debug mach-o
15504 @kindex show debug mach-o
15505 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
15506
15507 @item set mach-exceptions on
15508 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
15509 @kindex set mach-exceptions
15510 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
15511 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
15512 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
15513 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
15514
15515 @item show mach-exceptions
15516 @kindex show mach-exceptions
15517 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
15518 @end table
15519
15520
15521 @node Embedded OS
15522 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15523
15524 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15525 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15526 architectures.
15527
15528 @menu
15529 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15530 @end menu
15531
15532 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15533 various real-time operating systems.
15534
15535 @node VxWorks
15536 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15537
15538 @cindex VxWorks
15539
15540 @table @code
15541
15542 @kindex target vxworks
15543 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15544 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15545 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15546
15547 @end table
15548
15549 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15550 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15551
15552 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15553 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15554 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15555 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15556 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15557 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15558 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15559
15560 @table @code
15561 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15562 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15563 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15564 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15565 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15566 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15567 of a thin network line.
15568 @end table
15569
15570 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15571 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15572 procedures.
15573
15574 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15575 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15576 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15577 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15578 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15579 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15580 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15581 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15582 manual.
15583 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15584
15585 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15586 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15587 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15588 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15589
15590 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15591
15592 @smallexample
15593 (vxgdb)
15594 @end smallexample
15595
15596 @menu
15597 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15598 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15599 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15600 @end menu
15601
15602 @node VxWorks Connection
15603 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15604
15605 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15606 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15607
15608 @smallexample
15609 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15610 @end smallexample
15611
15612 @need 750
15613 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15614
15615 @smallexample
15616 Attaching remote machine across net...
15617 Connected to tt.
15618 @end smallexample
15619
15620 @need 1000
15621 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15622 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15623 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15624 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15625 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15626
15627 @smallexample
15628 prog.o: No such file or directory.
15629 @end smallexample
15630
15631 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15632 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15633 command again.
15634
15635 @node VxWorks Download
15636 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
15637
15638 @cindex download to VxWorks
15639 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15640 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15641 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15642 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15643 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15644 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15645 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15646 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15647 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15648 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15649 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15650 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15651 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15652 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15653 program, type this on VxWorks:
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15657 @end smallexample
15658
15659 @noindent
15660 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15661
15662 @smallexample
15663 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15664 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15665 @end smallexample
15666
15667 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15668
15669 @smallexample
15670 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15671 @end smallexample
15672
15673 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15674 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15675 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15676 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15677 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15678 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15679 table.)
15680
15681 @node VxWorks Attach
15682 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15683
15684 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15685 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15686 follows:
15687
15688 @smallexample
15689 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15690 @end smallexample
15691
15692 @noindent
15693 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15694 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15695 the time of attachment.
15696
15697 @node Embedded Processors
15698 @section Embedded Processors
15699
15700 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15701 configurations.
15702
15703 @cindex send command to simulator
15704 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15705 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15706
15707 @table @code
15708 @item sim @var{command}
15709 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15710 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15711 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15712 acceptable commands.
15713 @end table
15714
15715
15716 @menu
15717 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15718 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15719 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15720 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15721 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15722 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15723 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15724 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15725 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15726 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15727 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15728 * CRIS:: CRIS
15729 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15730 @end menu
15731
15732 @node ARM
15733 @subsection ARM
15734 @cindex ARM RDI
15735
15736 @table @code
15737 @kindex target rdi
15738 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15739 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15740 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15741 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15742
15743 @kindex target rdp
15744 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15745 ARM Demon monitor.
15746
15747 @end table
15748
15749 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15750
15751 @table @code
15752 @item set arm disassembler
15753 @kindex set arm
15754 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15755 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15756
15757 @item show arm disassembler
15758 @kindex show arm
15759 Show the current disassembly style.
15760
15761 @item set arm apcs32
15762 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15763 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15764
15765 @item show arm apcs32
15766 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15767
15768 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15769 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15770 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15771
15772 @table @code
15773 @item auto
15774 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15775 @item softfpa
15776 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15777 processors.
15778 @item fpa
15779 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15780 @item softvfp
15781 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15782 @item vfp
15783 VFP co-processor.
15784 @end table
15785
15786 @item show arm fpu
15787 Show the current type of the FPU.
15788
15789 @item set arm abi
15790 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15791
15792 @item show arm abi
15793 Show the currently used ABI.
15794
15795 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15796 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15797 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15798 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15799 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15800 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15801 register).
15802
15803 @item show arm fallback-mode
15804 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15805
15806 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15807 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15808 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15809 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15810 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15811
15812 @item show arm force-mode
15813 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15814
15815 @item set debug arm
15816 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15817 target support subsystem.
15818
15819 @item show debug arm
15820 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15821 @end table
15822
15823 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15824 using the RDI interface:
15825
15826 @table @code
15827 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15828 @kindex rdilogfile
15829 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15830 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15831 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15832 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15833 @file{rdi.log}.
15834
15835 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15836 @kindex rdilogenable
15837 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15838 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15839 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15840 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15841 are logged to a file.
15842
15843 @item set rdiromatzero
15844 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15845 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15846 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15847 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15848 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15849 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15850
15851 @item show rdiromatzero
15852 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15853 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15854
15855 @item set rdiheartbeat
15856 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15857 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15858 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15859 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15860 well as the Angel monitor.
15861
15862 @item show rdiheartbeat
15863 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
15864 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15865 @end table
15866
15867
15868 @node M32R/D
15869 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @kindex target m32r
15873 @item target m32r @var{dev}
15874 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15875
15876 @kindex target m32rsdi
15877 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15878 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15879 @end table
15880
15881 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15882
15883 @table @code
15884 @item set download-path @var{path}
15885 @kindex set download-path
15886 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15887 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15888
15889 @item show download-path
15890 @kindex show download-path
15891 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15892
15893 @item set board-address @var{addr}
15894 @kindex set board-address
15895 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
15896 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15897
15898 @item show board-address
15899 @kindex show board-address
15900 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15901
15902 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15903 @kindex set server-address
15904 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15905 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15906 host machine.
15907
15908 @item show server-address
15909 @kindex show server-address
15910 Display the IP address of the download server.
15911
15912 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15913 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15914 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15915 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15916 executable file is uploaded.
15917
15918 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15919 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15920 Test the @code{upload} command.
15921 @end table
15922
15923 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15924
15925 @table @code
15926 @item sdireset
15927 @kindex sdireset
15928 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15929 This command resets the SDI connection.
15930
15931 @item sdistatus
15932 @kindex sdistatus
15933 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15934
15935 @item debug_chaos
15936 @kindex debug_chaos
15937 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15938 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15939
15940 @item use_debug_dma
15941 @kindex use_debug_dma
15942 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15943
15944 @item use_mon_code
15945 @kindex use_mon_code
15946 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15947
15948 @item use_ib_break
15949 @kindex use_ib_break
15950 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15951
15952 @item use_dbt_break
15953 @kindex use_dbt_break
15954 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15955 @end table
15956
15957 @node M68K
15958 @subsection M68k
15959
15960 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15961 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15962
15963 @table @code
15964
15965 @kindex target dbug
15966 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15967 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15968
15969 @end table
15970
15971 @node MIPS Embedded
15972 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15973
15974 @cindex MIPS boards
15975 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15976 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15977 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15978
15979 @need 1000
15980 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15981
15982 @table @code
15983 @item target mips @var{port}
15984 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15985 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15986 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15987 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15988 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15989 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15990 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15991
15992 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15993 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15994 debugger:
15995
15996 @smallexample
15997 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15998 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15999 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
16000 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
16001 (@value{GDBP}) run
16002 @end smallexample
16003
16004 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
16005 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
16006 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
16007 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
16008 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
16009
16010 @item target pmon @var{port}
16011 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
16012 PMON ROM monitor.
16013
16014 @item target ddb @var{port}
16015 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16016 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16017
16018 @item target lsi @var{port}
16019 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16020 LSI variant of PMON.
16021
16022 @kindex target r3900
16023 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16024 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16025
16026 @kindex target array
16027 @item target array @var{dev}
16028 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16029
16030 @end table
16031
16032
16033 @noindent
16034 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16035
16036 @table @code
16037 @item set mipsfpu double
16038 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16039 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16040 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16041 @itemx show mipsfpu
16042 @kindex set mipsfpu
16043 @kindex show mipsfpu
16044 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16045 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16046 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16047 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16048 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16049 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16050 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16051 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16052 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16053 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16054 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16055 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16056 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16057
16058 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16059 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16060 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16061
16062 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16063 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16064
16065 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16066 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16067 @itemx show timeout
16068 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16069 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16070 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16071 @kindex set timeout
16072 @kindex show timeout
16073 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16074 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16075 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16076 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16077 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16078 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16079 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16080 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16081 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16082 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16083
16084 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16085 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16086 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16087 to run before stopping.
16088
16089 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16090 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16091 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16092 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16093 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16094 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16095
16096 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16097 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16098 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16099 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16100
16101 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16102 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16103 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16104 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16105 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16106 @table @asis
16107 @item pmon target
16108 @samp{PMON}
16109 @item ddb target
16110 @samp{NEC010}
16111 @item lsi target
16112 @samp{PMON>}
16113 @end table
16114
16115 @item show monitor-prompt
16116 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16117 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16118 remote monitor.
16119
16120 @item set monitor-warnings
16121 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16122 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16123 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16124 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16125 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16126
16127 @item show monitor-warnings
16128 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16129 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16130
16131 @item pmon @var{command}
16132 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16133 @cindex send PMON command
16134 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16135 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16136 @end table
16137
16138 @node OpenRISC 1000
16139 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16140 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16141
16142 @cindex or1k boards
16143 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16144 about platform and commands.
16145
16146 @table @code
16147
16148 @kindex target jtag
16149 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16150
16151 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16152 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16153 connected via parallel port to the board.
16154
16155 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16156
16157 @kindex or1ksim
16158 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16159 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16160 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16161
16162 @kindex info or1k spr
16163 @item info or1k spr
16164 Displays spr groups.
16165
16166 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16167 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16168 Displays register names in selected group.
16169
16170 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16171 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16172 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16173 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16174 Shows information about specified spr register.
16175
16176 @kindex spr
16177 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16178 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16179 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16180 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16181 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16182 @end table
16183
16184 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16185 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16186 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16187 triggers can be set using:
16188 @table @code
16189 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16190 Load effective address/data
16191 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16192 Store effective address/data
16193 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16194 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16195 @item $FETCH
16196 Fetch data
16197 @end table
16198
16199 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16200 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16201
16202 @code{htrace} commands:
16203 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16204 @table @code
16205 @kindex hwatch
16206 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16207 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16208 or Data. For example:
16209
16210 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16211
16212 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16213
16214 @kindex htrace
16215 @item htrace info
16216 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16217
16218 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16219 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16220
16221 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16222 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16223
16224 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16225 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16226
16227 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16228 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16229 triggered.
16230
16231 @item htrace enable
16232 @itemx htrace disable
16233 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16234
16235 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16236 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16237
16238 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16239 will be written there.
16240
16241 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16242 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16243
16244 @item htrace mode continuous
16245 Set continuous trace mode.
16246
16247 @item htrace mode suspend
16248 Set suspend trace mode.
16249
16250 @end table
16251
16252 @node PowerPC Embedded
16253 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16254
16255 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16256
16257 @table @code
16258 @kindex set powerpc
16259 @item set powerpc soft-float
16260 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16261 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16262 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16263 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16264
16265 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16266 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16267 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16268 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16269 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16270 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16271 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16272 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16273
16274 @kindex target dink32
16275 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16276 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16277
16278 @kindex target ppcbug
16279 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16280 @kindex target ppcbug1
16281 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16282 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16283
16284 @kindex target sds
16285 @item target sds @var{dev}
16286 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16287 @end table
16288
16289 @cindex SDS protocol
16290 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16291 by @value{GDBN}:
16292
16293 @table @code
16294 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16295 @kindex set sdstimeout
16296 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16297 default is 2 seconds.
16298
16299 @item show sdstimeout
16300 @kindex show sdstimeout
16301 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16302
16303 @item sds @var{command}
16304 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16305 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16306 @end table
16307
16308
16309 @node PA
16310 @subsection HP PA Embedded
16311
16312 @table @code
16313
16314 @kindex target op50n
16315 @item target op50n @var{dev}
16316 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
16317
16318 @kindex target w89k
16319 @item target w89k @var{dev}
16320 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
16321
16322 @end table
16323
16324 @node Sparclet
16325 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
16326
16327 @cindex Sparclet
16328
16329 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
16330 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
16331 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16332 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
16333 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
16334
16335 @table @code
16336 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
16337 @kindex remotetimeout
16338 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
16339 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16340 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
16341 @end table
16342
16343 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
16344 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
16345 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
16346 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
16347 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
16351 @end smallexample
16352
16353 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
16357 @end smallexample
16358
16359 @cindex running, on Sparclet
16360 Once you have set
16361 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16362 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
16363 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
16364
16365 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16366
16367 @smallexample
16368 (gdbslet)
16369 @end smallexample
16370
16371 @menu
16372 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16373 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16374 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16375 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16376 @end menu
16377
16378 @node Sparclet File
16379 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16380
16381 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16382
16383 @smallexample
16384 (gdbslet) file prog
16385 @end smallexample
16386
16387 @need 1000
16388 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16389 @value{GDBN} locates
16390 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16391 path.
16392 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16393 files will be searched as well.
16394 @value{GDBN} locates
16395 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16396 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16397 If it fails
16398 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16399
16400 @smallexample
16401 prog: No such file or directory.
16402 @end smallexample
16403
16404 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16405 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16406 @code{target} command again.
16407
16408 @node Sparclet Connection
16409 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16410
16411 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16412 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16413
16414 @smallexample
16415 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16416 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16417 main () at ../prog.c:3
16418 @end smallexample
16419
16420 @need 750
16421 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16422
16423 @smallexample
16424 Connected to ttya.
16425 @end smallexample
16426
16427 @node Sparclet Download
16428 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16429
16430 @cindex download to Sparclet
16431 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16432 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16433 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16434 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16435 command.
16436 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16437 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16438 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16439 of each of the file's sections.
16440 For instance, if the program
16441 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16442 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16443
16444 @smallexample
16445 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16446 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16447 @end smallexample
16448
16449 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16450 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16451 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16452
16453 @node Sparclet Execution
16454 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16455
16456 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16457 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16458 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16459 manual for the list of commands.
16460
16461 @smallexample
16462 (gdbslet) b main
16463 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16464 (gdbslet) run
16465 Starting program: prog
16466 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16467 3 char *symarg = 0;
16468 (gdbslet) step
16469 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16470 (gdbslet)
16471 @end smallexample
16472
16473 @node Sparclite
16474 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16475
16476 @table @code
16477
16478 @kindex target sparclite
16479 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16480 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16481 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16482 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16483 remote protocol.
16484
16485 @end table
16486
16487 @node Z8000
16488 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16489
16490 @cindex Z8000
16491 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16492 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16493
16494 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16495 a Z8000 simulator.
16496
16497 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16498 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16499 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16500 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16501
16502 @table @code
16503 @item target sim @var{args}
16504 @kindex sim
16505 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16506 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16507 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16508 @end table
16509
16510 @noindent
16511 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16512 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16513 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16514 to run your program, and so on.
16515
16516 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16517 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16518 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16519
16520 @table @code
16521
16522 @item cycles
16523 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16524
16525 @item insts
16526 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16527
16528 @item time
16529 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16530
16531 @end table
16532
16533 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16534 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16535 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16536 simulated clock ticks.
16537
16538 @node AVR
16539 @subsection Atmel AVR
16540 @cindex AVR
16541
16542 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16543 following AVR-specific commands:
16544
16545 @table @code
16546 @item info io_registers
16547 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16548 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16549 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16550 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16551 @end table
16552
16553 @node CRIS
16554 @subsection CRIS
16555 @cindex CRIS
16556
16557 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16558 following CRIS-specific commands:
16559
16560 @table @code
16561 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16562 @cindex CRIS version
16563 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16564 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16565 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16566
16567 @item show cris-version
16568 Show the current CRIS version.
16569
16570 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16571 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16572 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16573 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16574 @code{R59}.
16575
16576 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16577 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16578
16579 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16580 @cindex CRIS mode
16581 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16582 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16583 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16584
16585 @item show cris-mode
16586 Show the current CRIS mode.
16587 @end table
16588
16589 @node Super-H
16590 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16591 @cindex Super-H
16592
16593 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16594 commands:
16595
16596 @table @code
16597 @item regs
16598 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16599 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16600
16601 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16602 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16603 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16604 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16605 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16606 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16607 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16608 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16609 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16610 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16611 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16612 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16613
16614 @item show sh calling-convention
16615 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16616 Show the current calling convention setting.
16617
16618 @end table
16619
16620
16621 @node Architectures
16622 @section Architectures
16623
16624 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16625 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16626
16627 @menu
16628 * i386::
16629 * A29K::
16630 * Alpha::
16631 * MIPS::
16632 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16633 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16634 * PowerPC::
16635 @end menu
16636
16637 @node i386
16638 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16639
16640 @table @code
16641 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16642 @kindex set struct-convention
16643 @cindex struct return convention
16644 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
16645 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16646 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16647 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16648 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16649 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16650 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16651 be returned in a register.
16652
16653 @item show struct-convention
16654 @kindex show struct-convention
16655 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16656 from functions.
16657 @end table
16658
16659 @node A29K
16660 @subsection A29K
16661
16662 @table @code
16663
16664 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16665 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16666 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16667 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16668 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16669 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16670 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16671 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16672 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16673 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16674 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16675 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16676 hexadecimal.
16677
16678 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16679 @item show rstack_high_address
16680 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16681 processors.
16682
16683 @end table
16684
16685 @node Alpha
16686 @subsection Alpha
16687
16688 See the following section.
16689
16690 @node MIPS
16691 @subsection MIPS
16692
16693 @cindex stack on Alpha
16694 @cindex stack on MIPS
16695 @cindex Alpha stack
16696 @cindex MIPS stack
16697 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16698 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16699 find the beginning of a function.
16700
16701 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16702 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16703 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16704 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16705 commands:
16706
16707 @table @code
16708 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16709 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16710 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16711 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16712 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16713 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16714 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16715 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16716
16717 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16718 Display the current limit.
16719 @end table
16720
16721 @noindent
16722 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16723 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16724
16725 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16726 programs:
16727
16728 @table @code
16729 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16730 @kindex set mips abi
16731 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16732 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16733 values of @var{arg} are:
16734
16735 @table @samp
16736 @item auto
16737 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16738 default).
16739 @item o32
16740 @item o64
16741 @item n32
16742 @item n64
16743 @item eabi32
16744 @item eabi64
16745 @item auto
16746 @end table
16747
16748 @item show mips abi
16749 @kindex show mips abi
16750 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16751
16752 @item set mipsfpu
16753 @itemx show mipsfpu
16754 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16755
16756 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16757 @kindex set mips mask-address
16758 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16759 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16760 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16761 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16762 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16763
16764 @item show mips mask-address
16765 @kindex show mips mask-address
16766 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16767 not.
16768
16769 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16770 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16771 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16772 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16773 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16774 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16775
16776 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16777 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16778 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16779
16780 @item set debug mips
16781 @kindex set debug mips
16782 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16783 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16784
16785 @item show debug mips
16786 @kindex show debug mips
16787 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16788 @end table
16789
16790
16791 @node HPPA
16792 @subsection HPPA
16793 @cindex HPPA support
16794
16795 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16796 following special commands:
16797
16798 @table @code
16799 @item set debug hppa
16800 @kindex set debug hppa
16801 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16802 messages are to be displayed.
16803
16804 @item show debug hppa
16805 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16806
16807 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16808 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16809 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16810 given @var{address}.
16811
16812 @end table
16813
16814
16815 @node SPU
16816 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16817 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16818 @cindex SPU
16819
16820 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16821 it provides the following special commands:
16822
16823 @table @code
16824 @item info spu event
16825 @kindex info spu
16826 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16827 and pending event status.
16828
16829 @item info spu signal
16830 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16831 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16832 notification channels.
16833
16834 @item info spu mailbox
16835 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16836 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16837 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16838
16839 @item info spu dma
16840 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16841 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16842 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16843
16844 @item info spu proxydma
16845 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16846 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16847 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16848
16849 @end table
16850
16851 @node PowerPC
16852 @subsection PowerPC
16853 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16854
16855 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16856 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16857 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16858 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16859 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16860
16861 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16862 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16863 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16864
16865 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
16866 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
16867
16868
16869 @node Controlling GDB
16870 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16871
16872 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16873 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16874 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16875 described here.
16876
16877 @menu
16878 * Prompt:: Prompt
16879 * Editing:: Command editing
16880 * Command History:: Command history
16881 * Screen Size:: Screen size
16882 * Numbers:: Numbers
16883 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16884 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16885 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16886 @end menu
16887
16888 @node Prompt
16889 @section Prompt
16890
16891 @cindex prompt
16892
16893 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16894 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16895 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16896 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16897 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16898 which one you are talking to.
16899
16900 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16901 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16902 or a prompt that does not.
16903
16904 @table @code
16905 @kindex set prompt
16906 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16907 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16908
16909 @kindex show prompt
16910 @item show prompt
16911 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16912 @end table
16913
16914 @node Editing
16915 @section Command Editing
16916 @cindex readline
16917 @cindex command line editing
16918
16919 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16920 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16921 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16922 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16923 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16924 debugging sessions.
16925
16926 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16927 command @code{set}.
16928
16929 @table @code
16930 @kindex set editing
16931 @cindex editing
16932 @item set editing
16933 @itemx set editing on
16934 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16935
16936 @item set editing off
16937 Disable command line editing.
16938
16939 @kindex show editing
16940 @item show editing
16941 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16942 @end table
16943
16944 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16945 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16946 encouraged to read that chapter.
16947
16948 @node Command History
16949 @section Command History
16950 @cindex command history
16951
16952 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16953 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16954 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16955 history facility.
16956
16957 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16958 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16959 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16960
16961 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16962 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16963 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16964 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16965 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16966 pressed on a line by itself.
16967
16968 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16969 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16970 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16971 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16972
16973 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16974 history.
16975
16976 @table @code
16977 @cindex history substitution
16978 @cindex history file
16979 @kindex set history filename
16980 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16981 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16982 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16983 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16984 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16985 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16986 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16987 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16988 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16989 is not set.
16990
16991 @cindex save command history
16992 @kindex set history save
16993 @item set history save
16994 @itemx set history save on
16995 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16996 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16997
16998 @item set history save off
16999 Stop recording command history in a file.
17000
17001 @cindex history size
17002 @kindex set history size
17003 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
17004 @item set history size @var{size}
17005 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
17006 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
17007 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
17008 @end table
17009
17010 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
17011 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
17012
17013 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17014 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17015 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17016 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17017 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17018 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17019 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17020 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17021
17022 The commands to control history expansion are:
17023
17024 @table @code
17025 @item set history expansion on
17026 @itemx set history expansion
17027 @kindex set history expansion
17028 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17029
17030 @item set history expansion off
17031 Disable history expansion.
17032
17033 @c @group
17034 @kindex show history
17035 @item show history
17036 @itemx show history filename
17037 @itemx show history save
17038 @itemx show history size
17039 @itemx show history expansion
17040 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17041 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17042 @c @end group
17043 @end table
17044
17045 @table @code
17046 @kindex show commands
17047 @cindex show last commands
17048 @cindex display command history
17049 @item show commands
17050 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17051
17052 @item show commands @var{n}
17053 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17054
17055 @item show commands +
17056 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17057 @end table
17058
17059 @node Screen Size
17060 @section Screen Size
17061 @cindex size of screen
17062 @cindex pauses in output
17063
17064 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17065 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17066 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17067 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17068 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17069 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17070 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17071 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17072
17073 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17074 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17075 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17076 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17077 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17078 width} commands:
17079
17080 @table @code
17081 @kindex set height
17082 @kindex set width
17083 @kindex show width
17084 @kindex show height
17085 @item set height @var{lpp}
17086 @itemx show height
17087 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17088 @itemx show width
17089 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17090 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17091 commands display the current settings.
17092
17093 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17094 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17095 file or to an editor buffer.
17096
17097 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17098 from wrapping its output.
17099
17100 @item set pagination on
17101 @itemx set pagination off
17102 @kindex set pagination
17103 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17104 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17105
17106 @item show pagination
17107 @kindex show pagination
17108 Show the current pagination mode.
17109 @end table
17110
17111 @node Numbers
17112 @section Numbers
17113 @cindex number representation
17114 @cindex entering numbers
17115
17116 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17117 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17118 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17119 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17120 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17121 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17122 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17123 both input and output with the commands described below.
17124
17125 @table @code
17126 @kindex set input-radix
17127 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17128 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17129 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17130 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17131 example, any of
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 set input-radix 012
17135 set input-radix 10.
17136 set input-radix 0xa
17137 @end smallexample
17138
17139 @noindent
17140 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17141 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17142 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17143 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17144 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17145 change the radix.
17146
17147 @kindex set output-radix
17148 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17149 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17150 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17151 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17152
17153 @kindex show input-radix
17154 @item show input-radix
17155 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17156
17157 @kindex show output-radix
17158 @item show output-radix
17159 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17160
17161 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17162 @itemx show radix
17163 @kindex set radix
17164 @kindex show radix
17165 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17166 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17167 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17168 default value of 10.
17169
17170 @end table
17171
17172 @node ABI
17173 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17174
17175 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17176 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17177 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17178 current ABI.
17179
17180 @cindex OS ABI
17181 @kindex set osabi
17182 @kindex show osabi
17183
17184 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17185 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17186 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17187 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17188 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17189 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17190 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17191 platform provides.
17192
17193 @table @code
17194 @item show osabi
17195 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17196
17197 @item set osabi
17198 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17199
17200 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17201 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17202 @end table
17203
17204 @cindex float promotion
17205
17206 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17207 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17208 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17209 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17210 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17211 @code{double} and then passed.
17212
17213 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17214 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17215 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17216
17217 @table @code
17218 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17219 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17220 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17221 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17222 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17223
17224 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17225 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17226 functions.
17227
17228 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17229 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17230 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17231 @end table
17232
17233 @kindex set cp-abi
17234 @kindex show cp-abi
17235 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17236 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17237 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17238 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17239 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17240 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17241 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17242 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17243 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17244 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17245 ``auto''.
17246
17247 @table @code
17248 @item show cp-abi
17249 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17250
17251 @item set cp-abi
17252 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17253
17254 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17255 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17256 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17257 @end table
17258
17259 @node Messages/Warnings
17260 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17261
17262 @cindex verbose operation
17263 @cindex optional warnings
17264 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17265 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17266 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17267 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17268
17269 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17270 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17271 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17272
17273 @table @code
17274 @kindex set verbose
17275 @item set verbose on
17276 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17277
17278 @item set verbose off
17279 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17280
17281 @kindex show verbose
17282 @item show verbose
17283 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
17284 @end table
17285
17286 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
17287 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
17288 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
17289 Symbol Files}).
17290
17291 @table @code
17292
17293 @kindex set complaints
17294 @item set complaints @var{limit}
17295 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
17296 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
17297 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
17298 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
17299
17300 @kindex show complaints
17301 @item show complaints
17302 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
17303
17304 @end table
17305
17306 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
17307 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
17308 you try to run a program which is already running:
17309
17310 @smallexample
17311 (@value{GDBP}) run
17312 The program being debugged has been started already.
17313 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
17314 @end smallexample
17315
17316 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
17317 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
17318
17319 @table @code
17320
17321 @kindex set confirm
17322 @cindex flinching
17323 @cindex confirmation
17324 @cindex stupid questions
17325 @item set confirm off
17326 Disables confirmation requests.
17327
17328 @item set confirm on
17329 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
17330
17331 @kindex show confirm
17332 @item show confirm
17333 Displays state of confirmation requests.
17334
17335 @end table
17336
17337 @cindex command tracing
17338 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
17339 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
17340 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
17341 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
17342
17343 @table @code
17344 @kindex set trace-commands
17345 @cindex command scripts, debugging
17346 @item set trace-commands on
17347 Enable command tracing.
17348 @item set trace-commands off
17349 Disable command tracing.
17350 @item show trace-commands
17351 Display the current state of command tracing.
17352 @end table
17353
17354 @node Debugging Output
17355 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
17356 @cindex optional debugging messages
17357
17358 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
17359 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
17360 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
17361 section documents those commands.
17362
17363 @table @code
17364 @kindex set exec-done-display
17365 @item set exec-done-display
17366 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17367 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17368 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17369 @kindex show exec-done-display
17370 @item show exec-done-display
17371 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17372 notification.
17373 @kindex set debug
17374 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17375 @cindex architecture debugging info
17376 @item set debug arch
17377 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17378 @kindex show debug
17379 @item show debug arch
17380 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17381 @item set debug aix-thread
17382 @cindex AIX threads
17383 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17384 module.
17385 @item show debug aix-thread
17386 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17387 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17388 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17389 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17390 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17391 A value of zero turns off the display.
17392 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17393 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17394 @item set debug displaced
17395 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17396 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17397 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17398 @item show debug displaced
17399 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17400 related to displaced stepping.
17401 @item set debug event
17402 @cindex event debugging info
17403 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17404 default is off.
17405 @item show debug event
17406 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17407 info.
17408 @item set debug expression
17409 @cindex expression debugging info
17410 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17411 expression parsing. The default is off.
17412 @item show debug expression
17413 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17414 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17415 @item set debug frame
17416 @cindex frame debugging info
17417 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17418 default is off.
17419 @item show debug frame
17420 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17421 info.
17422 @item set debug infrun
17423 @cindex inferior debugging info
17424 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17425 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17426 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17427 @item show debug infrun
17428 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17429 @item set debug lin-lwp
17430 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17431 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17432 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17433 @item show debug lin-lwp
17434 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17435 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17436 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17437 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17438 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17439 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17440 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17441 @item set debug observer
17442 @cindex observer debugging info
17443 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17444 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17445 @item show debug observer
17446 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17447 @item set debug overload
17448 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17449 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17450 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17451 is off.
17452 @item show debug overload
17453 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17454 debugging info.
17455 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17456 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17457 @cindex debug remote protocol
17458 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17459 @cindex display remote packets
17460 @item set debug remote
17461 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17462 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17463 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17464 @item show debug remote
17465 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17466 @item set debug serial
17467 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17468 default is off.
17469 @item show debug serial
17470 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17471 info.
17472 @item set debug solib-frv
17473 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17474 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17475 @item show debug solib-frv
17476 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17477 messages.
17478 @item set debug target
17479 @cindex target debugging info
17480 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17481 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17482 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17483 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17484 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17485 @item show debug target
17486 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17487 info.
17488 @item set debug timestamp
17489 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17490 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17491 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17492 message.
17493 @item show debug timestamp
17494 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17495 debugging info.
17496 @item set debugvarobj
17497 @cindex variable object debugging info
17498 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17499 info. The default is off.
17500 @item show debugvarobj
17501 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17502 debugging info.
17503 @item set debug xml
17504 @cindex XML parser debugging
17505 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17506 @item show debug xml
17507 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17508 @end table
17509
17510 @node Extending GDB
17511 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17512 @cindex extending GDB
17513
17514 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17515 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17516 Python scripting language.
17517
17518 @menu
17519 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17520 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17521 @end menu
17522
17523 @node Sequences
17524 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17525
17526 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17527 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17528 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17529 files.
17530
17531 @menu
17532 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17533 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17534 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17535 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17536 @end menu
17537
17538 @node Define
17539 @subsection User-defined Commands
17540
17541 @cindex user-defined command
17542 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17543 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17544 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17545 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17546 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17547 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17548
17549 @smallexample
17550 define adder
17551 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17552 end
17553 @end smallexample
17554
17555 @noindent
17556 To execute the command use:
17557
17558 @smallexample
17559 adder 1 2 3
17560 @end smallexample
17561
17562 @noindent
17563 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17564 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17565 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17566 functions calls.
17567
17568 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17569 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17570 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17571 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17572
17573 @smallexample
17574 define adder
17575 if $argc == 2
17576 print $arg0 + $arg1
17577 end
17578 if $argc == 3
17579 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17580 end
17581 end
17582 @end smallexample
17583
17584 @table @code
17585
17586 @kindex define
17587 @item define @var{commandname}
17588 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17589 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17590 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
17591 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
17592 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
17593 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
17594
17595 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17596 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17597 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17598
17599 @kindex document
17600 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17601 @item document @var{commandname}
17602 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17603 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17604 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17605 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17606 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17607 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17608
17609 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17610 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17611 does not change the documentation.
17612
17613 @kindex dont-repeat
17614 @cindex don't repeat command
17615 @item dont-repeat
17616 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17617 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17618 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17619
17620 @kindex help user-defined
17621 @item help user-defined
17622 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17623 (if any) for each.
17624
17625 @kindex show user
17626 @item show user
17627 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
17628 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17629 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17630 definitions for all user-defined commands.
17631
17632 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17633 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
17634 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
17635 @item show max-user-call-depth
17636 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
17637 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17638 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17639 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17640 @end table
17641
17642 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17643 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17644
17645 When user-defined commands are executed, the
17646 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17647 stops execution of the user-defined command.
17648
17649 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17650 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17651 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17652 messages when used in a user-defined command.
17653
17654 @node Hooks
17655 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17656 @cindex command hooks
17657 @cindex hooks, for commands
17658 @cindex hooks, pre-command
17659
17660 @kindex hook
17661 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17662 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17663 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17664 before that command.
17665
17666 @cindex hooks, post-command
17667 @kindex hookpost
17668 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17669 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17670 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17671 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17672 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17673
17674 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17675 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17676
17677 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17678 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17679
17680 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17681 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17682 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17683 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17684 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17685
17686 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17687 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17688 you could define:
17689
17690 @smallexample
17691 define hook-stop
17692 handle SIGALRM nopass
17693 end
17694
17695 define hook-run
17696 handle SIGALRM pass
17697 end
17698
17699 define hook-continue
17700 handle SIGALRM pass
17701 end
17702 @end smallexample
17703
17704 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17705 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17706 you could define:
17707
17708 @smallexample
17709 define hook-echo
17710 echo <<<---
17711 end
17712
17713 define hookpost-echo
17714 echo --->>>\n
17715 end
17716
17717 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17718 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17719 (@value{GDBP})
17720
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17724 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17725 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17726 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17727 @c or not?
17728 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
17729 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
17730 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
17731
17732 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17733 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17734 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17735
17736 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17737 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17738
17739 @node Command Files
17740 @subsection Command Files
17741
17742 @cindex command files
17743 @cindex scripting commands
17744 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17745 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17746 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17747 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17748 terminal.
17749
17750 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17751 command:
17752
17753 @table @code
17754 @kindex source
17755 @cindex execute commands from a file
17756 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17757 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17758 @end table
17759
17760 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17761 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17762 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17763 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17764 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17765
17766 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17767 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17768
17769 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17770 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17771 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17772
17773 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17774 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17775 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17776 when called from command files.
17777
17778 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17779 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17780 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17781 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17782 the next command.
17783
17784 @smallexample
17785 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17786 @end smallexample
17787
17788 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17789 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17790 would be directed to @file{log}.
17791
17792 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17793 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17794 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17795 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17796 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17797 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17798 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17799 conditionally, etc.
17800
17801 @table @code
17802 @kindex if
17803 @kindex else
17804 @item if
17805 @itemx else
17806 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17807 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17808 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17809 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17810 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17811 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17812 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17813
17814 @kindex while
17815 @item while
17816 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17817 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17818 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17819 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17820 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17821 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17822
17823 @kindex loop_break
17824 @item loop_break
17825 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17826 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17827 line.
17828
17829 @kindex loop_continue
17830 @item loop_continue
17831 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17832 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17833 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17834 the controlling expression.
17835
17836 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17837 @item end
17838 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17839 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17840 @end table
17841
17842
17843 @node Output
17844 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
17845
17846 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17847 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17848 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17849 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17850 want.
17851
17852 @table @code
17853 @kindex echo
17854 @item echo @var{text}
17855 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17856 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17857 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17858 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17859 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17860 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17861 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17862 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17863 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17864 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17865 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17866
17867 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17868 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17869
17870 @smallexample
17871 echo This is some text\n\
17872 which is continued\n\
17873 onto several lines.\n
17874 @end smallexample
17875
17876 produces the same output as
17877
17878 @smallexample
17879 echo This is some text\n
17880 echo which is continued\n
17881 echo onto several lines.\n
17882 @end smallexample
17883
17884 @kindex output
17885 @item output @var{expression}
17886 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17887 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17888 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17889 on expressions.
17890
17891 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17892 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17893 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17894 Formats}, for more information.
17895
17896 @kindex printf
17897 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17898 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17899 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17900 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17901 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17902 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17903 executing the code below:
17904
17905 @smallexample
17906 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17907 @end smallexample
17908
17909 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17910 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17911 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17912 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17913 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17914 printed.
17915
17916 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17917
17918 @smallexample
17919 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17920 @end smallexample
17921
17922 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17923 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17924 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17925
17926 @itemize @bullet
17927 @item
17928 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17929
17930 @item
17931 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17932 width.
17933
17934 @item
17935 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17936 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17937
17938 @item
17939 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17940 supported.
17941
17942 @item
17943 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17944
17945 @item
17946 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17947 @end itemize
17948
17949 @noindent
17950 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17951 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17952 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17953 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17954
17955 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17956 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17957 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17958 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17959 supported.
17960
17961 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17962 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17963 together with a floating point specifier.
17964 letters:
17965
17966 @itemize @bullet
17967 @item
17968 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17969
17970 @item
17971 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17972
17973 @item
17974 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17975 @end itemize
17976
17977 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17978 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17979 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17980
17981 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17982 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17983
17984 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17985 @smallexample
17986 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17987 @end smallexample
17988
17989 @end table
17990
17991 @node Python
17992 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17993 @cindex python scripting
17994 @cindex scripting with python
17995
17996 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
17997 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
17998 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
17999
18000 @menu
18001 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
18002 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
18003 @end menu
18004
18005 @node Python Commands
18006 @subsection Python Commands
18007 @cindex python commands
18008 @cindex commands to access python
18009
18010 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
18011 and one related setting:
18012
18013 @table @code
18014 @kindex python
18015 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18016 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18017
18018 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18019 argument as a Python command. For example:
18020
18021 @smallexample
18022 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18023 23
18024 @end smallexample
18025
18026 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18027 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18028 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18029 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18030 containing @code{end}. For example:
18031
18032 @smallexample
18033 (@value{GDBP}) python
18034 Type python script
18035 End with a line saying just "end".
18036 >print 23
18037 >end
18038 23
18039 @end smallexample
18040
18041 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18042 @item maint set python print-stack
18043 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18044 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18045 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18046 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18047 disabled.
18048 @end table
18049
18050 @node Python API
18051 @subsection Python API
18052 @cindex python api
18053 @cindex programming in python
18054
18055 @cindex python stdout
18056 @cindex python pagination
18057 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18058 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18059 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18060 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18061 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18062
18063 @menu
18064 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18065 * Exception Handling::
18066 * Values From Inferior::
18067 @end menu
18068
18069 @node Basic Python
18070 @subsubsection Basic Python
18071
18072 @cindex python functions
18073 @cindex python module
18074 @cindex gdb module
18075 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18076 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18077 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18078 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18079
18080 @findex gdb.execute
18081 @defun execute command
18082 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18083 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18084 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18085 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18086 @end defun
18087
18088 @findex gdb.get_parameter
18089 @defun get_parameter parameter
18090 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18091 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18092 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18093 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18094
18095 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18096 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18097 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18098 @end defun
18099
18100 @findex gdb.write
18101 @defun write string
18102 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18103 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18104 call this function.
18105 @end defun
18106
18107 @findex gdb.flush
18108 @defun flush
18109 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18110 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18111 function.
18112 @end defun
18113
18114 @node Exception Handling
18115 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18116 @cindex python exceptions
18117 @cindex exceptions, python
18118
18119 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18120 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18121 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18122 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18123 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18124 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18125 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18126
18127 @smallexample
18128 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18129 Traceback (most recent call last):
18130 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18131 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18132 @end smallexample
18133
18134 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18135 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18136 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18137 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18138 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18139 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18140 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18141 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18142 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18143 traceback.
18144
18145 @node Values From Inferior
18146 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18147 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18148 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18149
18150 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18151 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18152 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18153 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18154 fetching values when necessary.
18155
18156 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18157 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18158 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18159
18160 @smallexample
18161 bar = some_val + 2
18162 @end smallexample
18163
18164 @noindent
18165 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18166 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18167
18168 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18169 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18170 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18171 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18172
18173 @smallexample
18174 bar = some_val['foo']
18175 @end smallexample
18176
18177 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18178
18179 For pointer data types, @code{gdb.Value} provides a method for
18180 dereferencing the pointer to obtain the object it points to.
18181
18182 @defmethod Value dereference
18183 This method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object whose contents is
18184 the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if @code{foo} is
18185 a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
18186
18187 @smallexample
18188 int *foo;
18189 @end smallexample
18190
18191 @noindent
18192 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
18193 @code{foo} points to like this:
18194
18195 @smallexample
18196 bar = foo.dereference ()
18197 @end smallexample
18198
18199 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
18200 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
18201 @end defmethod
18202
18203 @node Interpreters
18204 @chapter Command Interpreters
18205 @cindex command interpreters
18206
18207 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
18208 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
18209 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
18210
18211 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
18212 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
18213 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
18214 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
18215
18216 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
18217 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
18218 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
18219 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
18220
18221 @table @code
18222 @item console
18223 @cindex console interpreter
18224 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
18225 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
18226 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
18227
18228 @item mi
18229 @cindex mi interpreter
18230 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
18231 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
18232 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
18233 Interface}.
18234
18235 @item mi2
18236 @cindex mi2 interpreter
18237 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
18238
18239 @item mi1
18240 @cindex mi1 interpreter
18241 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
18242
18243 @end table
18244
18245 @cindex invoke another interpreter
18246 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
18247 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
18248 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
18249 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
18250 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
18251 the IDE inoperable!
18252
18253 @kindex interpreter-exec
18254 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
18255 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
18256 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
18257 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
18258
18259 @smallexample
18260 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
18261 @end smallexample
18262
18263 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
18264 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
18265
18266 @node TUI
18267 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
18268 @cindex TUI
18269 @cindex Text User Interface
18270
18271 @menu
18272 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
18273 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
18274 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
18275 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
18276 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
18277 @end menu
18278
18279 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
18280 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
18281 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
18282 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
18283 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
18284 is available.
18285
18286 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
18287 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
18288 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
18289 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
18290 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
18291 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
18292
18293 @node TUI Overview
18294 @section TUI Overview
18295
18296 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
18297
18298 @table @emph
18299 @item command
18300 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
18301 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
18302 managed using readline.
18303
18304 @item source
18305 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
18306 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
18307
18308 @item assembly
18309 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
18310
18311 @item register
18312 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
18313 when their values change.
18314 @end table
18315
18316 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
18317 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
18318 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
18319 indicates the breakpoint type:
18320
18321 @table @code
18322 @item B
18323 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18324
18325 @item b
18326 Breakpoint which was never hit.
18327
18328 @item H
18329 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18330
18331 @item h
18332 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
18333 @end table
18334
18335 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
18336
18337 @table @code
18338 @item +
18339 Breakpoint is enabled.
18340
18341 @item -
18342 Breakpoint is disabled.
18343 @end table
18344
18345 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
18346 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
18347 changes.
18348
18349 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
18350 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
18351 layouts:
18352
18353 @itemize @bullet
18354 @item
18355 source only,
18356
18357 @item
18358 assembly only,
18359
18360 @item
18361 source and assembly,
18362
18363 @item
18364 source and registers, or
18365
18366 @item
18367 assembly and registers.
18368 @end itemize
18369
18370 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
18371
18372 @table @emph
18373 @item target
18374 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
18375 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
18376
18377 @item process
18378 Gives the current process or thread number.
18379 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
18380
18381 @item function
18382 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
18383 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
18384 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
18385 the string @code{??} is displayed.
18386
18387 @item line
18388 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
18389 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
18390
18391 @item pc
18392 Indicates the current program counter address.
18393 @end table
18394
18395 @node TUI Keys
18396 @section TUI Key Bindings
18397 @cindex TUI key bindings
18398
18399 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
18400 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
18401 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
18402
18403 @table @kbd
18404 @kindex C-x C-a
18405 @item C-x C-a
18406 @kindex C-x a
18407 @itemx C-x a
18408 @kindex C-x A
18409 @itemx C-x A
18410 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
18411 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
18412 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
18413 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
18414 The screen is then refreshed.
18415
18416 @kindex C-x 1
18417 @item C-x 1
18418 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
18419 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
18420 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
18421
18422 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
18423
18424 @kindex C-x 2
18425 @item C-x 2
18426 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
18427 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
18428 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
18429 previous layout and the new one.
18430
18431 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
18432
18433 @kindex C-x o
18434 @item C-x o
18435 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
18436 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
18437 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
18438
18439 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
18440
18441 @kindex C-x s
18442 @item C-x s
18443 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
18444 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
18445 @end table
18446
18447 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
18448
18449 @table @asis
18450 @kindex PgUp
18451 @item @key{PgUp}
18452 Scroll the active window one page up.
18453
18454 @kindex PgDn
18455 @item @key{PgDn}
18456 Scroll the active window one page down.
18457
18458 @kindex Up
18459 @item @key{Up}
18460 Scroll the active window one line up.
18461
18462 @kindex Down
18463 @item @key{Down}
18464 Scroll the active window one line down.
18465
18466 @kindex Left
18467 @item @key{Left}
18468 Scroll the active window one column left.
18469
18470 @kindex Right
18471 @item @key{Right}
18472 Scroll the active window one column right.
18473
18474 @kindex C-L
18475 @item @kbd{C-L}
18476 Refresh the screen.
18477 @end table
18478
18479 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
18480 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
18481 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
18482 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
18483 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
18484
18485 @node TUI Single Key Mode
18486 @section TUI Single Key Mode
18487 @cindex TUI single key mode
18488
18489 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
18490 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
18491 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
18492
18493 @table @kbd
18494 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18495 @item c
18496 continue
18497
18498 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18499 @item d
18500 down
18501
18502 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18503 @item f
18504 finish
18505
18506 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18507 @item n
18508 next
18509
18510 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18511 @item q
18512 exit the SingleKey mode.
18513
18514 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18515 @item r
18516 run
18517
18518 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18519 @item s
18520 step
18521
18522 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18523 @item u
18524 up
18525
18526 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18527 @item v
18528 info locals
18529
18530 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18531 @item w
18532 where
18533 @end table
18534
18535 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
18536 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
18537 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
18538 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
18539 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
18540 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
18541
18542
18543 @node TUI Commands
18544 @section TUI-specific Commands
18545 @cindex TUI commands
18546
18547 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
18548 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
18549 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
18550 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
18551
18552 @table @code
18553 @item info win
18554 @kindex info win
18555 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
18556
18557 @item layout next
18558 @kindex layout
18559 Display the next layout.
18560
18561 @item layout prev
18562 Display the previous layout.
18563
18564 @item layout src
18565 Display the source window only.
18566
18567 @item layout asm
18568 Display the assembly window only.
18569
18570 @item layout split
18571 Display the source and assembly window.
18572
18573 @item layout regs
18574 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
18575
18576 @item focus next
18577 @kindex focus
18578 Make the next window active for scrolling.
18579
18580 @item focus prev
18581 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
18582
18583 @item focus src
18584 Make the source window active for scrolling.
18585
18586 @item focus asm
18587 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
18588
18589 @item focus regs
18590 Make the register window active for scrolling.
18591
18592 @item focus cmd
18593 Make the command window active for scrolling.
18594
18595 @item refresh
18596 @kindex refresh
18597 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
18598
18599 @item tui reg float
18600 @kindex tui reg
18601 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
18602
18603 @item tui reg general
18604 Show the general registers in the register window.
18605
18606 @item tui reg next
18607 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
18608 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
18609 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
18610 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
18611
18612 @item tui reg system
18613 Show the system registers in the register window.
18614
18615 @item update
18616 @kindex update
18617 Update the source window and the current execution point.
18618
18619 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
18620 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
18621 @kindex winheight
18622 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
18623 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
18624 decrease it.
18625
18626 @item tabset @var{nchars}
18627 @kindex tabset
18628 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
18629 @end table
18630
18631 @node TUI Configuration
18632 @section TUI Configuration Variables
18633 @cindex TUI configuration variables
18634
18635 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
18636
18637 @table @code
18638 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
18639 @kindex set tui border-kind
18640 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
18641 The possible values are the following:
18642 @table @code
18643 @item space
18644 Use a space character to draw the border.
18645
18646 @item ascii
18647 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
18648
18649 @item acs
18650 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
18651 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
18652 @end table
18653
18654 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
18655 @kindex set tui border-mode
18656 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
18657 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
18658 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
18659 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
18660 @table @code
18661 @item normal
18662 Use normal attributes to display the border.
18663
18664 @item standout
18665 Use standout mode.
18666
18667 @item reverse
18668 Use reverse video mode.
18669
18670 @item half
18671 Use half bright mode.
18672
18673 @item half-standout
18674 Use half bright and standout mode.
18675
18676 @item bold
18677 Use extra bright or bold mode.
18678
18679 @item bold-standout
18680 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
18681 @end table
18682 @end table
18683
18684 @node Emacs
18685 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
18686
18687 @cindex Emacs
18688 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
18689 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
18690 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
18691 @value{GDBN}.
18692
18693 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
18694 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
18695 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
18696 created Emacs buffer.
18697 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
18698
18699 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
18700 things:
18701
18702 @itemize @bullet
18703 @item
18704 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
18705 the GUD buffer.
18706
18707 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
18708 and output done by the program you are debugging.
18709
18710 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
18711 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
18712 in this way.
18713
18714 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
18715 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
18716 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
18717 stop.
18718
18719 @item
18720 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
18721
18722 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
18723 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
18724 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
18725 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
18726 and the source.
18727
18728 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
18729 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
18730 @end itemize
18731
18732 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
18733 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
18734 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
18735 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
18736
18737 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
18738 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
18739 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
18740 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
18741 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
18742 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
18743 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
18744 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
18745 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
18746
18747 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
18748 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
18749 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
18750 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
18751
18752 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
18753 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
18754 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
18755 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
18756 one you want.
18757
18758 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
18759 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
18760
18761 @table @kbd
18762 @item C-h m
18763 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
18764
18765 @item C-c C-s
18766 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
18767 update the display window to show the current file and location.
18768
18769 @item C-c C-n
18770 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
18771 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
18772 to show the current file and location.
18773
18774 @item C-c C-i
18775 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
18776 display window accordingly.
18777
18778 @item C-c C-f
18779 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
18780 @code{finish} command.
18781
18782 @item C-c C-r
18783 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
18784 command.
18785
18786 @item C-c <
18787 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
18788 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
18789 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
18790
18791 @item C-c >
18792 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
18793 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
18794 @end table
18795
18796 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
18797 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
18798
18799 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
18800 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
18801 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
18802 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
18803 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
18804 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
18805 speedbar displays watch expressions.
18806
18807 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
18808 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
18809 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
18810 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
18811 frame.
18812
18813 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
18814 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
18815 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
18816 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
18817 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
18818 to correspond properly with the code.
18819
18820 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
18821 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
18822 Emacs Manual}).
18823
18824 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
18825 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
18826 @ignore
18827 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
18828 @kindex Epoch
18829 @kindex inspect
18830
18831 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
18832 called the @code{epoch}
18833 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
18834 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
18835 each value is printed in its own window.
18836 @end ignore
18837
18838
18839 @node GDB/MI
18840 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
18841
18842 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
18843
18844 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
18845 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
18846 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
18847 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
18848 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
18849 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
18850
18851 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
18852 in the form of a reference manual.
18853
18854 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
18855 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
18856 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
18857
18858 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
18859
18860 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
18861 This chapter uses the following notation:
18862
18863 @itemize @bullet
18864 @item
18865 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
18866
18867 @item
18868 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
18869 it may or may not be given.
18870
18871 @item
18872 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18873 may repeat zero or more times.
18874
18875 @item
18876 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18877 may repeat one or more times.
18878
18879 @item
18880 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
18881 @end itemize
18882
18883 @ignore
18884 @heading Dependencies
18885 @end ignore
18886
18887 @menu
18888 * GDB/MI General Design::
18889 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
18890 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
18891 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
18892 * GDB/MI Output Records::
18893 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
18894 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
18895 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
18896 * GDB/MI Program Context::
18897 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
18898 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
18899 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
18900 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
18901 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
18902 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
18903 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
18904 * GDB/MI File Commands::
18905 @ignore
18906 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
18907 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
18908 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
18909 @end ignore
18910 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
18911 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
18912 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
18913 @end menu
18914
18915 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18916 @node GDB/MI General Design
18917 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
18918 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
18919
18920 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
18921 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
18922 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
18923 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
18924 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
18925 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
18926 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
18927 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
18928 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
18929 a command and reported as part of that command response.
18930
18931 The important examples of notifications are:
18932 @itemize @bullet
18933
18934 @item
18935 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
18936 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
18937 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
18938 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
18939 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
18940 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
18941 command itself was successfully executed.
18942
18943 @item
18944 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
18945 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
18946 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
18947 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
18948 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
18949 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
18950
18951 @item
18952 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
18953 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
18954 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
18955 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
18956 orthogonal frontend design.
18957
18958 @end itemize
18959
18960 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
18961 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
18962 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
18963 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
18964 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
18965 the user interface.
18966
18967 @subsection Context management
18968
18969 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
18970 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
18971 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
18972 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
18973 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
18974 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
18975 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
18976 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
18977 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
18978
18979 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
18980 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
18981 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
18982 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
18983 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
18984 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
18985 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
18986 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
18987 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
18988 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
18989 for thread and frame to operate on.
18990
18991 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
18992 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
18993 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
18994 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
18995 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
18996 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
18997 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
18998 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
18999 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
19000 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
19001
19002 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
19003 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
19004 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
19005 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
19006 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
19007 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
19008 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
19009 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
19010 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
19011 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
19012 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
19013 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
19014 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
19015 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
19016 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
19017 @samp{--frame} options.
19018
19019 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
19020
19021 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
19022 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
19023 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
19024 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
19025 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
19026 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
19027 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
19028 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
19029 @code{-list-target-features} command.
19030
19031 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
19032 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
19033 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
19034 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
19035 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
19036 are running.
19037
19038 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
19039 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
19040 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
19041 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
19042 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
19043 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
19044 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
19045 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
19046 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
19047 @samp{--thread} option).
19048
19049 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
19050 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
19051 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
19052 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
19053
19054 @subsection Thread groups
19055 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
19056 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
19057 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
19058 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
19059 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
19060
19061 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
19062 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
19063 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
19064 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
19065 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
19066 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
19067 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
19068 into processes.
19069
19070 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
19071 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
19072 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
19073 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
19074 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
19075 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
19076 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
19077 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
19078 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
19079 the members of specific thread group.
19080
19081 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
19082 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
19083 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
19084 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
19085 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
19086 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
19087 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
19088 after attaching to that thread group.
19089
19090 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19091 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
19092 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
19093
19094 @menu
19095 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
19096 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
19097 @end menu
19098
19099 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
19100 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
19101
19102 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
19103 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
19104 @table @code
19105 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
19106 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
19107
19108 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
19109 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
19110 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19111
19112 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
19113 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
19114 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
19115
19116 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19117 "any sequence of digits"
19118
19119 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
19120 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
19121
19122 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
19123 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
19124
19125 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
19126 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
19127
19128 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
19129 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
19130 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
19131
19132 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
19133 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
19134
19135 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19136 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19137 @end table
19138
19139 @noindent
19140 Notes:
19141
19142 @itemize @bullet
19143 @item
19144 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
19145 output is described below.
19146
19147 @item
19148 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
19149 finishes.
19150
19151 @item
19152 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
19153 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
19154 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
19155 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
19156 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
19157 @end itemize
19158
19159 Pragmatics:
19160
19161 @itemize @bullet
19162 @item
19163 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
19164
19165 @item
19166 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
19167 @end itemize
19168
19169 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
19170 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
19171
19172 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
19173 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
19174 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
19175 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
19176 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
19177 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
19178
19179 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
19180 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
19181 @var{token}.
19182
19183 @table @code
19184 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
19185 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
19186
19187 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
19188 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19189
19190 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
19191 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
19192
19193 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
19194 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
19195
19196 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
19197 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
19198
19199 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
19200 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
19201
19202 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
19203 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
19204
19205 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
19206 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19207
19208 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
19209 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
19210
19211 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
19212 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
19213 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
19214
19215 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
19216 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
19217
19218 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
19219 @code{ @var{string} }
19220
19221 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
19222 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
19223
19224 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
19225 @code{@var{c-string}}
19226
19227 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
19228 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
19229
19230 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
19231 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
19232 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
19233
19234 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
19235 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
19236
19237 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
19238 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
19239
19240 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
19241 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
19242
19243 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
19244 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
19245
19246 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19247 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19248
19249 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19250 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
19251 @end table
19252
19253 @noindent
19254 Notes:
19255
19256 @itemize @bullet
19257 @item
19258 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
19259
19260 @item
19261 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
19262 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
19263 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
19264 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
19265 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
19266 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
19267 prior command.
19268
19269 @item
19270 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19271 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
19272 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
19273 prefixed by @samp{+}.
19274
19275 @item
19276 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19277 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
19278 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
19279 @samp{*}.
19280
19281 @item
19282 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19283 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
19284 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
19285 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
19286
19287 @item
19288 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19289 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
19290 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
19291 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
19292
19293 @item
19294 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19295 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
19296 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
19297
19298 @item
19299 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19300 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
19301 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
19302 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
19303
19304 @item
19305 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19306 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
19307 @var{values}.
19308
19309
19310 @end itemize
19311
19312 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
19313 details about the various output records.
19314
19315 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19316 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
19317 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
19318
19319 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
19320 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
19321
19322 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
19323 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
19324 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
19325 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
19326 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
19327 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
19328
19329 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
19330 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
19331 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
19332
19333 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19334 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
19335 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
19336 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
19337
19338 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
19339 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
19340
19341 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
19342 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
19343 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
19344 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
19345 might change.
19346
19347 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
19348 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
19349 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
19350 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
19351
19352 @itemize @bullet
19353 @item
19354 New MI commands may be added.
19355
19356 @item
19357 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
19358
19359 @item
19360 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
19361 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
19362
19363 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
19364 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
19365
19366 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
19367 @c resolve inconsistencies.
19368 @end itemize
19369
19370 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
19371 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
19372 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
19373 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
19374 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
19375
19376 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
19377 @c version?
19378
19379 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
19380 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
19381 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
19382 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
19383 @cindex mailing lists
19384
19385 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19386 @node GDB/MI Output Records
19387 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
19388
19389 @menu
19390 * GDB/MI Result Records::
19391 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
19392 * GDB/MI Async Records::
19393 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
19394 @end menu
19395
19396 @node GDB/MI Result Records
19397 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
19398
19399 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19400 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
19401 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
19402 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
19403
19404 @table @code
19405 @findex ^done
19406 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
19407 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
19408 values.
19409
19410 @item "^running"
19411 @findex ^running
19412 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
19413 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
19414 running.
19415
19416 @item "^connected"
19417 @findex ^connected
19418 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
19419
19420 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
19421 @findex ^error
19422 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
19423 error message.
19424
19425 @item "^exit"
19426 @findex ^exit
19427 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
19428
19429 @end table
19430
19431 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
19432 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
19433
19434 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
19435 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19436 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
19437 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
19438 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
19439
19440 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
19441 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
19442 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
19443 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
19444 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
19445
19446 @table @code
19447 @item "~" @var{string-output}
19448 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
19449 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
19450
19451 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
19452 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
19453 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
19454 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
19455
19456 @item "&" @var{string-output}
19457 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
19458 internals.
19459 @end table
19460
19461 @node GDB/MI Async Records
19462 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
19463
19464 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19465 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
19466 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
19467 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
19468 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
19469 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
19470
19471 The following is the list of possible async records:
19472
19473 @table @code
19474
19475 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
19476 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
19477 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
19478 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
19479 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
19480 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
19481 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
19482 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
19483 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
19484 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
19485
19486 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
19487 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
19488 following values:
19489
19490 @table @code
19491 @item breakpoint-hit
19492 A breakpoint was reached.
19493 @item watchpoint-trigger
19494 A watchpoint was triggered.
19495 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
19496 A read watchpoint was triggered.
19497 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
19498 An access watchpoint was triggered.
19499 @item function-finished
19500 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
19501 @item location-reached
19502 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
19503 @item watchpoint-scope
19504 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
19505 @item end-stepping-range
19506 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
19507 similar CLI command was accomplished.
19508 @item exited-signalled
19509 The inferior exited because of a signal.
19510 @item exited
19511 The inferior exited.
19512 @item exited-normally
19513 The inferior exited normally.
19514 @item signal-received
19515 A signal was received by the inferior.
19516 @end table
19517
19518 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
19519 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
19520 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
19521 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
19522 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
19523 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
19524 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
19525 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
19526 several threads in the list.
19527
19528 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
19529 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
19530 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
19531 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
19532 thread group.
19533
19534 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
19535 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
19536 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
19537 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
19538 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
19539
19540 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
19541 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
19542 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
19543 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
19544 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
19545 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
19546 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
19547
19548 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
19549 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
19550 that thread.
19551
19552 @end table
19553
19554 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
19555 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
19556
19557 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
19558 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
19559 fields:
19560
19561 @table @code
19562 @item level
19563 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
19564 zero. This field is always present.
19565
19566 @item func
19567 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
19568 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
19569
19570 @item addr
19571 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
19572
19573 @item file
19574 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
19575 address. This field may be absent.
19576
19577 @item line
19578 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
19579 may be absent.
19580
19581 @item from
19582 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
19583 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
19584
19585 @end table
19586
19587
19588 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19589 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
19590 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
19591 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
19592
19593 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
19594 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
19595 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
19596 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
19597
19598 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
19599 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
19600
19601 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
19602
19603 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
19604 information of the breakpoint.
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 -> -break-insert main
19608 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
19609 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
19610 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
19611 <- (gdb)
19612 @end smallexample
19613
19614 @subheading Program Execution
19615
19616 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
19617 reason that execution stopped.
19618
19619 @smallexample
19620 -> -exec-run
19621 <- ^running
19622 <- (gdb)
19623 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
19624 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
19625 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
19626 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
19627 <- (gdb)
19628 -> -exec-continue
19629 <- ^running
19630 <- (gdb)
19631 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19632 <- (gdb)
19633 @end smallexample
19634
19635 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
19636
19637 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
19638
19639 @smallexample
19640 -> (gdb)
19641 <- -gdb-exit
19642 <- ^exit
19643 @end smallexample
19644
19645 @subheading A Bad Command
19646
19647 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
19648
19649 @smallexample
19650 -> -rubbish
19651 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
19652 <- (gdb)
19653 @end smallexample
19654
19655
19656 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19657 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
19658 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
19659
19660 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
19661 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
19662
19663 @subheading Motivation
19664
19665 The motivation for this collection of commands.
19666
19667 @subheading Introduction
19668
19669 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
19670
19671 @subheading Commands
19672
19673 For each command in the block, the following is described:
19674
19675 @subsubheading Synopsis
19676
19677 @smallexample
19678 -command @var{args}@dots{}
19679 @end smallexample
19680
19681 @subsubheading Result
19682
19683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19684
19685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
19686
19687 @subsubheading Example
19688
19689 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
19690 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
19691
19692
19693 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19694 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
19695 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
19696
19697 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
19698 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
19699 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
19700 breakpoints.
19701
19702 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
19703 @findex -break-after
19704
19705 @subsubheading Synopsis
19706
19707 @smallexample
19708 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
19709 @end smallexample
19710
19711 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
19712 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
19713 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
19714 @samp{-break-list} command below.
19715
19716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19717
19718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
19719
19720 @subsubheading Example
19721
19722 @smallexample
19723 (gdb)
19724 -break-insert main
19725 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
19726 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
19727 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
19728 (gdb)
19729 -break-after 1 3
19730 ~
19731 ^done
19732 (gdb)
19733 -break-list
19734 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19735 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19736 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19737 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19738 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19739 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19740 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19741 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19742 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19743 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19744 (gdb)
19745 @end smallexample
19746
19747 @ignore
19748 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
19749 @findex -break-catch
19750
19751 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
19752 @findex -break-commands
19753 @end ignore
19754
19755
19756 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
19757 @findex -break-condition
19758
19759 @subsubheading Synopsis
19760
19761 @smallexample
19762 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
19763 @end smallexample
19764
19765 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
19766 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
19767 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
19768 command below).
19769
19770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19771
19772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
19773
19774 @subsubheading Example
19775
19776 @smallexample
19777 (gdb)
19778 -break-condition 1 1
19779 ^done
19780 (gdb)
19781 -break-list
19782 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19783 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19784 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19785 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19786 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19787 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19788 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19789 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19790 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19791 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19792 (gdb)
19793 @end smallexample
19794
19795 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
19796 @findex -break-delete
19797
19798 @subsubheading Synopsis
19799
19800 @smallexample
19801 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19802 @end smallexample
19803
19804 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
19805 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
19806
19807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19808
19809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
19810
19811 @subsubheading Example
19812
19813 @smallexample
19814 (gdb)
19815 -break-delete 1
19816 ^done
19817 (gdb)
19818 -break-list
19819 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19820 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19821 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19822 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19823 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19824 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19825 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19826 body=[]@}
19827 (gdb)
19828 @end smallexample
19829
19830 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
19831 @findex -break-disable
19832
19833 @subsubheading Synopsis
19834
19835 @smallexample
19836 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19837 @end smallexample
19838
19839 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
19840 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
19841
19842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19843
19844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
19845
19846 @subsubheading Example
19847
19848 @smallexample
19849 (gdb)
19850 -break-disable 2
19851 ^done
19852 (gdb)
19853 -break-list
19854 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19855 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19856 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19857 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19858 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19859 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19860 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19861 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
19862 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19863 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19864 (gdb)
19865 @end smallexample
19866
19867 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
19868 @findex -break-enable
19869
19870 @subsubheading Synopsis
19871
19872 @smallexample
19873 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19874 @end smallexample
19875
19876 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
19877
19878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19879
19880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
19881
19882 @subsubheading Example
19883
19884 @smallexample
19885 (gdb)
19886 -break-enable 2
19887 ^done
19888 (gdb)
19889 -break-list
19890 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19891 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19892 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19893 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19894 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19895 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19896 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19897 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19898 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19899 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19900 (gdb)
19901 @end smallexample
19902
19903 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
19904 @findex -break-info
19905
19906 @subsubheading Synopsis
19907
19908 @smallexample
19909 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
19910 @end smallexample
19911
19912 @c REDUNDANT???
19913 Get information about a single breakpoint.
19914
19915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19916
19917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
19918
19919 @subsubheading Example
19920 N.A.
19921
19922 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
19923 @findex -break-insert
19924
19925 @subsubheading Synopsis
19926
19927 @smallexample
19928 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
19929 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
19930 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
19931 @end smallexample
19932
19933 @noindent
19934 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
19935
19936 @itemize @bullet
19937 @item function
19938 @c @item +offset
19939 @c @item -offset
19940 @c @item linenum
19941 @item filename:linenum
19942 @item filename:function
19943 @item *address
19944 @end itemize
19945
19946 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
19947
19948 @table @samp
19949 @item -t
19950 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
19951 @item -h
19952 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
19953 @item -c @var{condition}
19954 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
19955 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
19956 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
19957 @item -f
19958 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
19959 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
19960 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
19961 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
19962 cannot be parsed.
19963 @end table
19964
19965 @subsubheading Result
19966
19967 The result is in the form:
19968
19969 @smallexample
19970 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
19971 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
19972 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
19973 times="@var{times}"@}
19974 @end smallexample
19975
19976 @noindent
19977 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
19978 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
19979 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
19980 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
19981 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
19982 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
19983 which use the same output).
19984
19985 Note: this format is open to change.
19986 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
19987
19988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19989
19990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
19991 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
19992
19993 @subsubheading Example
19994
19995 @smallexample
19996 (gdb)
19997 -break-insert main
19998 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
19999 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
20000 (gdb)
20001 -break-insert -t foo
20002 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
20003 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
20004 (gdb)
20005 -break-list
20006 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20007 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20008 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20009 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20010 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20011 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20012 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20013 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20014 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
20015 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
20016 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
20017 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
20018 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
20019 (gdb)
20020 -break-insert -r foo.*
20021 ~int foo(int, int);
20022 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
20023 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
20024 (gdb)
20025 @end smallexample
20026
20027 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
20028 @findex -break-list
20029
20030 @subsubheading Synopsis
20031
20032 @smallexample
20033 -break-list
20034 @end smallexample
20035
20036 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
20037
20038 @table @samp
20039 @item Number
20040 number of the breakpoint
20041 @item Type
20042 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
20043 @item Disposition
20044 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
20045 or @samp{nokeep}
20046 @item Enabled
20047 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
20048 @item Address
20049 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
20050 @item What
20051 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
20052 name, line number
20053 @item Times
20054 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
20055 @end table
20056
20057 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
20058 @code{body} field is an empty list.
20059
20060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20061
20062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
20063
20064 @subsubheading Example
20065
20066 @smallexample
20067 (gdb)
20068 -break-list
20069 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20070 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20071 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20072 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20073 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20074 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20075 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20076 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20077 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
20078 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20079 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20080 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
20081 (gdb)
20082 @end smallexample
20083
20084 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
20085
20086 @smallexample
20087 (gdb)
20088 -break-list
20089 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20090 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20091 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20092 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20093 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20094 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20095 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20096 body=[]@}
20097 (gdb)
20098 @end smallexample
20099
20100 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
20101 @findex -break-watch
20102
20103 @subsubheading Synopsis
20104
20105 @smallexample
20106 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
20107 @end smallexample
20108
20109 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
20110 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
20111 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
20112 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
20113 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
20114 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
20115 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
20116 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
20117
20118 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
20119 breakpoints inserted.
20120
20121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20122
20123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
20124 @samp{rwatch}.
20125
20126 @subsubheading Example
20127
20128 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
20129
20130 @smallexample
20131 (gdb)
20132 -break-watch x
20133 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
20134 (gdb)
20135 -exec-continue
20136 ^running
20137 (gdb)
20138 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
20139 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
20140 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20141 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
20142 (gdb)
20143 @end smallexample
20144
20145 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
20146 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
20147 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
20148
20149 @smallexample
20150 (gdb)
20151 -break-watch C
20152 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
20153 (gdb)
20154 -exec-continue
20155 ^running
20156 (gdb)
20157 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
20158 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20159 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20160 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20161 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20162 (gdb)
20163 -exec-continue
20164 ^running
20165 (gdb)
20166 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
20167 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20168 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20169 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20170 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20171 (gdb)
20172 @end smallexample
20173
20174 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
20175 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
20176 deleted.
20177
20178 @smallexample
20179 (gdb)
20180 -break-watch C
20181 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
20182 (gdb)
20183 -break-list
20184 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20185 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20186 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20187 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20188 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20189 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20190 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20191 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20192 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20193 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20194 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
20195 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20196 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
20197 (gdb)
20198 -exec-continue
20199 ^running
20200 (gdb)
20201 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
20202 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20203 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20204 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20205 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20206 (gdb)
20207 -break-list
20208 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20209 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20210 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20211 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20212 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20213 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20214 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20215 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20216 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20217 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20218 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
20219 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20220 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
20221 (gdb)
20222 -exec-continue
20223 ^running
20224 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
20225 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20226 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20227 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20228 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20229 (gdb)
20230 -break-list
20231 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20232 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20233 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20234 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20235 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20236 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20237 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20238 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20239 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20240 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20241 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
20242 times="1"@}]@}
20243 (gdb)
20244 @end smallexample
20245
20246 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20247 @node GDB/MI Program Context
20248 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
20249
20250 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
20251 @findex -exec-arguments
20252
20253
20254 @subsubheading Synopsis
20255
20256 @smallexample
20257 -exec-arguments @var{args}
20258 @end smallexample
20259
20260 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
20261 @samp{-exec-run}.
20262
20263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20264
20265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
20266
20267 @subsubheading Example
20268
20269 @smallexample
20270 (gdb)
20271 -exec-arguments -v word
20272 ^done
20273 (gdb)
20274 @end smallexample
20275
20276
20277 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
20278 @findex -exec-show-arguments
20279
20280 @subsubheading Synopsis
20281
20282 @smallexample
20283 -exec-show-arguments
20284 @end smallexample
20285
20286 Print the arguments of the program.
20287
20288 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20289
20290 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
20291
20292 @subsubheading Example
20293 N.A.
20294
20295
20296 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
20297 @findex -environment-cd
20298
20299 @subsubheading Synopsis
20300
20301 @smallexample
20302 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
20303 @end smallexample
20304
20305 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
20306
20307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20308
20309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
20310
20311 @subsubheading Example
20312
20313 @smallexample
20314 (gdb)
20315 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
20316 ^done
20317 (gdb)
20318 @end smallexample
20319
20320
20321 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
20322 @findex -environment-directory
20323
20324 @subsubheading Synopsis
20325
20326 @smallexample
20327 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
20328 @end smallexample
20329
20330 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
20331 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
20332 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
20333 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
20334 occurs as normal.
20335 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
20336 multiple directories in a single command
20337 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
20338 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
20339 If blanks are needed as
20340 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
20341 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
20342 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
20343 character must not be used
20344 in any directory name.
20345 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
20346
20347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20348
20349 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
20350
20351 @subsubheading Example
20352
20353 @smallexample
20354 (gdb)
20355 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
20356 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
20357 (gdb)
20358 -environment-directory ""
20359 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
20360 (gdb)
20361 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
20362 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
20363 (gdb)
20364 -environment-directory -r
20365 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
20366 (gdb)
20367 @end smallexample
20368
20369
20370 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
20371 @findex -environment-path
20372
20373 @subsubheading Synopsis
20374
20375 @smallexample
20376 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
20377 @end smallexample
20378
20379 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
20380 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
20381 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
20382 supplied in addition to the
20383 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
20384 occurs as normal.
20385 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
20386 multiple directories in a single command
20387 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
20388 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
20389 If blanks are needed as
20390 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
20391 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
20392 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
20393 character must not be used
20394 in any directory name.
20395 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
20396
20397
20398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20399
20400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
20401
20402 @subsubheading Example
20403
20404 @smallexample
20405 (gdb)
20406 -environment-path
20407 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
20408 (gdb)
20409 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
20410 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
20411 (gdb)
20412 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
20413 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
20414 (gdb)
20415 @end smallexample
20416
20417
20418 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
20419 @findex -environment-pwd
20420
20421 @subsubheading Synopsis
20422
20423 @smallexample
20424 -environment-pwd
20425 @end smallexample
20426
20427 Show the current working directory.
20428
20429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20430
20431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
20432
20433 @subsubheading Example
20434
20435 @smallexample
20436 (gdb)
20437 -environment-pwd
20438 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
20439 (gdb)
20440 @end smallexample
20441
20442 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20443 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
20444 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
20445
20446
20447 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
20448 @findex -thread-info
20449
20450 @subsubheading Synopsis
20451
20452 @smallexample
20453 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
20454 @end smallexample
20455
20456 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
20457 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
20458 threads. When printing information about all threads,
20459 also reports the current thread.
20460
20461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20462
20463 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
20464 about all threads.
20465
20466 @subsubheading Example
20467
20468 @smallexample
20469 -thread-info
20470 ^done,threads=[
20471 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
20472 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
20473 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
20474 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
20475 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
20476 current-thread-id="1"
20477 (gdb)
20478 @end smallexample
20479
20480 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
20481
20482 @table @code
20483 @item stopped
20484 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
20485 threads.
20486
20487 @item running
20488 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
20489 threads.
20490
20491 @end table
20492
20493 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
20494 @findex -thread-list-ids
20495
20496 @subsubheading Synopsis
20497
20498 @smallexample
20499 -thread-list-ids
20500 @end smallexample
20501
20502 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
20503 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
20504
20505 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
20506 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
20507
20508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20509
20510 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
20511
20512 @subsubheading Example
20513
20514 No threads present, besides the main process:
20515
20516 @smallexample
20517 (gdb)
20518 -thread-list-ids
20519 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
20520 (gdb)
20521 @end smallexample
20522
20523
20524 Several threads:
20525
20526 @smallexample
20527 (gdb)
20528 -thread-list-ids
20529 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20530 number-of-threads="3"
20531 (gdb)
20532 @end smallexample
20533
20534
20535 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
20536 @findex -thread-select
20537
20538 @subsubheading Synopsis
20539
20540 @smallexample
20541 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
20542 @end smallexample
20543
20544 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
20545 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
20546
20547 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
20548 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
20549
20550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20551
20552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
20553
20554 @subsubheading Example
20555
20556 @smallexample
20557 (gdb)
20558 -exec-next
20559 ^running
20560 (gdb)
20561 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
20562 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
20563 (gdb)
20564 -thread-list-ids
20565 ^done,
20566 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20567 number-of-threads="3"
20568 (gdb)
20569 -thread-select 3
20570 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
20571 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
20572 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
20573 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
20574 (gdb)
20575 @end smallexample
20576
20577 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20578 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
20579 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
20580
20581 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
20582 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
20583 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
20584 other cases.
20585
20586 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
20587 @findex -exec-continue
20588
20589 @subsubheading Synopsis
20590
20591 @smallexample
20592 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
20593 @end smallexample
20594
20595 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
20596 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
20597 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
20598 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
20599 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
20600 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
20601 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
20602 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
20603 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
20604 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
20605 thread group are resumed.
20606
20607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20608
20609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
20610
20611 @subsubheading Example
20612
20613 @smallexample
20614 -exec-continue
20615 ^running
20616 (gdb)
20617 @@Hello world
20618 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
20619 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
20620 line="13"@}
20621 (gdb)
20622 @end smallexample
20623
20624
20625 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
20626 @findex -exec-finish
20627
20628 @subsubheading Synopsis
20629
20630 @smallexample
20631 -exec-finish
20632 @end smallexample
20633
20634 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
20635 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
20636
20637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20638
20639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
20640
20641 @subsubheading Example
20642
20643 Function returning @code{void}.
20644
20645 @smallexample
20646 -exec-finish
20647 ^running
20648 (gdb)
20649 @@hello from foo
20650 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20651 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
20652 (gdb)
20653 @end smallexample
20654
20655 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
20656 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
20657 value itself.
20658
20659 @smallexample
20660 -exec-finish
20661 ^running
20662 (gdb)
20663 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
20664 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
20665 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20666 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
20667 (gdb)
20668 @end smallexample
20669
20670
20671 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
20672 @findex -exec-interrupt
20673
20674 @subsubheading Synopsis
20675
20676 @smallexample
20677 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
20678 @end smallexample
20679
20680 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
20681 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
20682 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
20683 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
20684 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
20685
20686 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
20687 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
20688 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
20689 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
20690
20691 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
20692 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
20693 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
20694 threads in that group will be interrupted.
20695
20696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20697
20698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
20699
20700 @subsubheading Example
20701
20702 @smallexample
20703 (gdb)
20704 111-exec-continue
20705 111^running
20706
20707 (gdb)
20708 222-exec-interrupt
20709 222^done
20710 (gdb)
20711 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
20712 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20713 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
20714 (gdb)
20715
20716 (gdb)
20717 -exec-interrupt
20718 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
20719 (gdb)
20720 @end smallexample
20721
20722
20723 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
20724 @findex -exec-next
20725
20726 @subsubheading Synopsis
20727
20728 @smallexample
20729 -exec-next
20730 @end smallexample
20731
20732 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20733 of the next source line is reached.
20734
20735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20736
20737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
20738
20739 @subsubheading Example
20740
20741 @smallexample
20742 -exec-next
20743 ^running
20744 (gdb)
20745 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
20746 (gdb)
20747 @end smallexample
20748
20749
20750 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
20751 @findex -exec-next-instruction
20752
20753 @subsubheading Synopsis
20754
20755 @smallexample
20756 -exec-next-instruction
20757 @end smallexample
20758
20759 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
20760 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
20761 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
20762 printed as well.
20763
20764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20765
20766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
20767
20768 @subsubheading Example
20769
20770 @smallexample
20771 (gdb)
20772 -exec-next-instruction
20773 ^running
20774
20775 (gdb)
20776 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20777 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
20778 (gdb)
20779 @end smallexample
20780
20781
20782 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
20783 @findex -exec-return
20784
20785 @subsubheading Synopsis
20786
20787 @smallexample
20788 -exec-return
20789 @end smallexample
20790
20791 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
20792 Displays the new current frame.
20793
20794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20795
20796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
20797
20798 @subsubheading Example
20799
20800 @smallexample
20801 (gdb)
20802 200-break-insert callee4
20803 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
20804 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20805 (gdb)
20806 000-exec-run
20807 000^running
20808 (gdb)
20809 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20810 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20811 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20812 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20813 (gdb)
20814 205-break-delete
20815 205^done
20816 (gdb)
20817 111-exec-return
20818 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
20819 args=[@{name="strarg",
20820 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20821 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20822 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20823 (gdb)
20824 @end smallexample
20825
20826
20827 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
20828 @findex -exec-run
20829
20830 @subsubheading Synopsis
20831
20832 @smallexample
20833 -exec-run
20834 @end smallexample
20835
20836 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
20837 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
20838 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
20839 the program has exited exceptionally.
20840
20841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20842
20843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
20844
20845 @subsubheading Examples
20846
20847 @smallexample
20848 (gdb)
20849 -break-insert main
20850 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20851 (gdb)
20852 -exec-run
20853 ^running
20854 (gdb)
20855 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20856 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20857 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20858 (gdb)
20859 @end smallexample
20860
20861 @noindent
20862 Program exited normally:
20863
20864 @smallexample
20865 (gdb)
20866 -exec-run
20867 ^running
20868 (gdb)
20869 x = 55
20870 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20871 (gdb)
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 @noindent
20875 Program exited exceptionally:
20876
20877 @smallexample
20878 (gdb)
20879 -exec-run
20880 ^running
20881 (gdb)
20882 x = 55
20883 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
20884 (gdb)
20885 @end smallexample
20886
20887 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
20888 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
20889
20890 @smallexample
20891 (gdb)
20892 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
20893 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
20894 @end smallexample
20895
20896
20897 @c @subheading -exec-signal
20898
20899
20900 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
20901 @findex -exec-step
20902
20903 @subsubheading Synopsis
20904
20905 @smallexample
20906 -exec-step
20907 @end smallexample
20908
20909 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20910 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
20911 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
20912 function.
20913
20914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20915
20916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
20917
20918 @subsubheading Example
20919
20920 Stepping into a function:
20921
20922 @smallexample
20923 -exec-step
20924 ^running
20925 (gdb)
20926 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20927 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
20928 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
20929 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
20930 (gdb)
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 Regular stepping:
20934
20935 @smallexample
20936 -exec-step
20937 ^running
20938 (gdb)
20939 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
20940 (gdb)
20941 @end smallexample
20942
20943
20944 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
20945 @findex -exec-step-instruction
20946
20947 @subsubheading Synopsis
20948
20949 @smallexample
20950 -exec-step-instruction
20951 @end smallexample
20952
20953 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
20954 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
20955 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
20956 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
20957 well.
20958
20959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20960
20961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
20962
20963 @subsubheading Example
20964
20965 @smallexample
20966 (gdb)
20967 -exec-step-instruction
20968 ^running
20969
20970 (gdb)
20971 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20972 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20973 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20974 (gdb)
20975 -exec-step-instruction
20976 ^running
20977
20978 (gdb)
20979 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20980 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20981 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20982 (gdb)
20983 @end smallexample
20984
20985
20986 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
20987 @findex -exec-until
20988
20989 @subsubheading Synopsis
20990
20991 @smallexample
20992 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
20993 @end smallexample
20994
20995 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
20996 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
20997 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
20998 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
20999
21000 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21001
21002 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
21003
21004 @subsubheading Example
21005
21006 @smallexample
21007 (gdb)
21008 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
21009 ^running
21010 (gdb)
21011 x = 55
21012 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21013 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
21014 (gdb)
21015 @end smallexample
21016
21017 @ignore
21018 @subheading -file-clear
21019 Is this going away????
21020 @end ignore
21021
21022 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21023 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
21024 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
21025
21026
21027 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
21028 @findex -stack-info-frame
21029
21030 @subsubheading Synopsis
21031
21032 @smallexample
21033 -stack-info-frame
21034 @end smallexample
21035
21036 Get info on the selected frame.
21037
21038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21039
21040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
21041 (without arguments).
21042
21043 @subsubheading Example
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 (gdb)
21047 -stack-info-frame
21048 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21049 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21050 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
21051 (gdb)
21052 @end smallexample
21053
21054 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
21055 @findex -stack-info-depth
21056
21057 @subsubheading Synopsis
21058
21059 @smallexample
21060 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
21061 @end smallexample
21062
21063 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
21064 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
21065
21066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21067
21068 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21069
21070 @subsubheading Example
21071
21072 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
21073
21074 @smallexample
21075 (gdb)
21076 -stack-info-depth
21077 ^done,depth="12"
21078 (gdb)
21079 -stack-info-depth 4
21080 ^done,depth="4"
21081 (gdb)
21082 -stack-info-depth 12
21083 ^done,depth="12"
21084 (gdb)
21085 -stack-info-depth 11
21086 ^done,depth="11"
21087 (gdb)
21088 -stack-info-depth 13
21089 ^done,depth="12"
21090 (gdb)
21091 @end smallexample
21092
21093 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
21094 @findex -stack-list-arguments
21095
21096 @subsubheading Synopsis
21097
21098 @smallexample
21099 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
21100 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21101 @end smallexample
21102
21103 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
21104 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
21105 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
21106 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
21107 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
21108 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
21109 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
21110 which case only existing frames will be returned.
21111
21112 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
21113 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
21114 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
21115
21116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21117
21118 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
21119 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
21120 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
21121
21122 @subsubheading Example
21123
21124 @smallexample
21125 (gdb)
21126 -stack-list-frames
21127 ^done,
21128 stack=[
21129 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21130 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21131 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
21132 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21133 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21134 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
21135 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
21136 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21137 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
21138 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
21139 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21140 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
21141 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
21142 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21143 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
21144 (gdb)
21145 -stack-list-arguments 0
21146 ^done,
21147 stack-args=[
21148 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21149 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
21150 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
21151 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
21152 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21153 (gdb)
21154 -stack-list-arguments 1
21155 ^done,
21156 stack-args=[
21157 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21158 frame=@{level="1",
21159 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21160 frame=@{level="2",args=[
21161 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21162 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21163 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
21164 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21165 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
21166 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
21167 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21168 (gdb)
21169 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
21170 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
21171 (gdb)
21172 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
21173 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
21174 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21175 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
21176 (gdb)
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
21180
21181
21182 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
21183 @findex -stack-list-frames
21184
21185 @subsubheading Synopsis
21186
21187 @smallexample
21188 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21189 @end smallexample
21190
21191 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
21192 following info:
21193
21194 @table @samp
21195 @item @var{level}
21196 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
21197 @item @var{addr}
21198 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
21199 @item @var{func}
21200 Function name.
21201 @item @var{file}
21202 File name of the source file where the function lives.
21203 @item @var{line}
21204 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
21205 @end table
21206
21207 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
21208 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
21209 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
21210 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
21211 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
21212 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
21213 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
21214
21215 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21216
21217 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
21218
21219 @subsubheading Example
21220
21221 Full stack backtrace:
21222
21223 @smallexample
21224 (gdb)
21225 -stack-list-frames
21226 ^done,stack=
21227 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
21228 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
21229 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21230 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21231 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21232 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21233 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21234 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21235 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21236 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21237 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21238 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21239 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21240 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21241 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21242 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21243 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21244 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21245 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21246 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21247 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21248 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21249 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
21250 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
21251 (gdb)
21252 @end smallexample
21253
21254 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
21255
21256 @smallexample
21257 (gdb)
21258 -stack-list-frames 3 5
21259 ^done,stack=
21260 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21261 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21262 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21263 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21264 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21265 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21266 (gdb)
21267 @end smallexample
21268
21269 Show a single frame:
21270
21271 @smallexample
21272 (gdb)
21273 -stack-list-frames 3 3
21274 ^done,stack=
21275 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21276 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21277 (gdb)
21278 @end smallexample
21279
21280
21281 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
21282 @findex -stack-list-locals
21283
21284 @subsubheading Synopsis
21285
21286 @smallexample
21287 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
21288 @end smallexample
21289
21290 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
21291 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
21292 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
21293 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
21294 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
21295 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
21296 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
21297 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
21298 more detail.
21299
21300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21301
21302 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
21303
21304 @subsubheading Example
21305
21306 @smallexample
21307 (gdb)
21308 -stack-list-locals 0
21309 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
21310 (gdb)
21311 -stack-list-locals --all-values
21312 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
21313 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
21314 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
21315 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
21316 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
21317 (gdb)
21318 @end smallexample
21319
21320
21321 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
21322 @findex -stack-select-frame
21323
21324 @subsubheading Synopsis
21325
21326 @smallexample
21327 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
21328 @end smallexample
21329
21330 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
21331 the stack.
21332
21333 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
21334 option to every command.
21335
21336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21337
21338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
21339 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
21340
21341 @subsubheading Example
21342
21343 @smallexample
21344 (gdb)
21345 -stack-select-frame 2
21346 ^done
21347 (gdb)
21348 @end smallexample
21349
21350 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21351 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
21352 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
21353
21354 @ignore
21355
21356 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
21357
21358 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
21359 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
21360 used by @code{Insight}.
21361
21362 The two main reasons for that are:
21363
21364 @enumerate 1
21365 @item
21366 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
21367
21368 @item
21369 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
21370 now).
21371 @end enumerate
21372
21373 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
21374 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
21375 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
21376 hints about their use.
21377
21378 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
21379 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
21380 least, the following operations:
21381
21382 @itemize @bullet
21383 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
21384 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
21385 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
21386 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
21387 @end itemize
21388
21389 @end ignore
21390
21391 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
21392
21393 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
21394
21395 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
21396 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
21397 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
21398 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
21399 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
21400 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
21401 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
21402 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
21403 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
21404 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
21405 object, or to change display format.
21406
21407 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
21408 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
21409 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
21410 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
21411 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
21412 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
21413 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
21414 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
21415 child will be created.
21416
21417 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
21418 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
21419 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
21420 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
21421 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
21422
21423 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
21424 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
21425 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
21426 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
21427 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
21428 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
21429 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
21430 variables that frontend has created.
21431
21432 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
21433 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
21434 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
21435 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
21436 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
21437 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
21438 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
21439 implicitly updated.
21440
21441 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
21442 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
21443 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
21444 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
21445 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
21446 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
21447 frame. Consider this example:
21448
21449 @smallexample
21450 void do_work(...)
21451 @{
21452 struct work_state state;
21453
21454 if (...)
21455 do_work(...);
21456 @}
21457 @end smallexample
21458
21459 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
21460 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
21461 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
21462 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
21463 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
21464
21465 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
21466 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
21467 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
21468 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
21469 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
21470 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
21471
21472 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
21473 access this functionality:
21474
21475 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
21476 @item @strong{Operation}
21477 @tab @strong{Description}
21478
21479 @item @code{-var-create}
21480 @tab create a variable object
21481 @item @code{-var-delete}
21482 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
21483 @item @code{-var-set-format}
21484 @tab set the display format of this variable
21485 @item @code{-var-show-format}
21486 @tab show the display format of this variable
21487 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
21488 @tab tells how many children this object has
21489 @item @code{-var-list-children}
21490 @tab return a list of the object's children
21491 @item @code{-var-info-type}
21492 @tab show the type of this variable object
21493 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
21494 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
21495 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
21496 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
21497 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
21498 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
21499 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
21500 @tab get the value of this variable
21501 @item @code{-var-assign}
21502 @tab set the value of this variable
21503 @item @code{-var-update}
21504 @tab update the variable and its children
21505 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
21506 @tab set frozeness attribute
21507 @end multitable
21508
21509 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
21510 how it can be used.
21511
21512 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
21513
21514 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
21515 @findex -var-create
21516
21517 @subsubheading Synopsis
21518
21519 @smallexample
21520 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
21521 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
21522 @end smallexample
21523
21524 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
21525 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
21526 register.
21527
21528 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
21529 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
21530 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
21531 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
21532 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
21533
21534 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
21535 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
21536 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
21537 object must be created.
21538
21539 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
21540 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
21541
21542 @itemize @bullet
21543 @item
21544 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
21545
21546 @item
21547 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
21548
21549 @item
21550 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
21551 @end itemize
21552
21553 @subsubheading Result
21554
21555 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
21556 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
21557 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
21558 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
21559
21560 @smallexample
21561 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
21562 @end smallexample
21563
21564
21565 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
21566 @findex -var-delete
21567
21568 @subsubheading Synopsis
21569
21570 @smallexample
21571 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
21572 @end smallexample
21573
21574 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
21575 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
21576
21577 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
21578
21579
21580 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
21581 @findex -var-set-format
21582
21583 @subsubheading Synopsis
21584
21585 @smallexample
21586 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
21587 @end smallexample
21588
21589 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
21590 @var{format-spec}.
21591
21592 @anchor{-var-set-format}
21593 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
21594
21595 @smallexample
21596 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
21597 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
21598 @end smallexample
21599
21600 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
21601 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
21602 for pointers, etc.).
21603
21604 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
21605 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
21606
21607 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
21608 @findex -var-show-format
21609
21610 @subsubheading Synopsis
21611
21612 @smallexample
21613 -var-show-format @var{name}
21614 @end smallexample
21615
21616 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
21617
21618 @smallexample
21619 @var{format} @expansion{}
21620 @var{format-spec}
21621 @end smallexample
21622
21623
21624 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
21625 @findex -var-info-num-children
21626
21627 @subsubheading Synopsis
21628
21629 @smallexample
21630 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
21631 @end smallexample
21632
21633 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 numchild=@var{n}
21637 @end smallexample
21638
21639
21640 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
21641 @findex -var-list-children
21642
21643 @subsubheading Synopsis
21644
21645 @smallexample
21646 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
21647 @end smallexample
21648 @anchor{-var-list-children}
21649
21650 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
21651 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
21652 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
21653 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
21654 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
21655 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
21656 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
21657 and unions.
21658
21659 @subsubheading Example
21660
21661 @smallexample
21662 (gdb)
21663 -var-list-children n
21664 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
21665 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
21666 (gdb)
21667 -var-list-children --all-values n
21668 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
21669 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
21670 @end smallexample
21671
21672
21673 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
21674 @findex -var-info-type
21675
21676 @subsubheading Synopsis
21677
21678 @smallexample
21679 -var-info-type @var{name}
21680 @end smallexample
21681
21682 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
21683 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
21684 @value{GDBN} CLI:
21685
21686 @smallexample
21687 type=@var{typename}
21688 @end smallexample
21689
21690
21691 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
21692 @findex -var-info-expression
21693
21694 @subsubheading Synopsis
21695
21696 @smallexample
21697 -var-info-expression @var{name}
21698 @end smallexample
21699
21700 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
21701 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
21702 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
21703
21704 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
21705 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
21706
21707 @smallexample
21708 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
21709 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
21710 @end smallexample
21711
21712 @noindent
21713 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
21714
21715 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
21716 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
21717 is of limited use.
21718
21719 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
21720 @findex -var-info-path-expression
21721
21722 @subsubheading Synopsis
21723
21724 @smallexample
21725 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
21726 @end smallexample
21727
21728 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
21729 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
21730 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
21731 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
21732 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
21733 watchpoint from a variable object.
21734
21735 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
21736 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
21737 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
21738 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
21739 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
21740 @smallexample
21741 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
21742 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
21743 @end smallexample
21744
21745 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
21746 @findex -var-show-attributes
21747
21748 @subsubheading Synopsis
21749
21750 @smallexample
21751 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
21752 @end smallexample
21753
21754 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
21755
21756 @smallexample
21757 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
21758 @end smallexample
21759
21760 @noindent
21761 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
21762
21763 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
21764 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
21765
21766 @subsubheading Synopsis
21767
21768 @smallexample
21769 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
21770 @end smallexample
21771
21772 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
21773 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
21774 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
21775 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
21776 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
21777 the current display format will be used. The current display format
21778 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
21779
21780 @smallexample
21781 value=@var{value}
21782 @end smallexample
21783
21784 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
21785 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
21786
21787 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
21788 @findex -var-assign
21789
21790 @subsubheading Synopsis
21791
21792 @smallexample
21793 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
21794 @end smallexample
21795
21796 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
21797 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
21798 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
21799 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
21800
21801 @subsubheading Example
21802
21803 @smallexample
21804 (gdb)
21805 -var-assign var1 3
21806 ^done,value="3"
21807 (gdb)
21808 -var-update *
21809 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
21810 (gdb)
21811 @end smallexample
21812
21813 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
21814 @findex -var-update
21815
21816 @subsubheading Synopsis
21817
21818 @smallexample
21819 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
21820 @end smallexample
21821
21822 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
21823 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
21824 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
21825 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
21826 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
21827 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
21828 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
21829 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
21830 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
21831 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
21832 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
21833 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
21834 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
21835
21836 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
21837 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
21838 diagnostic.
21839
21840 @subsubheading Example
21841
21842 @smallexample
21843 (gdb)
21844 -var-assign var1 3
21845 ^done,value="3"
21846 (gdb)
21847 -var-update --all-values var1
21848 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
21849 type_changed="false"@}]
21850 (gdb)
21851 @end smallexample
21852
21853 @anchor{-var-update}
21854 The field in_scope may take three values:
21855
21856 @table @code
21857 @item "true"
21858 The variable object's current value is valid.
21859
21860 @item "false"
21861 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
21862 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
21863 scope.
21864
21865 @item "invalid"
21866 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
21867 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
21868 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
21869 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
21870 objects.
21871 @end table
21872
21873 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
21874 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
21875
21876 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
21877 @findex -var-set-frozen
21878 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
21879
21880 @subsubheading Synopsis
21881
21882 @smallexample
21883 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
21884 @end smallexample
21885
21886 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
21887 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
21888 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
21889 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
21890 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
21891 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
21892 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
21893 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
21894 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
21895 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
21896 @code{-var-update} does.
21897
21898 @subsubheading Example
21899
21900 @smallexample
21901 (gdb)
21902 -var-set-frozen V 1
21903 ^done
21904 (gdb)
21905 @end smallexample
21906
21907
21908 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21909 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
21910 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
21911
21912 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
21913 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
21914 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
21915 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
21916
21917 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
21918 @c @subheading -data-assign
21919 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
21920 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
21921 @c set variable
21922 @c @subsubheading Example
21923 @c N.A.
21924
21925 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
21926 @findex -data-disassemble
21927
21928 @subsubheading Synopsis
21929
21930 @smallexample
21931 -data-disassemble
21932 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
21933 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
21934 -- @var{mode}
21935 @end smallexample
21936
21937 @noindent
21938 Where:
21939
21940 @table @samp
21941 @item @var{start-addr}
21942 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
21943 @item @var{end-addr}
21944 is the end address
21945 @item @var{filename}
21946 is the name of the file to disassemble
21947 @item @var{linenum}
21948 is the line number to disassemble around
21949 @item @var{lines}
21950 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
21951 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
21952 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
21953 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
21954 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
21955 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
21956 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
21957 are displayed.
21958 @item @var{mode}
21959 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
21960 disassembly).
21961 @end table
21962
21963 @subsubheading Result
21964
21965 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
21966
21967 @itemize @bullet
21968 @item Address
21969 @item Func-name
21970 @item Offset
21971 @item Instruction
21972 @end itemize
21973
21974 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
21975 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
21976
21977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21978
21979 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
21980
21981 @subsubheading Example
21982
21983 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
21984
21985 @smallexample
21986 (gdb)
21987 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
21988 ^done,
21989 asm_insns=[
21990 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21991 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21992 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21993 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21994 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
21995 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
21996 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
21997 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21998 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
21999 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
22000 (gdb)
22001 @end smallexample
22002
22003 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
22004 @code{main}.
22005
22006 @smallexample
22007 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
22008 ^done,asm_insns=[
22009 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22010 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22011 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22012 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22013 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22014 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22015 [@dots{}]
22016 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
22017 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
22018 (gdb)
22019 @end smallexample
22020
22021 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
22022
22023 @smallexample
22024 (gdb)
22025 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
22026 ^done,asm_insns=[
22027 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22028 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22029 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22030 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22031 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22032 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
22033 (gdb)
22034 @end smallexample
22035
22036 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
22037
22038 @smallexample
22039 (gdb)
22040 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
22041 ^done,asm_insns=[
22042 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
22043 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22044 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22045 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22046 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
22047 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
22048 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22049 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22050 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22051 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22052 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22053 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
22054 (gdb)
22055 @end smallexample
22056
22057
22058 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
22059 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
22060
22061 @subsubheading Synopsis
22062
22063 @smallexample
22064 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
22065 @end smallexample
22066
22067 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
22068 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
22069 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
22070
22071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22072
22073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
22074 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
22075 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
22076
22077 @subsubheading Example
22078
22079 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
22080 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
22081 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
22082 output.
22083
22084 @smallexample
22085 211-data-evaluate-expression A
22086 211^done,value="1"
22087 (gdb)
22088 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
22089 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
22090 (gdb)
22091 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
22092 411^done,value="4"
22093 (gdb)
22094 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
22095 511^done,value="4"
22096 (gdb)
22097 @end smallexample
22098
22099
22100 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
22101 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
22102
22103 @subsubheading Synopsis
22104
22105 @smallexample
22106 -data-list-changed-registers
22107 @end smallexample
22108
22109 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
22110
22111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22112
22113 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
22114 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
22115
22116 @subsubheading Example
22117
22118 On a PPC MBX board:
22119
22120 @smallexample
22121 (gdb)
22122 -exec-continue
22123 ^running
22124
22125 (gdb)
22126 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
22127 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
22128 line="5"@}
22129 (gdb)
22130 -data-list-changed-registers
22131 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
22132 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
22133 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
22134 (gdb)
22135 @end smallexample
22136
22137
22138 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
22139 @findex -data-list-register-names
22140
22141 @subsubheading Synopsis
22142
22143 @smallexample
22144 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
22145 @end smallexample
22146
22147 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
22148 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
22149 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
22150 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
22151 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
22152 include empty register names.
22153
22154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22155
22156 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
22157 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
22158 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
22159
22160 @subsubheading Example
22161
22162 For the PPC MBX board:
22163 @smallexample
22164 (gdb)
22165 -data-list-register-names
22166 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
22167 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
22168 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
22169 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
22170 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
22171 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
22172 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
22173 (gdb)
22174 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
22175 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
22176 (gdb)
22177 @end smallexample
22178
22179 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
22180 @findex -data-list-register-values
22181
22182 @subsubheading Synopsis
22183
22184 @smallexample
22185 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
22186 @end smallexample
22187
22188 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
22189 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
22190 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
22191 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
22192
22193 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
22194
22195 @table @code
22196 @item x
22197 Hexadecimal
22198 @item o
22199 Octal
22200 @item t
22201 Binary
22202 @item d
22203 Decimal
22204 @item r
22205 Raw
22206 @item N
22207 Natural
22208 @end table
22209
22210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22211
22212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
22213 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
22214
22215 @subsubheading Example
22216
22217 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
22218 don't appear in the actual output):
22219
22220 @smallexample
22221 (gdb)
22222 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
22223 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22224 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
22225 (gdb)
22226 -data-list-register-values x
22227 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
22228 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22229 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
22230 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
22231 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
22232 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
22233 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
22234 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
22235 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
22236 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22237 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
22238 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
22239 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
22240 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
22241 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
22242 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
22243 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
22244 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
22245 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
22246 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
22247 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
22248 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
22249 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
22250 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
22251 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
22252 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
22253 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
22254 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
22255 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
22256 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
22257 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
22258 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
22259 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22260 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
22261 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
22262 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
22263 (gdb)
22264 @end smallexample
22265
22266
22267 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
22268 @findex -data-read-memory
22269
22270 @subsubheading Synopsis
22271
22272 @smallexample
22273 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
22274 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
22275 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
22276 @end smallexample
22277
22278 @noindent
22279 where:
22280
22281 @table @samp
22282 @item @var{address}
22283 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
22284 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
22285 quoted using the C convention.
22286
22287 @item @var{word-format}
22288 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
22289 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
22290 ,Output Formats}).
22291
22292 @item @var{word-size}
22293 The size of each memory word in bytes.
22294
22295 @item @var{nr-rows}
22296 The number of rows in the output table.
22297
22298 @item @var{nr-cols}
22299 The number of columns in the output table.
22300
22301 @item @var{aschar}
22302 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
22303 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
22304 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
22305 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
22306
22307 @item @var{byte-offset}
22308 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
22309 @end table
22310
22311 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
22312 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
22313 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
22314 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
22315 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
22316 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
22317 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
22318 @samp{addr}.
22319
22320 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
22321 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
22322 @samp{prev-page}.
22323
22324 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22325
22326 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
22327 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
22328
22329 @subsubheading Example
22330
22331 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
22332 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
22333 word. Display each word in hex.
22334
22335 @smallexample
22336 (gdb)
22337 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
22338 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
22339 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
22340 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
22341 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
22342 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
22343 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
22344 (gdb)
22345 @end smallexample
22346
22347 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
22348 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
22349
22350 @smallexample
22351 (gdb)
22352 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
22353 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
22354 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
22355 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
22356 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
22357 (gdb)
22358 @end smallexample
22359
22360 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
22361 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
22362 used as the non-printable character.
22363
22364 @smallexample
22365 (gdb)
22366 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
22367 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
22368 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
22369 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
22370 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22371 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22372 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22373 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22374 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
22375 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
22376 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
22377 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
22378 (gdb)
22379 @end smallexample
22380
22381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22382 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
22383 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
22384
22385 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
22386
22387 @c @subheading -trace-actions
22388
22389 @c @subheading -trace-delete
22390
22391 @c @subheading -trace-disable
22392
22393 @c @subheading -trace-dump
22394
22395 @c @subheading -trace-enable
22396
22397 @c @subheading -trace-exists
22398
22399 @c @subheading -trace-find
22400
22401 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
22402
22403 @c @subheading -trace-info
22404
22405 @c @subheading -trace-insert
22406
22407 @c @subheading -trace-list
22408
22409 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
22410
22411 @c @subheading -trace-save
22412
22413 @c @subheading -trace-start
22414
22415 @c @subheading -trace-stop
22416
22417
22418 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22419 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
22420 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
22421
22422
22423 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
22424 @findex -symbol-info-address
22425
22426 @subsubheading Synopsis
22427
22428 @smallexample
22429 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
22430 @end smallexample
22431
22432 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
22433
22434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22435
22436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
22437
22438 @subsubheading Example
22439 N.A.
22440
22441
22442 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
22443 @findex -symbol-info-file
22444
22445 @subsubheading Synopsis
22446
22447 @smallexample
22448 -symbol-info-file
22449 @end smallexample
22450
22451 Show the file for the symbol.
22452
22453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22454
22455 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
22456 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
22457
22458 @subsubheading Example
22459 N.A.
22460
22461
22462 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
22463 @findex -symbol-info-function
22464
22465 @subsubheading Synopsis
22466
22467 @smallexample
22468 -symbol-info-function
22469 @end smallexample
22470
22471 Show which function the symbol lives in.
22472
22473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22474
22475 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
22476
22477 @subsubheading Example
22478 N.A.
22479
22480
22481 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
22482 @findex -symbol-info-line
22483
22484 @subsubheading Synopsis
22485
22486 @smallexample
22487 -symbol-info-line
22488 @end smallexample
22489
22490 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
22491
22492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22493
22494 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
22495 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
22496
22497 @subsubheading Example
22498 N.A.
22499
22500
22501 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
22502 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
22503
22504 @subsubheading Synopsis
22505
22506 @smallexample
22507 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
22508 @end smallexample
22509
22510 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
22511
22512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22513
22514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
22515
22516 @subsubheading Example
22517 N.A.
22518
22519
22520 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
22521 @findex -symbol-list-functions
22522
22523 @subsubheading Synopsis
22524
22525 @smallexample
22526 -symbol-list-functions
22527 @end smallexample
22528
22529 List the functions in the executable.
22530
22531 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22532
22533 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
22534 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22535
22536 @subsubheading Example
22537 N.A.
22538
22539
22540 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
22541 @findex -symbol-list-lines
22542
22543 @subsubheading Synopsis
22544
22545 @smallexample
22546 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
22547 @end smallexample
22548
22549 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
22550 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
22551 ascending PC order.
22552
22553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22554
22555 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
22556
22557 @subsubheading Example
22558 @smallexample
22559 (gdb)
22560 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
22561 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
22562 (gdb)
22563 @end smallexample
22564
22565
22566 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
22567 @findex -symbol-list-types
22568
22569 @subsubheading Synopsis
22570
22571 @smallexample
22572 -symbol-list-types
22573 @end smallexample
22574
22575 List all the type names.
22576
22577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22578
22579 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
22580 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22581
22582 @subsubheading Example
22583 N.A.
22584
22585
22586 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
22587 @findex -symbol-list-variables
22588
22589 @subsubheading Synopsis
22590
22591 @smallexample
22592 -symbol-list-variables
22593 @end smallexample
22594
22595 List all the global and static variable names.
22596
22597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22598
22599 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22600
22601 @subsubheading Example
22602 N.A.
22603
22604
22605 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
22606 @findex -symbol-locate
22607
22608 @subsubheading Synopsis
22609
22610 @smallexample
22611 -symbol-locate
22612 @end smallexample
22613
22614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22615
22616 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
22617
22618 @subsubheading Example
22619 N.A.
22620
22621
22622 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
22623 @findex -symbol-type
22624
22625 @subsubheading Synopsis
22626
22627 @smallexample
22628 -symbol-type @var{variable}
22629 @end smallexample
22630
22631 Show type of @var{variable}.
22632
22633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22634
22635 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
22636 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
22637
22638 @subsubheading Example
22639 N.A.
22640
22641
22642 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22643 @node GDB/MI File Commands
22644 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
22645
22646 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
22647 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
22648
22649 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
22650 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
22651
22652 @subsubheading Synopsis
22653
22654 @smallexample
22655 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
22656 @end smallexample
22657
22658 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
22659 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
22660 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
22661 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
22662 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
22663 notification.
22664
22665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22666
22667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
22668
22669 @subsubheading Example
22670
22671 @smallexample
22672 (gdb)
22673 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22674 ^done
22675 (gdb)
22676 @end smallexample
22677
22678
22679 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
22680 @findex -file-exec-file
22681
22682 @subsubheading Synopsis
22683
22684 @smallexample
22685 -file-exec-file @var{file}
22686 @end smallexample
22687
22688 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
22689 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
22690 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
22691 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
22692 notification.
22693
22694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22695
22696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
22697
22698 @subsubheading Example
22699
22700 @smallexample
22701 (gdb)
22702 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22703 ^done
22704 (gdb)
22705 @end smallexample
22706
22707
22708 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
22709 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
22710
22711 @subsubheading Synopsis
22712
22713 @smallexample
22714 -file-list-exec-sections
22715 @end smallexample
22716
22717 List the sections of the current executable file.
22718
22719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22720
22721 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
22722 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
22723 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
22724
22725 @subsubheading Example
22726 N.A.
22727
22728
22729 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
22730 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
22731
22732 @subsubheading Synopsis
22733
22734 @smallexample
22735 -file-list-exec-source-file
22736 @end smallexample
22737
22738 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
22739 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
22740 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
22741 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
22742
22743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22744
22745 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
22746
22747 @subsubheading Example
22748
22749 @smallexample
22750 (gdb)
22751 123-file-list-exec-source-file
22752 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
22753 (gdb)
22754 @end smallexample
22755
22756
22757 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
22758 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
22759
22760 @subsubheading Synopsis
22761
22762 @smallexample
22763 -file-list-exec-source-files
22764 @end smallexample
22765
22766 List the source files for the current executable.
22767
22768 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
22769 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
22770
22771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22772
22773 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
22774 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
22775
22776 @subsubheading Example
22777 @smallexample
22778 (gdb)
22779 -file-list-exec-source-files
22780 ^done,files=[
22781 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
22782 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
22783 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
22784 (gdb)
22785 @end smallexample
22786
22787 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
22788 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
22789
22790 @subsubheading Synopsis
22791
22792 @smallexample
22793 -file-list-shared-libraries
22794 @end smallexample
22795
22796 List the shared libraries in the program.
22797
22798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22799
22800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
22801
22802 @subsubheading Example
22803 N.A.
22804
22805
22806 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
22807 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
22808
22809 @subsubheading Synopsis
22810
22811 @smallexample
22812 -file-list-symbol-files
22813 @end smallexample
22814
22815 List symbol files.
22816
22817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22818
22819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
22820
22821 @subsubheading Example
22822 N.A.
22823
22824
22825 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
22826 @findex -file-symbol-file
22827
22828 @subsubheading Synopsis
22829
22830 @smallexample
22831 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
22832 @end smallexample
22833
22834 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
22835 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
22836 produced, except for a completion notification.
22837
22838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22839
22840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
22841
22842 @subsubheading Example
22843
22844 @smallexample
22845 (gdb)
22846 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22847 ^done
22848 (gdb)
22849 @end smallexample
22850
22851 @ignore
22852 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22853 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
22854 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
22855
22856 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
22857
22858 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
22859
22860 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
22861
22862 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
22863
22864 @c @subheading -overlay-map
22865
22866 @c @subheading -overlay-off
22867
22868 @c @subheading -overlay-on
22869
22870 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
22871
22872 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22873 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
22874 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
22875
22876 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
22877
22878 @c @subheading -signal-handle
22879
22880 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
22881
22882 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
22883 @end ignore
22884
22885
22886 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22887 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
22888 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
22889
22890
22891 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
22892 @findex -target-attach
22893
22894 @subsubheading Synopsis
22895
22896 @smallexample
22897 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
22898 @end smallexample
22899
22900 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
22901 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
22902 group, the id previously returned by
22903 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
22904
22905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22906
22907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
22908
22909 @subsubheading Example
22910 @smallexample
22911 (gdb)
22912 -target-attach 34
22913 =thread-created,id="1"
22914 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
22915 ^done
22916 (gdb)
22917 @end smallexample
22918
22919 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
22920 @findex -target-compare-sections
22921
22922 @subsubheading Synopsis
22923
22924 @smallexample
22925 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
22926 @end smallexample
22927
22928 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
22929 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
22930
22931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22932
22933 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
22934
22935 @subsubheading Example
22936 N.A.
22937
22938
22939 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
22940 @findex -target-detach
22941
22942 @subsubheading Synopsis
22943
22944 @smallexample
22945 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
22946 @end smallexample
22947
22948 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
22949 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
22950 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
22951
22952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22953
22954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
22955
22956 @subsubheading Example
22957
22958 @smallexample
22959 (gdb)
22960 -target-detach
22961 ^done
22962 (gdb)
22963 @end smallexample
22964
22965
22966 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
22967 @findex -target-disconnect
22968
22969 @subsubheading Synopsis
22970
22971 @smallexample
22972 -target-disconnect
22973 @end smallexample
22974
22975 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
22976 generally not resumed.
22977
22978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22979
22980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
22981
22982 @subsubheading Example
22983
22984 @smallexample
22985 (gdb)
22986 -target-disconnect
22987 ^done
22988 (gdb)
22989 @end smallexample
22990
22991
22992 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
22993 @findex -target-download
22994
22995 @subsubheading Synopsis
22996
22997 @smallexample
22998 -target-download
22999 @end smallexample
23000
23001 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
23002 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
23003
23004 @table @samp
23005 @item section
23006 The name of the section.
23007 @item section-sent
23008 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
23009 @item section-size
23010 The size of the section.
23011 @item total-sent
23012 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
23013 @item total-size
23014 The size of the overall executable to download.
23015 @end table
23016
23017 @noindent
23018 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
23019 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
23020
23021 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
23022 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
23023
23024 @table @samp
23025 @item section
23026 The name of the section.
23027 @item section-size
23028 The size of the section.
23029 @item total-size
23030 The size of the overall executable to download.
23031 @end table
23032
23033 @noindent
23034 At the end, a summary is printed.
23035
23036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23037
23038 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
23039
23040 @subsubheading Example
23041
23042 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
23043 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
23044
23045 @smallexample
23046 (gdb)
23047 -target-download
23048 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
23049 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
23050 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
23051 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
23052 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
23053 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
23054 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
23055 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
23056 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
23057 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
23058 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
23059 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
23060 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
23061 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
23062 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
23063 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
23064 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
23065 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
23066 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
23067 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
23068 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
23069 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
23070 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
23071 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
23072 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
23073 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
23074 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
23075 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23076 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23077 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
23078 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
23079 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
23080 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
23081 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
23082 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
23083 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
23084 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
23085 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
23086 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
23087 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
23088 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
23089 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
23090 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
23091 write-rate="429"
23092 (gdb)
23093 @end smallexample
23094
23095
23096 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
23097 @findex -target-exec-status
23098
23099 @subsubheading Synopsis
23100
23101 @smallexample
23102 -target-exec-status
23103 @end smallexample
23104
23105 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
23106 not, for instance).
23107
23108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23109
23110 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23111
23112 @subsubheading Example
23113 N.A.
23114
23115
23116 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
23117 @findex -target-list-available-targets
23118
23119 @subsubheading Synopsis
23120
23121 @smallexample
23122 -target-list-available-targets
23123 @end smallexample
23124
23125 List the possible targets to connect to.
23126
23127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23128
23129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
23130
23131 @subsubheading Example
23132 N.A.
23133
23134
23135 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
23136 @findex -target-list-current-targets
23137
23138 @subsubheading Synopsis
23139
23140 @smallexample
23141 -target-list-current-targets
23142 @end smallexample
23143
23144 Describe the current target.
23145
23146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23147
23148 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
23149 other things).
23150
23151 @subsubheading Example
23152 N.A.
23153
23154
23155 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
23156 @findex -target-list-parameters
23157
23158 @subsubheading Synopsis
23159
23160 @smallexample
23161 -target-list-parameters
23162 @end smallexample
23163
23164 @c ????
23165
23166 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23167
23168 No equivalent.
23169
23170 @subsubheading Example
23171 N.A.
23172
23173
23174 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
23175 @findex -target-select
23176
23177 @subsubheading Synopsis
23178
23179 @smallexample
23180 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
23181 @end smallexample
23182
23183 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
23184
23185 @table @samp
23186 @item @var{type}
23187 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
23188 @item @var{parameters}
23189 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
23190 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
23191 @end table
23192
23193 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
23194 which the target program is, in the following form:
23195
23196 @smallexample
23197 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
23198 args=[@var{arg list}]
23199 @end smallexample
23200
23201 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23202
23203 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
23204
23205 @subsubheading Example
23206
23207 @smallexample
23208 (gdb)
23209 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
23210 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
23211 (gdb)
23212 @end smallexample
23213
23214 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23215 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
23216 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
23217
23218
23219 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
23220 @findex -target-file-put
23221
23222 @subsubheading Synopsis
23223
23224 @smallexample
23225 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
23226 @end smallexample
23227
23228 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
23229 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
23230
23231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23232
23233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
23234
23235 @subsubheading Example
23236
23237 @smallexample
23238 (gdb)
23239 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
23240 ^done
23241 (gdb)
23242 @end smallexample
23243
23244
23245 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
23246 @findex -target-file-get
23247
23248 @subsubheading Synopsis
23249
23250 @smallexample
23251 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
23252 @end smallexample
23253
23254 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
23255 on the host system.
23256
23257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23258
23259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
23260
23261 @subsubheading Example
23262
23263 @smallexample
23264 (gdb)
23265 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
23266 ^done
23267 (gdb)
23268 @end smallexample
23269
23270
23271 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
23272 @findex -target-file-delete
23273
23274 @subsubheading Synopsis
23275
23276 @smallexample
23277 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
23278 @end smallexample
23279
23280 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
23281
23282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23283
23284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
23285
23286 @subsubheading Example
23287
23288 @smallexample
23289 (gdb)
23290 -target-file-delete remotefile
23291 ^done
23292 (gdb)
23293 @end smallexample
23294
23295
23296 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23297 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
23298 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
23299
23300 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
23301
23302 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
23303 @findex -gdb-exit
23304
23305 @subsubheading Synopsis
23306
23307 @smallexample
23308 -gdb-exit
23309 @end smallexample
23310
23311 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
23312
23313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23314
23315 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
23316
23317 @subsubheading Example
23318
23319 @smallexample
23320 (gdb)
23321 -gdb-exit
23322 ^exit
23323 @end smallexample
23324
23325
23326 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
23327 @findex -exec-abort
23328
23329 @subsubheading Synopsis
23330
23331 @smallexample
23332 -exec-abort
23333 @end smallexample
23334
23335 Kill the inferior running program.
23336
23337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23338
23339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
23340
23341 @subsubheading Example
23342 N.A.
23343
23344
23345 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
23346 @findex -gdb-set
23347
23348 @subsubheading Synopsis
23349
23350 @smallexample
23351 -gdb-set
23352 @end smallexample
23353
23354 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
23355 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
23356
23357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23358
23359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
23360
23361 @subsubheading Example
23362
23363 @smallexample
23364 (gdb)
23365 -gdb-set $foo=3
23366 ^done
23367 (gdb)
23368 @end smallexample
23369
23370
23371 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
23372 @findex -gdb-show
23373
23374 @subsubheading Synopsis
23375
23376 @smallexample
23377 -gdb-show
23378 @end smallexample
23379
23380 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
23381
23382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23383
23384 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
23385
23386 @subsubheading Example
23387
23388 @smallexample
23389 (gdb)
23390 -gdb-show annotate
23391 ^done,value="0"
23392 (gdb)
23393 @end smallexample
23394
23395 @c @subheading -gdb-source
23396
23397
23398 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
23399 @findex -gdb-version
23400
23401 @subsubheading Synopsis
23402
23403 @smallexample
23404 -gdb-version
23405 @end smallexample
23406
23407 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
23408
23409 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23410
23411 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
23412 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
23413
23414 @subsubheading Example
23415
23416 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
23417 @c box in TeX.
23418 @smallexample
23419 (gdb)
23420 -gdb-version
23421 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
23422 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23423 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
23424 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
23425 ~ certain conditions.
23426 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
23427 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
23428 ~ details.
23429 ~This GDB was configured as
23430 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
23431 ^done
23432 (gdb)
23433 @end smallexample
23434
23435 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
23436 @findex -list-features
23437
23438 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
23439 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
23440 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
23441 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
23442 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
23443 startup.
23444
23445 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
23446 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
23447 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
23448 is given below.
23449
23450 Example output:
23451
23452 @smallexample
23453 (gdb) -list-features
23454 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
23455 @end smallexample
23456
23457 The current list of features is:
23458
23459 @table @samp
23460 @item frozen-varobjs
23461 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
23462 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
23463 of @code{-varobj-create}.
23464 @item pending-breakpoints
23465 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
23466 @item thread-info
23467 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
23468
23469 @end table
23470
23471 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
23472 @findex -list-target-features
23473
23474 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
23475 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
23476 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
23477 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
23478 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
23479 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
23480 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
23481 Example output:
23482
23483 @smallexample
23484 (gdb) -list-features
23485 ^done,result=["async"]
23486 @end smallexample
23487
23488 The current list of features is:
23489
23490 @table @samp
23491 @item async
23492 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
23493 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
23494 while the target is running.
23495
23496 @end table
23497
23498 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
23499 @findex -list-thread-groups
23500
23501 @subheading Synopsis
23502
23503 @smallexample
23504 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
23505 @end smallexample
23506
23507 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
23508 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
23509 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
23510 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
23511 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
23512 the same time, but it may change in future.
23513
23514 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
23515 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
23516 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
23517 is not allowed.
23518
23519 @subheading Example
23520
23521 @smallexample
23522 @value{GDBP}
23523 -list-thread-groups
23524 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
23525 -list-thread-groups 17
23526 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
23527 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
23528 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
23529 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
23530 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
23531 @end smallexample
23532
23533 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
23534 @findex -interpreter-exec
23535
23536 @subheading Synopsis
23537
23538 @smallexample
23539 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
23540 @end smallexample
23541 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
23542
23543 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
23544
23545 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23546
23547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
23548
23549 @subheading Example
23550
23551 @smallexample
23552 (gdb)
23553 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
23554 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
23555 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
23556 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
23557 ^done
23558 (gdb)
23559 @end smallexample
23560
23561 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
23562 @findex -inferior-tty-set
23563
23564 @subheading Synopsis
23565
23566 @smallexample
23567 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
23568 @end smallexample
23569
23570 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
23571
23572 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23573
23574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
23575
23576 @subheading Example
23577
23578 @smallexample
23579 (gdb)
23580 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
23581 ^done
23582 (gdb)
23583 @end smallexample
23584
23585 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
23586 @findex -inferior-tty-show
23587
23588 @subheading Synopsis
23589
23590 @smallexample
23591 -inferior-tty-show
23592 @end smallexample
23593
23594 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
23595
23596 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23597
23598 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
23599
23600 @subheading Example
23601
23602 @smallexample
23603 (gdb)
23604 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
23605 ^done
23606 (gdb)
23607 -inferior-tty-show
23608 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
23609 (gdb)
23610 @end smallexample
23611
23612 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
23613 @findex -enable-timings
23614
23615 @subheading Synopsis
23616
23617 @smallexample
23618 -enable-timings [yes | no]
23619 @end smallexample
23620
23621 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
23622 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
23623 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
23624 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
23625
23626 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23627
23628 No equivalent.
23629
23630 @subheading Example
23631
23632 @smallexample
23633 (gdb)
23634 -enable-timings
23635 ^done
23636 (gdb)
23637 -break-insert main
23638 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23639 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
23640 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
23641 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
23642 (gdb)
23643 -enable-timings no
23644 ^done
23645 (gdb)
23646 -exec-run
23647 ^running
23648 (gdb)
23649 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
23650 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
23651 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
23652 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
23653 (gdb)
23654 @end smallexample
23655
23656 @node Annotations
23657 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
23658
23659 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
23660 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
23661 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
23662 relatively high level.
23663
23664 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
23665 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
23666
23667 @ignore
23668 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
23669 @end ignore
23670
23671 @menu
23672 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
23673 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
23674 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
23675 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
23676 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
23677 * Annotations for Running::
23678 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
23679 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
23680 @end menu
23681
23682 @node Annotations Overview
23683 @section What is an Annotation?
23684 @cindex annotations
23685
23686 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
23687 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
23688 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
23689 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
23690 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
23691 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
23692 cannot contain newline characters.
23693
23694 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
23695 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
23696 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
23697 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
23698 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
23699 means those three characters as output.
23700
23701 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
23702 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
23703 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
23704 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
23705 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
23706 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
23707 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
23708 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
23709 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
23710
23711 @table @code
23712 @kindex set annotate
23713 @item set annotate @var{level}
23714 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
23715 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
23716
23717 @item show annotate
23718 @kindex show annotate
23719 Show the current annotation level.
23720 @end table
23721
23722 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
23723
23724 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
23725
23726 @smallexample
23727 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
23728 GNU gdb 6.0
23729 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23730 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
23731 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
23732 under certain conditions.
23733 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
23734 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
23735 for details.
23736 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
23737
23738 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
23739 (@value{GDBP})
23740 ^Z^Zprompt
23741 @kbd{quit}
23742
23743 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
23744 $
23745 @end smallexample
23746
23747 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
23748 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
23749 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
23750 output from @value{GDBN}.
23751
23752 @node Server Prefix
23753 @section The Server Prefix
23754 @cindex server prefix
23755
23756 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
23757 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
23758 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
23759 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
23760 a transparent manner.
23761
23762 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23763 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23764 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23765
23766 @node Prompting
23767 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
23768
23769 @cindex annotations for prompts
23770 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
23771 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
23772 over, etc.
23773
23774 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
23775 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
23776 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
23777 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
23778 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
23779 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
23780 features the following annotations:
23781
23782 @smallexample
23783 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
23784 ^Z^Zprompt
23785 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
23786 @end smallexample
23787
23788 The input types are
23789
23790 @table @code
23791 @findex pre-prompt annotation
23792 @findex prompt annotation
23793 @findex post-prompt annotation
23794 @item prompt
23795 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
23796
23797 @findex pre-commands annotation
23798 @findex commands annotation
23799 @findex post-commands annotation
23800 @item commands
23801 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
23802 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
23803
23804 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
23805 @findex overload-choice annotation
23806 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
23807 @item overload-choice
23808 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
23809
23810 @findex pre-query annotation
23811 @findex query annotation
23812 @findex post-query annotation
23813 @item query
23814 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
23815
23816 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
23817 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
23818 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
23819 @item prompt-for-continue
23820 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
23821 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
23822 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
23823 presence of annotations.
23824 @end table
23825
23826 @node Errors
23827 @section Errors
23828 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
23829
23830 @findex quit annotation
23831 @smallexample
23832 ^Z^Zquit
23833 @end smallexample
23834
23835 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
23836
23837 @findex error annotation
23838 @smallexample
23839 ^Z^Zerror
23840 @end smallexample
23841
23842 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
23843
23844 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
23845 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
23846 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
23847 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
23848 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
23849 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
23850 to the top level.
23851
23852 @findex error-begin annotation
23853 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
23854
23855 @smallexample
23856 ^Z^Zerror-begin
23857 @end smallexample
23858
23859 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
23860 message.
23861
23862 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
23863 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
23864 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
23865
23866 @node Invalidation
23867 @section Invalidation Notices
23868
23869 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
23870 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
23871 changed.
23872
23873 @table @code
23874 @findex frames-invalid annotation
23875 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
23876
23877 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
23878 have changed.
23879
23880 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
23881 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
23882
23883 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
23884 deleted a breakpoint.
23885 @end table
23886
23887 @node Annotations for Running
23888 @section Running the Program
23889 @cindex annotations for running programs
23890
23891 @findex starting annotation
23892 @findex stopping annotation
23893 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
23894 @code{step} or @code{continue},
23895
23896 @smallexample
23897 ^Z^Zstarting
23898 @end smallexample
23899
23900 is output. When the program stops,
23901
23902 @smallexample
23903 ^Z^Zstopped
23904 @end smallexample
23905
23906 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
23907 annotations describe how the program stopped.
23908
23909 @table @code
23910 @findex exited annotation
23911 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
23912 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
23913 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
23914
23915 @findex signalled annotation
23916 @findex signal-name annotation
23917 @findex signal-name-end annotation
23918 @findex signal-string annotation
23919 @findex signal-string-end annotation
23920 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
23921 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
23922 annotation continues:
23923
23924 @smallexample
23925 @var{intro-text}
23926 ^Z^Zsignal-name
23927 @var{name}
23928 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
23929 @var{middle-text}
23930 ^Z^Zsignal-string
23931 @var{string}
23932 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
23933 @var{end-text}
23934 @end smallexample
23935
23936 @noindent
23937 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
23938 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
23939 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
23940 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
23941 user's benefit and have no particular format.
23942
23943 @findex signal annotation
23944 @item ^Z^Zsignal
23945 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
23946 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
23947 terminated with it.
23948
23949 @findex breakpoint annotation
23950 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
23951 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
23952
23953 @findex watchpoint annotation
23954 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
23955 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
23956 @end table
23957
23958 @node Source Annotations
23959 @section Displaying Source
23960 @cindex annotations for source display
23961
23962 @findex source annotation
23963 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
23964
23965 @smallexample
23966 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
23967 @end smallexample
23968
23969 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
23970 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
23971 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
23972 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
23973 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
23974 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
23975 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
23976 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
23977 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
23978 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
23979 depend on the language).
23980
23981 @node GDB Bugs
23982 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
23983 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
23984 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
23985
23986 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
23987
23988 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
23989 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
23990 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
23991 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
23992
23993 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
23994 information that enables us to fix the bug.
23995
23996 @menu
23997 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
23998 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
23999 @end menu
24000
24001 @node Bug Criteria
24002 @section Have You Found a Bug?
24003 @cindex bug criteria
24004
24005 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
24006
24007 @itemize @bullet
24008 @cindex fatal signal
24009 @cindex debugger crash
24010 @cindex crash of debugger
24011 @item
24012 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
24013 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
24014
24015 @cindex error on valid input
24016 @item
24017 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
24018 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
24019 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
24020
24021 @cindex invalid input
24022 @item
24023 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
24024 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
24025 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
24026 for traditional practice''.
24027
24028 @item
24029 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
24030 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
24031 @end itemize
24032
24033 @node Bug Reporting
24034 @section How to Report Bugs
24035 @cindex bug reports
24036 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
24037
24038 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
24039 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
24040 contact that organization first.
24041
24042 You can find contact information for many support companies and
24043 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
24044 distribution.
24045 @c should add a web page ref...
24046
24047 @ifset BUGURL
24048 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
24049 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24050 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
24051 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
24052 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
24053 be used.
24054
24055 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
24056 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
24057 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
24058 @samp{bug-gdb}.
24059
24060 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
24061 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
24062 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
24063 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
24064 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
24065 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
24066 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
24067 bug reports to the mailing list.
24068 @end ifset
24069 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
24070 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24071 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
24072 @end ifclear
24073 @end ifset
24074
24075 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
24076 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
24077 fact or leave it out, state it!
24078
24079 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
24080 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
24081 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
24082 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
24083 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
24084 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
24085 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
24086 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
24087 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
24088
24089 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
24090 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
24091 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
24092 self-contained.
24093
24094 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
24095 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
24096 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
24097 bugs properly.
24098
24099 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
24100
24101 @itemize @bullet
24102 @item
24103 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
24104 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
24105 version}.
24106
24107 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
24108 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
24109
24110 @item
24111 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
24112 version number.
24113
24114 @item
24115 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
24116 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
24117
24118 @item
24119 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
24120 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
24121 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
24122 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
24123 those compilers.
24124
24125 @item
24126 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
24127 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
24128 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
24129 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
24130
24131 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
24132 and then we might not encounter the bug.
24133
24134 @item
24135 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
24136 reproduce the bug.
24137
24138 @item
24139 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
24140 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
24141
24142 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
24143 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
24144 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
24145 a chance to make a mistake.
24146
24147 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
24148 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
24149 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
24150 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
24151 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
24152 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
24153 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
24154 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
24155
24156 @pindex script
24157 @cindex recording a session script
24158 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
24159 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
24160 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
24161 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
24162
24163 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
24164 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
24165
24166 @item
24167 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
24168 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
24169 it by context, not by line number.
24170
24171 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
24172 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
24173
24174 @end itemize
24175
24176 Here are some things that are not necessary:
24177
24178 @itemize @bullet
24179 @item
24180 A description of the envelope of the bug.
24181
24182 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
24183 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
24184 changes will not affect it.
24185
24186 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
24187 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
24188 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
24189 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
24190
24191 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
24192 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
24193 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
24194 less time, and so on.
24195
24196 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
24197 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
24198
24199 @item
24200 A patch for the bug.
24201
24202 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
24203 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
24204 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
24205 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
24206
24207 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
24208 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
24209 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
24210 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
24211
24212 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
24213 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
24214 help us to understand.
24215
24216 @item
24217 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
24218
24219 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
24220 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
24221 @end itemize
24222
24223 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
24224 @c and consists of the two following files:
24225 @c rluser.texinfo
24226 @c inc-hist.texinfo
24227 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
24228 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
24229 @include rluser.texi
24230 @include inc-hist.texinfo
24231
24232
24233 @node Formatting Documentation
24234 @appendix Formatting Documentation
24235
24236 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
24237 @cindex reference card
24238 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
24239 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
24240 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
24241 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
24242 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
24243 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
24244
24245 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
24246 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
24247
24248 @smallexample
24249 make refcard.dvi
24250 @end smallexample
24251
24252 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
24253 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
24254 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
24255 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
24256 your @sc{dvi} output program.
24257
24258 @cindex documentation
24259
24260 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
24261 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
24262 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
24263 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
24264 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
24265 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
24266
24267 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
24268 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
24269 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
24270 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
24271 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
24272 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
24273 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
24274 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
24275
24276 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
24277 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
24278 @code{makeinfo}.
24279
24280 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
24281 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
24282 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
24283
24284 @smallexample
24285 cd gdb
24286 make gdb.info
24287 @end smallexample
24288
24289 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
24290 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
24291 Texinfo definitions file.
24292
24293 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
24294 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
24295 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
24296 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
24297 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
24298 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
24299 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
24300
24301 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
24302 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
24303 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
24304 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
24305 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
24306 directory.
24307
24308 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
24309 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
24310 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
24311 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
24312
24313 @smallexample
24314 make gdb.dvi
24315 @end smallexample
24316
24317 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
24318
24319 @node Installing GDB
24320 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
24321 @cindex installation
24322
24323 @menu
24324 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
24325 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
24326 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
24327 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
24328 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
24329 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
24330 @end menu
24331
24332 @node Requirements
24333 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
24334 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
24335
24336 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
24337 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
24338
24339 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
24340 @table @asis
24341 @item ISO C90 compiler
24342 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
24343 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
24344
24345 @end table
24346
24347 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
24348 @table @asis
24349 @item Expat
24350 @anchor{Expat}
24351 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
24352 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
24353 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
24354 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
24355 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
24356 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
24357
24358 Expat is used for:
24359
24360 @itemize @bullet
24361 @item
24362 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
24363 @item
24364 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
24365 @item
24366 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
24367 @item
24368 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
24369 @end itemize
24370
24371 @item zlib
24372 @cindex compressed debug sections
24373 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
24374 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
24375 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
24376 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
24377 information in such binaries.
24378
24379 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
24380 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
24381 @url{http://zlib.net}.
24382
24383 @end table
24384
24385 @node Running Configure
24386 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
24387 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
24388 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
24389 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
24390 build the @code{gdb} program.
24391 @iftex
24392 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
24393 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
24394 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
24395 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
24396 @end iftex
24397
24398 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
24399 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
24400 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
24401
24402 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
24403 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
24404
24405 @table @code
24406 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
24407 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
24408
24409 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
24410 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
24411
24412 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
24413 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
24414
24415 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
24416 @sc{gnu} include files
24417
24418 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
24419 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
24420
24421 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
24422 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
24423
24424 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
24425 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
24426
24427 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
24428 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
24429
24430 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
24431 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
24432 @end table
24433
24434 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
24435 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
24436 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
24437
24438 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
24439 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
24440 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
24441 argument.
24442
24443 For example:
24444
24445 @smallexample
24446 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
24447 ./configure @var{host}
24448 make
24449 @end smallexample
24450
24451 @noindent
24452 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
24453 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
24454 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
24455 correct value by examining your system.)
24456
24457 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
24458 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
24459 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
24460 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
24461
24462 @need 750
24463 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
24464 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
24465 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
24466
24467 @smallexample
24468 sh configure @var{host}
24469 @end smallexample
24470
24471 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
24472 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
24473 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
24474 @file{configure}
24475 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
24476 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
24477
24478 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
24479 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
24480 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
24481 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
24482 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
24483 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
24484 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
24485 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
24486 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
24487
24488 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
24489 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
24490 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
24491 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
24492 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
24493
24494 @node Separate Objdir
24495 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
24496
24497 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
24498 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
24499 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
24500 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
24501 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
24502 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
24503 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
24504 program specified there.
24505
24506 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
24507 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
24508 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
24509 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
24510 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
24511 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
24512
24513 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
24514 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
24515
24516 @smallexample
24517 @group
24518 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
24519 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
24520 cd ../gdb-sun4
24521 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
24522 make
24523 @end group
24524 @end smallexample
24525
24526 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
24527 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
24528 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
24529 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
24530 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
24531 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
24532
24533 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
24534 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
24535 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
24536 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
24537 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
24538
24539 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
24540 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
24541 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
24542 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
24543 You specify a cross-debugging target by
24544 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
24545
24546 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
24547 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
24548 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
24549
24550 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
24551 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
24552 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
24553 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
24554 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
24555
24556 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
24557 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
24558 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
24559 with each other.
24560
24561 @node Config Names
24562 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
24563
24564 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
24565 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
24566 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
24567 of information in the following pattern:
24568
24569 @smallexample
24570 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
24571 @end smallexample
24572
24573 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
24574 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
24575 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
24576
24577 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
24578 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
24579 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
24580 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
24581 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
24582 abbreviations---for example:
24583
24584 @smallexample
24585 % sh config.sub i386-linux
24586 i386-pc-linux-gnu
24587 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
24588 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
24589 % sh config.sub hp9k700
24590 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
24591 % sh config.sub sun4
24592 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
24593 % sh config.sub sun3
24594 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
24595 % sh config.sub i986v
24596 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
24597 @end smallexample
24598
24599 @noindent
24600 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
24601 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
24602
24603 @node Configure Options
24604 @section @file{configure} Options
24605
24606 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
24607 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
24608 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
24609 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
24610
24611 @smallexample
24612 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
24613 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
24614 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
24615 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
24616 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
24617 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
24618 @var{host}
24619 @end smallexample
24620
24621 @noindent
24622 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
24623 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
24624 @samp{--}.
24625
24626 @table @code
24627 @item --help
24628 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
24629
24630 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
24631 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
24632 @file{@var{dir}}.
24633
24634 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
24635 Configure the source to install programs under directory
24636 @file{@var{dir}}.
24637
24638 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
24639 @need 2000
24640 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
24641 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
24642 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
24643 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
24644 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
24645 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
24646 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
24647 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
24648 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
24649 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
24650 @var{dirname}.
24651
24652 @item --norecursion
24653 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
24654 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
24655
24656 @item --target=@var{target}
24657 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
24658 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
24659 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
24660
24661 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
24662
24663 @item @var{host} @dots{}
24664 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
24665
24666 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
24667 @end table
24668
24669 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
24670 needed for special purposes only.
24671
24672 @node System-wide configuration
24673 @section System-wide configuration and settings
24674 @cindex system-wide init file
24675
24676 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
24677 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
24678 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
24679
24680 Here is the corresponding configure option:
24681
24682 @table @code
24683 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
24684 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
24685 @var{file}.
24686 @end table
24687
24688 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
24689 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
24690
24691 @itemize @bullet
24692 @item
24693 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
24694 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
24695 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
24696 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
24697 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
24698 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
24699
24700 @item
24701 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
24702 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
24703 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
24704 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
24705 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
24706 @end itemize
24707
24708 @node Maintenance Commands
24709 @appendix Maintenance Commands
24710 @cindex maintenance commands
24711 @cindex internal commands
24712
24713 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
24714 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
24715 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
24716 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
24717 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
24718
24719 @table @code
24720 @kindex maint agent
24721 @item maint agent @var{expression}
24722 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
24723 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
24724 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
24725
24726 @kindex maint info breakpoints
24727 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
24728 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
24729 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
24730 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
24731 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
24732 is shown:
24733
24734 @table @code
24735 @item breakpoint
24736 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
24737
24738 @item watchpoint
24739 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
24740
24741 @item longjmp
24742 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
24743 @code{longjmp} calls.
24744
24745 @item longjmp resume
24746 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
24747
24748 @item until
24749 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
24750
24751 @item finish
24752 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
24753
24754 @item shlib events
24755 Shared library events.
24756
24757 @end table
24758
24759 @kindex set displaced-stepping
24760 @kindex show displaced-stepping
24761 @cindex displaced stepping support
24762 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
24763 @item set displaced-stepping
24764 @itemx show displaced-stepping
24765 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
24766 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
24767 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
24768 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
24769 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
24770
24771 @table @code
24772 @item set displaced-stepping on
24773 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
24774 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
24775
24776 @item set displaced-stepping off
24777 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
24778 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
24779
24780 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
24781 @item set displaced-stepping auto
24782 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
24783 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
24784 architecture supports displaced stepping.
24785 @end table
24786
24787 @kindex maint check-symtabs
24788 @item maint check-symtabs
24789 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
24790
24791 @kindex maint cplus first_component
24792 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
24793 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
24794
24795 @kindex maint cplus namespace
24796 @item maint cplus namespace
24797 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
24798
24799 @kindex maint demangle
24800 @item maint demangle @var{name}
24801 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
24802
24803 @kindex maint deprecate
24804 @kindex maint undeprecate
24805 @cindex deprecated commands
24806 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
24807 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
24808 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
24809 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
24810 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
24811 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
24812 the replacement as part of the warning.
24813
24814 @kindex maint dump-me
24815 @item maint dump-me
24816 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
24817 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
24818 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
24819 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
24820
24821 @kindex maint internal-error
24822 @kindex maint internal-warning
24823 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
24824 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
24825 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
24826 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
24827 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
24828 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
24829 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
24830 @value{GDBN} session.
24831
24832 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
24833 used as the text of the error or warning message.
24834
24835 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
24836
24837 @smallexample
24838 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
24839 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
24840 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
24841 debugging may prove unreliable.
24842 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
24843 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
24844 (@value{GDBP})
24845 @end smallexample
24846
24847 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
24848 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
24849
24850 @kindex maint set internal-error
24851 @kindex maint show internal-error
24852 @kindex maint set internal-warning
24853 @kindex maint show internal-warning
24854 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
24855 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
24856 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
24857 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
24858 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
24859 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
24860 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
24861 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
24862 described in the table below.
24863
24864 @table @samp
24865 @item quit
24866 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
24867 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
24868
24869 @item corefile
24870 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
24871 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
24872 @end table
24873
24874 @kindex maint packet
24875 @item maint packet @var{text}
24876 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
24877 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
24878 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
24879 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
24880 checksum.
24881
24882 @kindex maint print architecture
24883 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24884 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
24885 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
24886
24887 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
24888 @item maint print c-tdesc
24889 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
24890 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
24891 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
24892
24893 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
24894 @item maint print dummy-frames
24895 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
24896
24897 @smallexample
24898 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
24899 @dots{}
24900 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
24901 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
24902 58 return (a + b);
24903 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
24904 @dots{}
24905 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
24906 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
24907 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
24908 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
24909 (@value{GDBP})
24910 @end smallexample
24911
24912 Takes an optional file parameter.
24913
24914 @kindex maint print registers
24915 @kindex maint print raw-registers
24916 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
24917 @kindex maint print register-groups
24918 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24919 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24920 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24921 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24922 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
24923
24924 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
24925 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
24926 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
24927 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
24928 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
24929 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
24930
24931 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
24932 write the information.
24933
24934 @kindex maint print reggroups
24935 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24936 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
24937 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
24938 information.
24939
24940 The register groups info looks like this:
24941
24942 @smallexample
24943 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
24944 Group Type
24945 general user
24946 float user
24947 all user
24948 vector user
24949 system user
24950 save internal
24951 restore internal
24952 @end smallexample
24953
24954 @kindex flushregs
24955 @item flushregs
24956 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
24957
24958 @kindex maint print objfiles
24959 @cindex info for known object files
24960 @item maint print objfiles
24961 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
24962 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
24963 and symtabs.
24964
24965 @kindex maint print statistics
24966 @cindex bcache statistics
24967 @item maint print statistics
24968 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
24969 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
24970 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
24971 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
24972 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
24973 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
24974 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
24975 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
24976 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
24977 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
24978 lengths.
24979
24980 @kindex maint print target-stack
24981 @cindex target stack description
24982 @item maint print target-stack
24983 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
24984 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
24985 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
24986 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
24987 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
24988 address.
24989
24990 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
24991 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
24992
24993 @kindex maint print type
24994 @cindex type chain of a data type
24995 @item maint print type @var{expr}
24996 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
24997 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
24998 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
24999 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
25000 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
25001
25002 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25003 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25004 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25005 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25006 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
25007
25008 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
25009 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
25010 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
25011 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
25012 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
25013 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
25014 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
25015 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
25016 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
25017
25018 @kindex maint set profile
25019 @kindex maint show profile
25020 @cindex profiling GDB
25021 @item maint set profile
25022 @itemx maint show profile
25023 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
25024
25025 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
25026 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
25027 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
25028 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
25029 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
25030 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
25031 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
25032
25033 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
25034 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
25035
25036 @kindex maint set linux-async
25037 @kindex maint show linux-async
25038 @cindex asynchronous support
25039 @item maint set linux-async
25040 @itemx maint show linux-async
25041 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support
25042 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
25043
25044 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
25045 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
25046
25047 @kindex maint set remote-async
25048 @kindex maint show remote-async
25049 @cindex asynchronous support
25050 @item maint set remote-async
25051 @itemx maint show remote-async
25052 Control the remote asynchronous support
25053 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
25054
25055 Remote asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
25056 the @samp{maint set remote-async} command to enable it.
25057
25058 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
25059 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
25060 @item maint show-debug-regs
25061 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
25062 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
25063 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
25064 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
25065 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
25066
25067 @kindex maint space
25068 @cindex memory used by commands
25069 @item maint space
25070 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
25071 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
25072 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
25073 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
25074 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25075
25076 @kindex maint time
25077 @cindex time of command execution
25078 @item maint time
25079 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
25080 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
25081 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
25082 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
25083 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
25084 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
25085 it's not possibly currently
25086 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
25087 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25088
25089 @kindex maint translate-address
25090 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
25091 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
25092 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
25093 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
25094 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
25095 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
25096 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
25097
25098 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
25099 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
25100 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
25101
25102 @end table
25103
25104 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
25105 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
25106
25107 @table @code
25108 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
25109 @kindex set watchdog
25110 @cindex watchdog timer
25111 @cindex timeout for commands
25112 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
25113 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
25114 reports and error and the command is aborted.
25115
25116 @item show watchdog
25117 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
25118 @end table
25119
25120 @node Remote Protocol
25121 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
25122
25123 @menu
25124 * Overview::
25125 * Packets::
25126 * Stop Reply Packets::
25127 * General Query Packets::
25128 * Register Packet Format::
25129 * Tracepoint Packets::
25130 * Host I/O Packets::
25131 * Interrupts::
25132 * Notification Packets::
25133 * Remote Non-Stop::
25134 * Packet Acknowledgment::
25135 * Examples::
25136 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
25137 * Library List Format::
25138 * Memory Map Format::
25139 @end menu
25140
25141 @node Overview
25142 @section Overview
25143
25144 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
25145 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
25146 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
25147 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
25148
25149 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
25150 transmitted and received data, respectively.
25151
25152 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
25153 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
25154 @cindex remote serial protocol
25155 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
25156 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
25157 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
25158 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
25159 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
25160
25161 @smallexample
25162 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25163 @end smallexample
25164 @noindent
25165
25166 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
25167 @noindent
25168 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
25169 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
25170 eight bit unsigned checksum).
25171
25172 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
25173 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
25174
25175 @smallexample
25176 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25177 @end smallexample
25178
25179 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
25180 @noindent
25181 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
25182 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
25183 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
25184
25185 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
25186 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
25187 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
25188 retransmission):
25189
25190 @smallexample
25191 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25192 <- @code{+}
25193 @end smallexample
25194 @noindent
25195
25196 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
25197 once a connection is established.
25198 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
25199
25200 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
25201 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
25202 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
25203 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
25204 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
25205 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
25206 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
25207
25208 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
25209 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
25210 exceptions).
25211
25212 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
25213 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
25214 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
25215 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
25216
25217 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
25218 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
25219 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
25220
25221 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
25222 @anchor{Binary Data}
25223 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
25224 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
25225 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
25226 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
25227 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
25228 binary data.
25229
25230 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
25231 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
25232 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
25233 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
25234 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
25235 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
25236 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
25237 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
25238 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
25239 (described next).
25240
25241 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
25242 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
25243 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
25244 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
25245 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
25246 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
25247 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
25248 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
25249 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
25250 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
25251 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
25252 3}} more times.
25253
25254 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
25255 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
25256 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
25257 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
25258 @samp{0*"00}.
25259
25260 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
25261 error number. That number is not well defined.
25262
25263 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
25264 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
25265 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
25266 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
25267 on that response.
25268
25269 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
25270 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
25271 optional.
25272
25273 @node Packets
25274 @section Packets
25275
25276 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
25277 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
25278 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
25279 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
25280
25281 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
25282 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
25283 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
25284 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
25285 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
25286 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
25287 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
25288 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
25289 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
25290 @var{baz}.
25291
25292 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
25293 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
25294 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
25295 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
25296 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
25297 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
25298 pick any thread.
25299
25300 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
25301 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
25302 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
25303 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
25304 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
25305 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
25306 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
25307 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
25308 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
25309 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
25310 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
25311 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
25312 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
25313
25314 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
25315 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
25316 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
25317 more information.
25318
25319 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
25320 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
25321
25322 Here are the packet descriptions.
25323
25324 @table @samp
25325
25326 @item !
25327 @cindex @samp{!} packet
25328 @anchor{extended mode}
25329 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
25330 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
25331 debugged.
25332
25333 Reply:
25334 @table @samp
25335 @item OK
25336 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
25337 @end table
25338
25339 @item ?
25340 @cindex @samp{?} packet
25341 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
25342 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
25343 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
25344
25345 Reply:
25346 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25347
25348 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
25349 @cindex @samp{A} packet
25350 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
25351 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
25352 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
25353
25354 Reply:
25355 @table @samp
25356 @item OK
25357 The arguments were set.
25358 @item E @var{NN}
25359 An error occurred.
25360 @end table
25361
25362 @item b @var{baud}
25363 @cindex @samp{b} packet
25364 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
25365 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
25366
25367 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
25368 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
25369 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
25370
25371 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
25372 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
25373 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
25374 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
25375 of view, nothing actually happened.}
25376
25377 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
25378 @cindex @samp{B} packet
25379 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
25380 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
25381
25382 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
25383 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
25384
25385 @item bc
25386 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
25387 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
25388 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
25389
25390 Reply:
25391 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25392
25393 @item bs
25394 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
25395 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
25396 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
25397
25398 Reply:
25399 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25400
25401 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
25402 @cindex @samp{c} packet
25403 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
25404 resume at current address.
25405
25406 Reply:
25407 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25408
25409 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
25410 @cindex @samp{C} packet
25411 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
25412 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
25413
25414 Reply:
25415 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25416
25417 @item d
25418 @cindex @samp{d} packet
25419 Toggle debug flag.
25420
25421 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
25422 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
25423
25424 @item D
25425 @itemx D;@var{pid}
25426 @cindex @samp{D} packet
25427 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
25428 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
25429 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
25430
25431 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
25432 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
25433 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
25434 big-endian hex string.
25435
25436 Reply:
25437 @table @samp
25438 @item OK
25439 for success
25440 @item E @var{NN}
25441 for an error
25442 @end table
25443
25444 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
25445 @cindex @samp{F} packet
25446 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
25447 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
25448 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
25449
25450 @item g
25451 @anchor{read registers packet}
25452 @cindex @samp{g} packet
25453 Read general registers.
25454
25455 Reply:
25456 @table @samp
25457 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25458 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
25459 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
25460 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
25461 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
25462 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
25463 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
25464 @item E @var{NN}
25465 for an error.
25466 @end table
25467
25468 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
25469 @cindex @samp{G} packet
25470 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
25471 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
25472
25473 Reply:
25474 @table @samp
25475 @item OK
25476 for success
25477 @item E @var{NN}
25478 for an error
25479 @end table
25480
25481 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
25482 @cindex @samp{H} packet
25483 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
25484 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
25485 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
25486 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
25487 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25488
25489 Reply:
25490 @table @samp
25491 @item OK
25492 for success
25493 @item E @var{NN}
25494 for an error
25495 @end table
25496
25497 @c FIXME: JTC:
25498 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
25499 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
25500 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
25501 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
25502 @c described. For example:
25503 @c
25504 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
25505 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
25506 @c otherwise returns current registers.
25507 @c
25508 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
25509 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
25510 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
25511
25512 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
25513 @anchor{cycle step packet}
25514 @cindex @samp{i} packet
25515 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
25516 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
25517 step starting at that address.
25518
25519 @item I
25520 @cindex @samp{I} packet
25521 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
25522 step packet}.
25523
25524 @item k
25525 @cindex @samp{k} packet
25526 Kill request.
25527
25528 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
25529 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
25530 thread?)}.
25531
25532 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
25533 @cindex @samp{m} packet
25534 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
25535 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
25536
25537 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
25538 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
25539 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
25540 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
25541 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
25542 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
25543 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
25544 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
25545
25546 Reply:
25547 @table @samp
25548 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25549 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
25550 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
25551 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
25552 @item E @var{NN}
25553 @var{NN} is errno
25554 @end table
25555
25556 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25557 @cindex @samp{M} packet
25558 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
25559 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
25560 hexadecimal number.
25561
25562 Reply:
25563 @table @samp
25564 @item OK
25565 for success
25566 @item E @var{NN}
25567 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
25568 written).
25569 @end table
25570
25571 @item p @var{n}
25572 @cindex @samp{p} packet
25573 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
25574 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
25575 register value is encoded.
25576
25577 Reply:
25578 @table @samp
25579 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25580 the register's value
25581 @item E @var{NN}
25582 for an error
25583 @item
25584 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
25585 @end table
25586
25587 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
25588 @anchor{write register packet}
25589 @cindex @samp{P} packet
25590 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
25591 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
25592 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
25593
25594 Reply:
25595 @table @samp
25596 @item OK
25597 for success
25598 @item E @var{NN}
25599 for an error
25600 @end table
25601
25602 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
25603 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
25604 @cindex @samp{q} packet
25605 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
25606 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
25607 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
25608
25609 @item r
25610 @cindex @samp{r} packet
25611 Reset the entire system.
25612
25613 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
25614
25615 @item R @var{XX}
25616 @cindex @samp{R} packet
25617 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
25618 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
25619
25620 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
25621
25622 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
25623 @cindex @samp{s} packet
25624 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
25625 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
25626
25627 Reply:
25628 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25629
25630 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
25631 @anchor{step with signal packet}
25632 @cindex @samp{S} packet
25633 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
25634 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
25635
25636 Reply:
25637 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25638
25639 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
25640 @cindex @samp{t} packet
25641 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
25642 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
25643 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
25644
25645 @item T @var{thread-id}
25646 @cindex @samp{T} packet
25647 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
25648
25649 Reply:
25650 @table @samp
25651 @item OK
25652 thread is still alive
25653 @item E @var{NN}
25654 thread is dead
25655 @end table
25656
25657 @item v
25658 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
25659 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
25660
25661 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
25662 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
25663 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
25664 The process ID is a
25665 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
25666 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
25667 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
25668
25669 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
25670 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
25671 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
25672 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
25673 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
25674 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
25675 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
25676 @c stopping or restarting threads.
25677
25678 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
25679
25680 Reply:
25681 @table @samp
25682 @item E @var{nn}
25683 for an error
25684 @item @r{Any stop packet}
25685 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
25686 @item OK
25687 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
25688 @end table
25689
25690 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
25691 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
25692 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
25693 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
25694 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
25695 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
25696 in their current state in non-stop mode.
25697 Specifying multiple
25698 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
25699 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25700
25701 Currently supported actions are:
25702
25703 @table @samp
25704 @item c
25705 Continue.
25706 @item C @var{sig}
25707 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
25708 @item s
25709 Step.
25710 @item S @var{sig}
25711 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
25712 @item t
25713 Stop.
25714 @item T @var{sig}
25715 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
25716 @end table
25717
25718 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
25719 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
25720 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
25721
25722 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
25723 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
25724 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
25725 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
25726 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
25727 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
25728 as an implementation detail.
25729
25730 Reply:
25731 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25732
25733 @item vCont?
25734 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
25735 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
25736
25737 Reply:
25738 @table @samp
25739 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
25740 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
25741 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
25742 @item
25743 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
25744 @end table
25745
25746 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
25747 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
25748 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
25749 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
25750
25751 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
25752 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
25753 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
25754 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
25755 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
25756 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
25757 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
25758 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
25759 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
25760 packet is received.
25761
25762 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
25763 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
25764 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
25765 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
25766 @var{thread-id}.
25767
25768 Reply:
25769 @table @samp
25770 @item OK
25771 for success
25772 @item E @var{NN}
25773 for an error
25774 @end table
25775
25776 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25777 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
25778 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
25779 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
25780 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
25781 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
25782 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
25783 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
25784 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
25785 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
25786 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
25787 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
25788
25789
25790 Reply:
25791 @table @samp
25792 @item OK
25793 for success
25794 @item E.memtype
25795 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
25796 @item E @var{NN}
25797 for an error
25798 @end table
25799
25800 @item vFlashDone
25801 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
25802 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
25803 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
25804 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
25805 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
25806 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
25807 request is completed.
25808
25809 @item vKill;@var{pid}
25810 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
25811 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
25812 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
25813 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
25814 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
25815
25816 Reply:
25817 @table @samp
25818 @item E @var{nn}
25819 for an error
25820 @item OK
25821 for success
25822 @end table
25823
25824 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
25825 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
25826 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
25827 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
25828 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
25829 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
25830 state.
25831
25832 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
25833
25834 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
25835
25836 Reply:
25837 @table @samp
25838 @item E @var{nn}
25839 for an error
25840 @item @r{Any stop packet}
25841 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
25842 @end table
25843
25844 @item vStopped
25845 @anchor{vStopped packet}
25846 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
25847
25848 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
25849 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
25850
25851 Reply:
25852 @table @samp
25853 @item @r{Any stop packet}
25854 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
25855 @item OK
25856 if there are no unreported stop events
25857 @end table
25858
25859 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25860 @anchor{X packet}
25861 @cindex @samp{X} packet
25862 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
25863 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
25864 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25865
25866 Reply:
25867 @table @samp
25868 @item OK
25869 for success
25870 @item E @var{NN}
25871 for an error
25872 @end table
25873
25874 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
25875 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
25876 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
25877 @cindex @samp{z} packet
25878 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
25879 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
25880 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
25881 @var{length} bytes.
25882
25883 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
25884 separately.
25885
25886 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
25887 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
25888 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
25889 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
25890 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
25891 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
25892
25893 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
25894 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
25895 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
25896 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
25897 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
25898 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
25899
25900 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
25901 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
25902 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
25903 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
25904 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
25905
25906 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
25907 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
25908 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
25909 target, is not defined.}
25910
25911 Reply:
25912 @table @samp
25913 @item OK
25914 success
25915 @item
25916 not supported
25917 @item E @var{NN}
25918 for an error
25919 @end table
25920
25921 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
25922 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
25923 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
25924 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
25925 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
25926 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
25927
25928 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
25929 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
25930
25931 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
25932 movement.}
25933
25934 Reply:
25935 @table @samp
25936 @item OK
25937 success
25938 @item
25939 not supported
25940 @item E @var{NN}
25941 for an error
25942 @end table
25943
25944 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
25945 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
25946 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
25947 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
25948 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
25949
25950 Reply:
25951 @table @samp
25952 @item OK
25953 success
25954 @item
25955 not supported
25956 @item E @var{NN}
25957 for an error
25958 @end table
25959
25960 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
25961 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
25962 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
25963 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
25964 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
25965
25966 Reply:
25967 @table @samp
25968 @item OK
25969 success
25970 @item
25971 not supported
25972 @item E @var{NN}
25973 for an error
25974 @end table
25975
25976 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
25977 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
25978 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
25979 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
25980 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
25981
25982 Reply:
25983 @table @samp
25984 @item OK
25985 success
25986 @item
25987 not supported
25988 @item E @var{NN}
25989 for an error
25990 @end table
25991
25992 @end table
25993
25994 @node Stop Reply Packets
25995 @section Stop Reply Packets
25996 @cindex stop reply packets
25997
25998 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
25999 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
26000 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
26001 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
26002 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
26003 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
26004 @value{GDBN} source code.
26005
26006 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
26007 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
26008 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
26009 components.
26010
26011 @table @samp
26012
26013 @item S @var{AA}
26014 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26015 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
26016 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
26017
26018 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
26019 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
26020 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26021 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
26022 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
26023 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
26024 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
26025 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
26026
26027 @itemize @bullet
26028 @item
26029 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
26030 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
26031 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
26032 two-digit hex number.
26033
26034 @item
26035 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
26036 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26037
26038 @item
26039 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
26040 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
26041 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
26042 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
26043
26044 @item
26045 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
26046 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
26047 future.
26048 @end itemize
26049
26050 The currently defined stop reasons are:
26051
26052 @table @samp
26053 @item watch
26054 @itemx rwatch
26055 @itemx awatch
26056 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
26057 hex.
26058
26059 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
26060 @item library
26061 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
26062 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
26063 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
26064
26065 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
26066 @item replaylog
26067 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
26068 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
26069 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
26070 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
26071 for more information.
26072
26073
26074 @end table
26075
26076 @item W @var{AA}
26077 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26078 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
26079 applicable to certain targets.
26080
26081 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
26082 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
26083 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26084 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26085
26086 @item X @var{AA}
26087 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26088 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
26089
26090 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
26091 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
26092 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
26093 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26094
26095 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
26096 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
26097 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
26098 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
26099 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
26100
26101 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
26102 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
26103 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
26104 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
26105 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
26106 system calls.
26107
26108 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
26109 this very system call.
26110
26111 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
26112 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
26113 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
26114 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26115 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
26116 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
26117
26118 @end table
26119
26120 @node General Query Packets
26121 @section General Query Packets
26122 @cindex remote query requests
26123
26124 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
26125 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
26126 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
26127 sending information to and from the stub.
26128
26129 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
26130 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
26131 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
26132 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
26133 conventions:
26134
26135 @itemize @bullet
26136 @item
26137 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
26138 @item
26139 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
26140 letter.
26141 @item
26142 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
26143 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
26144 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
26145 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
26146 @end itemize
26147
26148 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
26149 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
26150 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
26151 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
26152 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
26153 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
26154 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
26155 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
26156 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
26157 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
26158 packet.}.
26159
26160 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
26161 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
26162 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
26163 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
26164 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
26165
26166 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
26167
26168 @table @samp
26169
26170 @item qC
26171 @cindex current thread, remote request
26172 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
26173 Return the current thread ID.
26174
26175 Reply:
26176 @table @samp
26177 @item QC @var{thread-id}
26178 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
26179 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26180 @item @r{(anything else)}
26181 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
26182 @end table
26183
26184 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
26185 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
26186 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
26187 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
26188 Reply:
26189 @table @samp
26190 @item E @var{NN}
26191 An error (such as memory fault)
26192 @item C @var{crc32}
26193 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
26194 @end table
26195
26196 @item qfThreadInfo
26197 @itemx qsThreadInfo
26198 @cindex list active threads, remote request
26199 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
26200 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
26201 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
26202 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
26203 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
26204 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
26205 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
26206 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
26207
26208 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
26209
26210 Reply:
26211 @table @samp
26212 @item m @var{thread-id}
26213 A single thread ID
26214 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
26215 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
26216 @item l
26217 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
26218 @end table
26219
26220 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
26221 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
26222 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
26223 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
26224 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
26225 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
26226 fields.
26227
26228 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
26229 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
26230 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
26231 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
26232 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
26233
26234 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
26235 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26236
26237 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
26238 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
26239 information associated with the variable.)
26240
26241 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
26242 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
26243 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
26244 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
26245 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
26246 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
26247
26248 Reply:
26249 @table @samp
26250 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
26251 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
26252 local storage requested.
26253
26254 @item E @var{nn}
26255 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26256
26257 @item
26258 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
26259 @end table
26260
26261 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
26262 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
26263 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
26264 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
26265 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
26266 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
26267 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
26268
26269 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
26270
26271 Reply:
26272 @table @samp
26273 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
26274 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
26275 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
26276 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
26277 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
26278 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
26279 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
26280 @end table
26281
26282 @item qOffsets
26283 @cindex section offsets, remote request
26284 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
26285 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
26286 image.
26287
26288 Reply:
26289 @table @samp
26290 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
26291 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
26292 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
26293 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
26294 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
26295 segments by the supplied offsets.
26296
26297 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
26298 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
26299 to the @code{Bss} section.}
26300
26301 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
26302 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
26303 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
26304 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
26305 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
26306 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
26307 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
26308 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
26309 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
26310 @end table
26311
26312 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
26313 @cindex thread information, remote request
26314 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
26315 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
26316 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
26317 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
26318
26319 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
26320 (see below).
26321
26322 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
26323
26324 @item QNonStop:1
26325 @item QNonStop:0
26326 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
26327 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
26328 @anchor{QNonStop}
26329 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
26330 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
26331
26332 Reply:
26333 @table @samp
26334 @item OK
26335 The request succeeded.
26336
26337 @item E @var{nn}
26338 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26339
26340 @item
26341 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
26342 the stub.
26343 @end table
26344
26345 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26346 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26347 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
26348 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
26349
26350 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
26351 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
26352 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
26353 @anchor{QPassSignals}
26354 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
26355 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
26356 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
26357 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
26358 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
26359 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
26360 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
26361 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
26362 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
26363
26364 Reply:
26365 @table @samp
26366 @item OK
26367 The request succeeded.
26368
26369 @item E @var{nn}
26370 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26371
26372 @item
26373 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
26374 the stub.
26375 @end table
26376
26377 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
26378 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
26379 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26380 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26381
26382 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
26383 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
26384 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
26385 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
26386 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
26387 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
26388 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
26389 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
26390 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
26391
26392 Reply:
26393 @table @samp
26394 @item OK
26395 A command response with no output.
26396 @item @var{OUTPUT}
26397 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
26398 @item E @var{NN}
26399 Indicate a badly formed request.
26400 @item
26401 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
26402 @end table
26403
26404 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
26405 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
26406 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
26407 packets.)
26408
26409 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
26410 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
26411 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
26412 @anchor{qSearch memory}
26413 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
26414 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
26415 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
26416
26417 Reply:
26418 @table @samp
26419 @item 0
26420 The pattern was not found.
26421 @item 1,address
26422 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
26423 @item E @var{NN}
26424 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
26425 @item
26426 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
26427 @end table
26428
26429 @item QStartNoAckMode
26430 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
26431 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
26432 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
26433 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
26434
26435 Reply:
26436 @table @samp
26437 @item OK
26438 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
26439 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
26440 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
26441 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
26442 @item
26443 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
26444 @end table
26445
26446 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
26447 @cindex supported packets, remote query
26448 @cindex features of the remote protocol
26449 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
26450 @anchor{qSupported}
26451 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
26452 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
26453 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
26454 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
26455 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
26456 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
26457 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
26458 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
26459 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
26460 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
26461 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
26462 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
26463 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
26464 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
26465
26466 Reply:
26467 @table @samp
26468 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
26469 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
26470 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
26471 possible forms).
26472 @item
26473 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
26474 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
26475 @end table
26476
26477 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
26478 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
26479 are:
26480
26481 @table @samp
26482 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
26483 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
26484 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
26485 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
26486 @item @var{name}+
26487 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
26488 need an associated value.
26489 @item @var{name}-
26490 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
26491 @item @var{name}?
26492 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
26493 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
26494 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
26495 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
26496 @end table
26497
26498 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
26499 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
26500 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
26501 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
26502 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
26503
26504 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
26505 are defined:
26506
26507 @table @samp
26508 @item multiprocess
26509 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
26510 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
26511 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
26512 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
26513 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
26514 @end table
26515
26516 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
26517 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
26518 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
26519 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
26520 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
26521 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
26522 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
26523 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
26524 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
26525 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
26526 all the features it supports.
26527
26528 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
26529 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
26530
26531 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
26532 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
26533 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
26534 form response.
26535
26536 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
26537 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
26538 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
26539 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
26540
26541 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
26542 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
26543 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
26544 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
26545 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
26546
26547 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
26548
26549 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
26550 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
26551 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
26552 @item Feature Name
26553 @tab Value Required
26554 @tab Default
26555 @tab Probe Allowed
26556
26557 @item @samp{PacketSize}
26558 @tab Yes
26559 @tab @samp{-}
26560 @tab No
26561
26562 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
26563 @tab No
26564 @tab @samp{-}
26565 @tab Yes
26566
26567 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
26568 @tab No
26569 @tab @samp{-}
26570 @tab Yes
26571
26572 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26573 @tab No
26574 @tab @samp{-}
26575 @tab Yes
26576
26577 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26578 @tab No
26579 @tab @samp{-}
26580 @tab Yes
26581
26582 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
26583 @tab No
26584 @tab @samp{-}
26585 @tab Yes
26586
26587 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
26588 @tab No
26589 @tab @samp{-}
26590 @tab Yes
26591
26592 @item @samp{QNonStop}
26593 @tab No
26594 @tab @samp{-}
26595 @tab Yes
26596
26597 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
26598 @tab No
26599 @tab @samp{-}
26600 @tab Yes
26601
26602 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
26603 @tab No
26604 @tab @samp{-}
26605 @tab Yes
26606
26607 @item @samp{multiprocess}
26608 @tab No
26609 @tab @samp{-}
26610 @tab No
26611
26612 @end multitable
26613
26614 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
26615
26616 @table @samp
26617 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
26618 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
26619 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
26620 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
26621 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
26622 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
26623 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
26624 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
26625 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
26626 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
26627
26628 @item qXfer:auxv:read
26629 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
26630 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
26631
26632 @item qXfer:features:read
26633 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
26634 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
26635
26636 @item qXfer:libraries:read
26637 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
26638 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
26639
26640 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
26641 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
26642 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
26643
26644 @item qXfer:spu:read
26645 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
26646 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
26647
26648 @item qXfer:spu:write
26649 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
26650 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
26651
26652 @item QNonStop
26653 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
26654 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
26655
26656 @item QPassSignals
26657 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
26658 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
26659
26660 @item QStartNoAckMode
26661 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
26662 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
26663
26664 @item multiprocess
26665 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
26666 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
26667 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
26668 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
26669 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
26670 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
26671 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
26672 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
26673 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
26674 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
26675 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
26676
26677 @item qXfer:osdata:read
26678 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
26679 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
26680
26681 @end table
26682
26683 @item qSymbol::
26684 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
26685 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
26686 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
26687 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
26688
26689 Reply:
26690 @table @samp
26691 @item OK
26692 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
26693 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
26694 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
26695 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
26696 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
26697 below.
26698 @end table
26699
26700 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
26701 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
26702
26703 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
26704 target has previously requested.
26705
26706 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
26707 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
26708 will be empty.
26709
26710 Reply:
26711 @table @samp
26712 @item OK
26713 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
26714 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
26715 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
26716 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
26717 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
26718 @end table
26719
26720 @item QTDP
26721 @itemx QTFrame
26722 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
26723
26724 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
26725 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
26726 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
26727 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
26728 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
26729 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
26730 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
26731 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
26732 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
26733 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
26734 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
26735
26736 Reply:
26737 @table @samp
26738 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
26739 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
26740 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
26741 the thread's attributes.
26742 @end table
26743
26744 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
26745 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
26746 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
26747 packets.)
26748
26749 @item QTStart
26750 @itemx QTStop
26751 @itemx QTinit
26752 @itemx QTro
26753 @itemx qTStatus
26754 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
26755
26756 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26757 @cindex read special object, remote request
26758 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
26759 @anchor{qXfer read}
26760 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
26761 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
26762 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
26763 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
26764 additional details about what data to access.
26765
26766 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
26767 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
26768 formats, listed below.
26769
26770 @table @samp
26771 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
26772 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
26773 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
26774 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
26775
26776 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26777 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26778
26779 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26780 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
26781 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
26782 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
26783 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
26784
26785 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26786 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26787
26788 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26789 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
26790 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
26791 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
26792 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
26793
26794 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
26795 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
26796 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
26797
26798 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26799 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26800
26801 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
26802 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
26803 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
26804 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
26805 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
26806
26807 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26808 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26809
26810 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26811 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
26812 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
26813 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
26814 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
26815 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
26816 in that context to be accessed.
26817
26818 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26819 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
26820 (@pxref{qSupported}).
26821
26822 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
26823 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
26824 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
26825 @xref{Operating System Information}.
26826
26827 @end table
26828
26829 Reply:
26830 @table @samp
26831 @item m @var{data}
26832 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
26833 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
26834 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
26835 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
26836 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
26837 request.
26838
26839 @item l @var{data}
26840 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
26841 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
26842 than the @var{length} in the request.
26843
26844 @item l
26845 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
26846 There is no more data to be read.
26847
26848 @item E00
26849 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
26850
26851 @item E @var{nn}
26852 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
26853 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
26854
26855 @item
26856 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
26857 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
26858 @end table
26859
26860 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
26861 @cindex write data into object, remote request
26862 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
26863 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
26864 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
26865 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
26866 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
26867 to access.
26868
26869 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
26870 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
26871 formats, listed below.
26872
26873 @table @samp
26874 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
26875 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
26876 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
26877 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
26878 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
26879 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
26880 in that context to be accessed.
26881
26882 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26883 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26884 @end table
26885
26886 Reply:
26887 @table @samp
26888 @item @var{nn}
26889 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
26890 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
26891
26892 @item E00
26893 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
26894
26895 @item E @var{nn}
26896 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
26897 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
26898
26899 @item
26900 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
26901 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
26902 @end table
26903
26904 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
26905 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
26906 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
26907 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
26908 must respond with an empty packet.
26909
26910 @end table
26911
26912 @node Register Packet Format
26913 @section Register Packet Format
26914
26915 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
26916 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
26917 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
26918 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
26919 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
26920 most-significant - least-significant.
26921
26922 @table @r
26923
26924 @item MIPS32
26925
26926 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
26927 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
26928 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
26929
26930 @item MIPS64
26931
26932 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
26933 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
26934 as @code{MIPS32}.
26935
26936 @end table
26937
26938 @node Tracepoint Packets
26939 @section Tracepoint Packets
26940 @cindex tracepoint packets
26941 @cindex packets, tracepoint
26942
26943 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
26944 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
26945
26946 @table @samp
26947
26948 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
26949 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
26950 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
26951 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
26952 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
26953 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
26954 tracepoint's actions.
26955
26956 Replies:
26957 @table @samp
26958 @item OK
26959 The packet was understood and carried out.
26960 @item
26961 The packet was not recognized.
26962 @end table
26963
26964 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
26965 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
26966 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
26967 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
26968 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
26969 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
26970 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
26971
26972 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
26973 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
26974 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
26975 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
26976 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
26977 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
26978 tracepoint actions.
26979
26980 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
26981 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
26982 following forms:
26983
26984 @table @samp
26985
26986 @item R @var{mask}
26987 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
26988 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
26989 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
26990 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
26991 not fit in a 32-bit word.
26992
26993 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
26994 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
26995 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
26996 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
26997 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
26998 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
26999 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
27000
27001 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
27002 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
27003 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
27004 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
27005 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
27006 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
27007 packet).
27008
27009 @end table
27010
27011 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
27012 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
27013 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
27014 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
27015 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
27016 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
27017 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
27018 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
27019
27020 Replies:
27021 @table @samp
27022 @item OK
27023 The packet was understood and carried out.
27024 @item
27025 The packet was not recognized.
27026 @end table
27027
27028 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
27029 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
27030 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
27031 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
27032
27033 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
27034 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
27035 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
27036 one of the following forms:
27037
27038 @table @samp
27039 @item F @var{f}
27040 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
27041 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
27042 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
27043
27044 @item T @var{t}
27045 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
27046 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
27047
27048 @end table
27049
27050 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
27051 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27052 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
27053 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
27054
27055 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
27056 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27057 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
27058 is a hexadecimal number.
27059
27060 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
27061 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27062 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
27063 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
27064 numbers.
27065
27066 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
27067 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
27068 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
27069
27070 @item QTStart
27071 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
27072 hits in the trace frame buffer.
27073
27074 @item QTStop
27075 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
27076
27077 @item QTinit
27078 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
27079
27080 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
27081 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
27082 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
27083 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
27084
27085 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
27086 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
27087 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
27088 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
27089
27090 @item qTStatus
27091 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
27092
27093 Replies:
27094 @table @samp
27095 @item T0
27096 There is no trace experiment running.
27097 @item T1
27098 There is a trace experiment running.
27099 @end table
27100
27101 @end table
27102
27103
27104 @node Host I/O Packets
27105 @section Host I/O Packets
27106 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
27107 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
27108
27109 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
27110 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
27111 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
27112 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
27113 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
27114 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
27115 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
27116 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
27117 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
27118 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
27119
27120 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
27121 its arguments. They have this format:
27122
27123 @table @samp
27124
27125 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
27126 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
27127 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
27128 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
27129 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
27130 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
27131 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
27132 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
27133 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
27134
27135 @end table
27136
27137 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
27138
27139 @table @samp
27140
27141 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
27142 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
27143 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
27144 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
27145 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
27146 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
27147 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
27148 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
27149 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
27150 @var{attachment}.
27151
27152 @item
27153 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
27154
27155 @end table
27156
27157 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
27158
27159 @table @samp
27160 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
27161 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
27162 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
27163 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
27164 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
27165 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
27166 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
27167
27168 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
27169 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
27170 -1 if an error occurs.
27171
27172 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
27173 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
27174 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
27175 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
27176 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
27177 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
27178 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
27179 @var{count} was zero.
27180
27181 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
27182 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
27183 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
27184 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
27185 some characters were escaped.
27186
27187 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
27188 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
27189 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
27190 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
27191 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
27192 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
27193 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
27194 error occurred.
27195
27196 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
27197 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
27198 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
27199
27200 @end table
27201
27202 @node Interrupts
27203 @section Interrupts
27204 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
27205
27206 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
27207 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
27208 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
27209 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
27210
27211 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
27212 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
27213 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
27214 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
27215 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
27216
27217 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
27218 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
27219 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
27220 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
27221 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
27222 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
27223 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
27224 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
27225
27226 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
27227 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
27228 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
27229 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
27230 currently-executing threads and processes.
27231 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
27232 running program, it should send one of the stop
27233 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
27234 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
27235 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
27236 Interrupts received while the
27237 program is stopped are discarded.
27238
27239 @node Notification Packets
27240 @section Notification Packets
27241 @cindex notification packets
27242 @cindex packets, notification
27243
27244 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
27245 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
27246 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
27247 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
27248 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
27249 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
27250 is not a problem.
27251
27252 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
27253 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
27254 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
27255 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
27256 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
27257 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
27258 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
27259
27260 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
27261 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
27262
27263 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
27264 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
27265 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
27266 not they understand it.
27267
27268 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
27269 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
27270 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
27271 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
27272 recipients.
27273
27274 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
27275 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
27276 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
27277 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
27278 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
27279
27280 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
27281 defined:
27282
27283 @table @samp
27284 @item Stop: @var{reply}
27285 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
27286 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
27287 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
27288 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
27289 @value{GDBN}.
27290 @end table
27291
27292 @node Remote Non-Stop
27293 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
27294
27295 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
27296 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
27297 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
27298 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27299
27300 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
27301 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
27302 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
27303 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
27304 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
27305 probe the target state after a mode change.
27306
27307 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
27308 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
27309 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
27310 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
27311 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
27312 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
27313 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
27314 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
27315 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
27316 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
27317 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
27318
27319 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
27320 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
27321 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
27322 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
27323 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
27324 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
27325 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
27326 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
27327 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
27328 sending any queued stop events.
27329
27330 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
27331 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
27332 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
27333 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
27334 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
27335 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
27336 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
27337
27338 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
27339 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
27340 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
27341 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
27342 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
27343 process normally.
27344
27345 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
27346 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
27347 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
27348 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
27349 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
27350 should process normally.
27351
27352 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
27353 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
27354 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
27355 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
27356 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
27357
27358 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
27359 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
27360 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
27361 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
27362 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
27363 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
27364 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
27365 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
27366 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
27367 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
27368 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
27369 @samp{OK}.
27370
27371 @node Packet Acknowledgment
27372 @section Packet Acknowledgment
27373
27374 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
27375 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
27376 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
27377 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
27378 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
27379 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
27380 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
27381
27382 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
27383 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
27384 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
27385 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
27386 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
27387
27388 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
27389 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
27390 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
27391 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
27392
27393 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
27394 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
27395 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
27396 @pxref{qSupported}.
27397 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
27398 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
27399 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
27400 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
27401 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
27402 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
27403 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
27404
27405 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
27406 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
27407 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
27408 connection.
27409 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
27410 new connection is established,
27411 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
27412 for the current connection, once disabled.
27413
27414 @node Examples
27415 @section Examples
27416
27417 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
27418 does not get any direct output:
27419
27420 @smallexample
27421 -> @code{R00}
27422 <- @code{+}
27423 @emph{target restarts}
27424 -> @code{?}
27425 <- @code{+}
27426 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
27427 -> @code{+}
27428 @end smallexample
27429
27430 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
27431
27432 @smallexample
27433 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
27434 <- @code{+}
27435 -> @code{s}
27436 <- @code{+}
27437 @emph{time passes}
27438 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
27439 -> @code{+}
27440 -> @code{g}
27441 <- @code{+}
27442 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
27443 -> @code{+}
27444 @end smallexample
27445
27446 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
27447 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
27448 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
27449
27450 @menu
27451 * File-I/O Overview::
27452 * Protocol Basics::
27453 * The F Request Packet::
27454 * The F Reply Packet::
27455 * The Ctrl-C Message::
27456 * Console I/O::
27457 * List of Supported Calls::
27458 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
27459 * Constants::
27460 * File-I/O Examples::
27461 @end menu
27462
27463 @node File-I/O Overview
27464 @subsection File-I/O Overview
27465 @cindex file-i/o overview
27466
27467 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
27468 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
27469 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
27470 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
27471 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
27472 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
27473
27474 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
27475 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
27476 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
27477 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
27478 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
27479
27480 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
27481 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
27482 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
27483 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
27484 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
27485 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
27486 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
27487
27488 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
27489 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
27490 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
27491 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
27492 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
27493
27494 @smallexample
27495 (@value{GDBP}) continue
27496 <- target requests 'system call X'
27497 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
27498 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
27499 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
27500 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
27501 @end smallexample
27502
27503 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
27504 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
27505 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
27506 system are not supported by this protocol.
27507
27508 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
27509
27510 @node Protocol Basics
27511 @subsection Protocol Basics
27512 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
27513
27514 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
27515 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
27516 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
27517 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
27518 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
27519 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
27520 to call the appropriate host system call:
27521
27522 @itemize @bullet
27523 @item
27524 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
27525
27526 @item
27527 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
27528 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
27529 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
27530 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
27531
27532 @end itemize
27533
27534 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
27535
27536 @itemize @bullet
27537 @item
27538 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
27539 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
27540 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
27541 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
27542 packet.
27543
27544 @item
27545 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
27546 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
27547
27548 @item
27549 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
27550
27551 @item
27552 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
27553
27554 @item
27555 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
27556 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
27557 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
27558 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
27559 packet.
27560
27561 @end itemize
27562
27563 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
27564 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
27565
27566 @itemize @bullet
27567 @item
27568 Return value.
27569
27570 @item
27571 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
27572
27573 @item
27574 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
27575
27576 @end itemize
27577
27578 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
27579 the latest continue or step action.
27580
27581 @node The F Request Packet
27582 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
27583 @cindex file-i/o request packet
27584 @cindex @code{F} request packet
27585
27586 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
27587
27588 @table @samp
27589 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
27590
27591 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
27592 This is just the name of the function.
27593
27594 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
27595 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
27596 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
27597 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
27598 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
27599 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
27600 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
27601
27602 @end table
27603
27604
27605
27606 @node The F Reply Packet
27607 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
27608 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
27609 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
27610
27611 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
27612
27613 @table @samp
27614
27615 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
27616
27617 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
27618
27619 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
27620 representation.
27621 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
27622
27623 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
27624 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
27625 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
27626
27627 @smallexample
27628 F0,0,C
27629 @end smallexample
27630
27631 @noindent
27632 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
27633
27634 @smallexample
27635 F-1,4,C
27636 @end smallexample
27637
27638 @noindent
27639 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
27640
27641 @end table
27642
27643
27644 @node The Ctrl-C Message
27645 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
27646 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
27647
27648 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
27649 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
27650 the target should behave as if it had
27651 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
27652 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
27653 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
27654 packet.
27655
27656 It's important for the target to know in which
27657 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
27658
27659 @itemize @bullet
27660 @item
27661 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
27662
27663 @item
27664 The system call on the host has been finished.
27665
27666 @end itemize
27667
27668 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
27669 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
27670 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
27671 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
27672 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
27673 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
27674
27675 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
27676 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
27677 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
27678 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
27679 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
27680 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
27681 or the full action has been completed.
27682
27683 @node Console I/O
27684 @subsection Console I/O
27685 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
27686
27687 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
27688 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
27689 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
27690 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
27691 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
27692 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
27693 conditions is met:
27694
27695 @itemize @bullet
27696 @item
27697 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
27698 @code{read}
27699 system call is treated as finished.
27700
27701 @item
27702 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
27703 newline.
27704
27705 @item
27706 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
27707 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
27708
27709 @end itemize
27710
27711 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
27712 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
27713 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
27714 is stopped at the user's request.
27715
27716
27717 @node List of Supported Calls
27718 @subsection List of Supported Calls
27719 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
27720
27721 @menu
27722 * open::
27723 * close::
27724 * read::
27725 * write::
27726 * lseek::
27727 * rename::
27728 * unlink::
27729 * stat/fstat::
27730 * gettimeofday::
27731 * isatty::
27732 * system::
27733 @end menu
27734
27735 @node open
27736 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
27737 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
27738
27739 @table @asis
27740 @item Synopsis:
27741 @smallexample
27742 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
27743 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
27744 @end smallexample
27745
27746 @item Request:
27747 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
27748
27749 @noindent
27750 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
27751
27752 @table @code
27753 @item O_CREAT
27754 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
27755 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
27756 are concerned.
27757
27758 @item O_EXCL
27759 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
27760 an error and open() fails.
27761
27762 @item O_TRUNC
27763 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
27764 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
27765 truncated to zero length.
27766
27767 @item O_APPEND
27768 The file is opened in append mode.
27769
27770 @item O_RDONLY
27771 The file is opened for reading only.
27772
27773 @item O_WRONLY
27774 The file is opened for writing only.
27775
27776 @item O_RDWR
27777 The file is opened for reading and writing.
27778 @end table
27779
27780 @noindent
27781 Other bits are silently ignored.
27782
27783
27784 @noindent
27785 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
27786
27787 @table @code
27788 @item S_IRUSR
27789 User has read permission.
27790
27791 @item S_IWUSR
27792 User has write permission.
27793
27794 @item S_IRGRP
27795 Group has read permission.
27796
27797 @item S_IWGRP
27798 Group has write permission.
27799
27800 @item S_IROTH
27801 Others have read permission.
27802
27803 @item S_IWOTH
27804 Others have write permission.
27805 @end table
27806
27807 @noindent
27808 Other bits are silently ignored.
27809
27810
27811 @item Return value:
27812 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
27813 occurred.
27814
27815 @item Errors:
27816
27817 @table @code
27818 @item EEXIST
27819 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
27820
27821 @item EISDIR
27822 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
27823
27824 @item EACCES
27825 The requested access is not allowed.
27826
27827 @item ENAMETOOLONG
27828 @var{pathname} was too long.
27829
27830 @item ENOENT
27831 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
27832
27833 @item ENODEV
27834 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
27835
27836 @item EROFS
27837 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
27838 write access was requested.
27839
27840 @item EFAULT
27841 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
27842
27843 @item ENOSPC
27844 No space on device to create the file.
27845
27846 @item EMFILE
27847 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
27848
27849 @item ENFILE
27850 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
27851 has been reached.
27852
27853 @item EINTR
27854 The call was interrupted by the user.
27855 @end table
27856
27857 @end table
27858
27859 @node close
27860 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
27861 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
27862
27863 @table @asis
27864 @item Synopsis:
27865 @smallexample
27866 int close(int fd);
27867 @end smallexample
27868
27869 @item Request:
27870 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
27871
27872 @item Return value:
27873 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
27874
27875 @item Errors:
27876
27877 @table @code
27878 @item EBADF
27879 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
27880
27881 @item EINTR
27882 The call was interrupted by the user.
27883 @end table
27884
27885 @end table
27886
27887 @node read
27888 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
27889 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
27890
27891 @table @asis
27892 @item Synopsis:
27893 @smallexample
27894 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
27895 @end smallexample
27896
27897 @item Request:
27898 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
27899
27900 @item Return value:
27901 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
27902 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
27903 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
27904
27905 @item Errors:
27906
27907 @table @code
27908 @item EBADF
27909 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
27910 reading.
27911
27912 @item EFAULT
27913 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27914
27915 @item EINTR
27916 The call was interrupted by the user.
27917 @end table
27918
27919 @end table
27920
27921 @node write
27922 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
27923 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
27924
27925 @table @asis
27926 @item Synopsis:
27927 @smallexample
27928 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
27929 @end smallexample
27930
27931 @item Request:
27932 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
27933
27934 @item Return value:
27935 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
27936 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
27937 is returned.
27938
27939 @item Errors:
27940
27941 @table @code
27942 @item EBADF
27943 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
27944 writing.
27945
27946 @item EFAULT
27947 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27948
27949 @item EFBIG
27950 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
27951 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
27952
27953 @item ENOSPC
27954 No space on device to write the data.
27955
27956 @item EINTR
27957 The call was interrupted by the user.
27958 @end table
27959
27960 @end table
27961
27962 @node lseek
27963 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
27964 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
27965
27966 @table @asis
27967 @item Synopsis:
27968 @smallexample
27969 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
27970 @end smallexample
27971
27972 @item Request:
27973 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
27974
27975 @var{flag} is one of:
27976
27977 @table @code
27978 @item SEEK_SET
27979 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
27980
27981 @item SEEK_CUR
27982 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
27983 bytes.
27984
27985 @item SEEK_END
27986 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
27987 bytes.
27988 @end table
27989
27990 @item Return value:
27991 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
27992 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
27993 value of -1 is returned.
27994
27995 @item Errors:
27996
27997 @table @code
27998 @item EBADF
27999 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
28000
28001 @item ESPIPE
28002 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
28003
28004 @item EINVAL
28005 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
28006
28007 @item EINTR
28008 The call was interrupted by the user.
28009 @end table
28010
28011 @end table
28012
28013 @node rename
28014 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
28015 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
28016
28017 @table @asis
28018 @item Synopsis:
28019 @smallexample
28020 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
28021 @end smallexample
28022
28023 @item Request:
28024 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
28025
28026 @item Return value:
28027 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28028
28029 @item Errors:
28030
28031 @table @code
28032 @item EISDIR
28033 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
28034 directory.
28035
28036 @item EEXIST
28037 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
28038
28039 @item EBUSY
28040 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
28041 process.
28042
28043 @item EINVAL
28044 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
28045 of itself.
28046
28047 @item ENOTDIR
28048 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
28049 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
28050 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
28051
28052 @item EFAULT
28053 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
28054
28055 @item EACCES
28056 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28057
28058 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28059
28060 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
28061
28062 @item ENOENT
28063 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
28064
28065 @item EROFS
28066 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28067
28068 @item ENOSPC
28069 The device containing the file has no room for the new
28070 directory entry.
28071
28072 @item EINTR
28073 The call was interrupted by the user.
28074 @end table
28075
28076 @end table
28077
28078 @node unlink
28079 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
28080 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
28081
28082 @table @asis
28083 @item Synopsis:
28084 @smallexample
28085 int unlink(const char *pathname);
28086 @end smallexample
28087
28088 @item Request:
28089 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
28090
28091 @item Return value:
28092 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28093
28094 @item Errors:
28095
28096 @table @code
28097 @item EACCES
28098 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28099
28100 @item EPERM
28101 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
28102
28103 @item EBUSY
28104 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
28105 being used by another process.
28106
28107 @item EFAULT
28108 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28109
28110 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28111 @var{pathname} was too long.
28112
28113 @item ENOENT
28114 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28115
28116 @item ENOTDIR
28117 A component of the path is not a directory.
28118
28119 @item EROFS
28120 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28121
28122 @item EINTR
28123 The call was interrupted by the user.
28124 @end table
28125
28126 @end table
28127
28128 @node stat/fstat
28129 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
28130 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
28131 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
28132
28133 @table @asis
28134 @item Synopsis:
28135 @smallexample
28136 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
28137 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
28138 @end smallexample
28139
28140 @item Request:
28141 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
28142 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
28143
28144 @item Return value:
28145 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28146
28147 @item Errors:
28148
28149 @table @code
28150 @item EBADF
28151 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
28152
28153 @item ENOENT
28154 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
28155 path is an empty string.
28156
28157 @item ENOTDIR
28158 A component of the path is not a directory.
28159
28160 @item EFAULT
28161 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28162
28163 @item EACCES
28164 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28165
28166 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28167 @var{pathname} was too long.
28168
28169 @item EINTR
28170 The call was interrupted by the user.
28171 @end table
28172
28173 @end table
28174
28175 @node gettimeofday
28176 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
28177 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
28178
28179 @table @asis
28180 @item Synopsis:
28181 @smallexample
28182 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
28183 @end smallexample
28184
28185 @item Request:
28186 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
28187
28188 @item Return value:
28189 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
28190
28191 @item Errors:
28192
28193 @table @code
28194 @item EINVAL
28195 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
28196
28197 @item EFAULT
28198 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28199 @end table
28200
28201 @end table
28202
28203 @node isatty
28204 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
28205 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
28206
28207 @table @asis
28208 @item Synopsis:
28209 @smallexample
28210 int isatty(int fd);
28211 @end smallexample
28212
28213 @item Request:
28214 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
28215
28216 @item Return value:
28217 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
28218
28219 @item Errors:
28220
28221 @table @code
28222 @item EINTR
28223 The call was interrupted by the user.
28224 @end table
28225
28226 @end table
28227
28228 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
28229 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
28230 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
28231 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
28232 needed.
28233
28234
28235 @node system
28236 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
28237 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
28238
28239 @table @asis
28240 @item Synopsis:
28241 @smallexample
28242 int system(const char *command);
28243 @end smallexample
28244
28245 @item Request:
28246 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
28247
28248 @item Return value:
28249 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
28250 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
28251 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
28252 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
28253 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
28254 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
28255 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
28256
28257 @item Errors:
28258
28259 @table @code
28260 @item EINTR
28261 The call was interrupted by the user.
28262 @end table
28263
28264 @end table
28265
28266 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
28267 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
28268 the host is simplified before it's returned
28269 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
28270 is discarded, and the return value consists
28271 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
28272
28273 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
28274 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
28275 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
28276
28277 @table @code
28278 @item set remote system-call-allowed
28279 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
28280 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
28281 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
28282
28283 @item show remote system-call-allowed
28284 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
28285 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
28286 protocol.
28287 @end table
28288
28289 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
28290 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
28291 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
28292
28293 @menu
28294 * Integral Datatypes::
28295 * Pointer Values::
28296 * Memory Transfer::
28297 * struct stat::
28298 * struct timeval::
28299 @end menu
28300
28301 @node Integral Datatypes
28302 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
28303 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
28304
28305 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
28306 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
28307 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
28308
28309 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
28310 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
28311
28312 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
28313
28314 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
28315 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
28316
28317 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
28318
28319 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
28320 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
28321 byte order.
28322
28323 @node Pointer Values
28324 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
28325 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
28326
28327 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
28328 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
28329 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
28330 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
28331
28332 @smallexample
28333 @code{1aaf/12}
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 @noindent
28337 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
28338 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
28339 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
28340 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
28341
28342 @smallexample
28343 @code{123456/d}
28344 @end smallexample
28345
28346 @node Memory Transfer
28347 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
28348 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
28349
28350 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
28351 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
28352 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
28353 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
28354 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
28355 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
28356 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
28357
28358
28359 @node struct stat
28360 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
28361 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
28362
28363 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
28364 is defined as follows:
28365
28366 @smallexample
28367 struct stat @{
28368 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
28369 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
28370 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
28371 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
28372 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
28373 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
28374 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
28375 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
28376 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
28377 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
28378 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
28379 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
28380 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
28381 @};
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
28385 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
28386 structure is of size 64 bytes.
28387
28388 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
28389 range of values.
28390
28391 @table @code
28392
28393 @item st_dev
28394 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
28395
28396 @item st_ino
28397 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
28398
28399 @item st_mode
28400 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
28401 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
28402
28403 @item st_uid
28404 @itemx st_gid
28405 @itemx st_rdev
28406 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
28407
28408 @item st_atime
28409 @itemx st_mtime
28410 @itemx st_ctime
28411 These values have a host and file system dependent
28412 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
28413 support exact timing values.
28414 @end table
28415
28416 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
28417 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
28418 continuing.
28419
28420 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
28421 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
28422 get truncated on the target.
28423
28424 @node struct timeval
28425 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
28426 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
28427
28428 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
28429 is defined as follows:
28430
28431 @smallexample
28432 struct timeval @{
28433 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
28434 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
28435 @};
28436 @end smallexample
28437
28438 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
28439 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
28440 structure is of size 8 bytes.
28441
28442 @node Constants
28443 @subsection Constants
28444 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
28445
28446 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
28447 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
28448 values before and after the call as needed.
28449
28450 @menu
28451 * Open Flags::
28452 * mode_t Values::
28453 * Errno Values::
28454 * Lseek Flags::
28455 * Limits::
28456 @end menu
28457
28458 @node Open Flags
28459 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
28460 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
28461
28462 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
28463
28464 @smallexample
28465 O_RDONLY 0x0
28466 O_WRONLY 0x1
28467 O_RDWR 0x2
28468 O_APPEND 0x8
28469 O_CREAT 0x200
28470 O_TRUNC 0x400
28471 O_EXCL 0x800
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 @node mode_t Values
28475 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
28476 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
28477
28478 All values are given in octal representation.
28479
28480 @smallexample
28481 S_IFREG 0100000
28482 S_IFDIR 040000
28483 S_IRUSR 0400
28484 S_IWUSR 0200
28485 S_IXUSR 0100
28486 S_IRGRP 040
28487 S_IWGRP 020
28488 S_IXGRP 010
28489 S_IROTH 04
28490 S_IWOTH 02
28491 S_IXOTH 01
28492 @end smallexample
28493
28494 @node Errno Values
28495 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
28496 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
28497
28498 All values are given in decimal representation.
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 EPERM 1
28502 ENOENT 2
28503 EINTR 4
28504 EBADF 9
28505 EACCES 13
28506 EFAULT 14
28507 EBUSY 16
28508 EEXIST 17
28509 ENODEV 19
28510 ENOTDIR 20
28511 EISDIR 21
28512 EINVAL 22
28513 ENFILE 23
28514 EMFILE 24
28515 EFBIG 27
28516 ENOSPC 28
28517 ESPIPE 29
28518 EROFS 30
28519 ENAMETOOLONG 91
28520 EUNKNOWN 9999
28521 @end smallexample
28522
28523 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
28524 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
28525
28526 @node Lseek Flags
28527 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
28528 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
28529
28530 @smallexample
28531 SEEK_SET 0
28532 SEEK_CUR 1
28533 SEEK_END 2
28534 @end smallexample
28535
28536 @node Limits
28537 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
28538 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
28539
28540 All values are given in decimal representation.
28541
28542 @smallexample
28543 INT_MIN -2147483648
28544 INT_MAX 2147483647
28545 UINT_MAX 4294967295
28546 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
28547 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
28548 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
28549 @end smallexample
28550
28551 @node File-I/O Examples
28552 @subsection File-I/O Examples
28553 @cindex file-i/o examples
28554
28555 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
28556 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
28557
28558 @smallexample
28559 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
28560 @emph{request memory read from target}
28561 -> @code{m1234,6}
28562 <- XXXXXX
28563 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
28564 -> @code{F6}
28565 @end smallexample
28566
28567 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
28568 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
28569
28570 @smallexample
28571 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28572 @emph{request memory write to target}
28573 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
28574 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
28575 -> @code{F6}
28576 @end smallexample
28577
28578 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
28579 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
28580
28581 @smallexample
28582 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28583 -> @code{F-1,9}
28584 @end smallexample
28585
28586 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
28587 host is called:
28588
28589 @smallexample
28590 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28591 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
28592 <- @code{T02}
28593 @end smallexample
28594
28595 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
28596 host is called:
28597
28598 @smallexample
28599 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28600 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
28601 <- @code{T02}
28602 @end smallexample
28603
28604 @node Library List Format
28605 @section Library List Format
28606 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
28607
28608 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
28609 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
28610 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
28611 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
28612 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
28613 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
28614 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
28615 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
28616 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
28617 are loaded.
28618
28619 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
28620 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
28621 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
28622 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
28623
28624 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
28625 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
28626 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
28627 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
28628 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
28629 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
28630
28631 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
28632 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
28633
28634 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
28635 offset, looks like this:
28636
28637 @smallexample
28638 <library-list>
28639 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
28640 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
28641 </library>
28642 </library-list>
28643 @end smallexample
28644
28645 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
28646 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
28647
28648 @smallexample
28649 <library-list>
28650 <library name="sharedlib.o">
28651 <section address="0x10000000"/>
28652 <section address="0x20000000"/>
28653 <section address="0x30000000"/>
28654 </library>
28655 </library-list>
28656 @end smallexample
28657
28658 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
28659
28660 @smallexample
28661 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
28662 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
28663 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
28664 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
28665 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
28666 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
28667 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
28668 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
28669 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
28670 @end smallexample
28671
28672 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
28673 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
28674 section for each library.
28675
28676 @node Memory Map Format
28677 @section Memory Map Format
28678 @cindex memory map format
28679
28680 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
28681 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
28682 memory map.
28683
28684 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
28685 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
28686 lists memory regions.
28687
28688 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
28689 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
28690
28691 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
28692
28693 @smallexample
28694 <?xml version="1.0"?>
28695 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
28696 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
28697 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
28698 <memory-map>
28699 region...
28700 </memory-map>
28701 @end smallexample
28702
28703 Each region can be either:
28704
28705 @itemize
28706
28707 @item
28708 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
28709 bytes from there:
28710
28711 @smallexample
28712 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
28713 @end smallexample
28714
28715
28716 @item
28717 A region of read-only memory:
28718
28719 @smallexample
28720 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
28721 @end smallexample
28722
28723
28724 @item
28725 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
28726 bytes in length:
28727
28728 @smallexample
28729 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
28730 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
28731 </memory>
28732 @end smallexample
28733
28734 @end itemize
28735
28736 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
28737 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
28738 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
28739
28740 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
28741
28742 @smallexample
28743 <!-- ................................................... -->
28744 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
28745 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
28746 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
28747 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
28748 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
28749 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
28750 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
28751 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
28752 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
28753 and its type, or device. -->
28754 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
28755 start CDATA #REQUIRED
28756 length CDATA #REQUIRED
28757 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
28758 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
28759 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
28760 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
28761 @end smallexample
28762
28763 @include agentexpr.texi
28764
28765 @node Target Descriptions
28766 @appendix Target Descriptions
28767 @cindex target descriptions
28768
28769 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
28770 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
28771 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
28772
28773 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
28774 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
28775 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
28776 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
28777 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
28778 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
28779 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
28780
28781 @itemize @bullet
28782 @item
28783 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
28784 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
28785 @item
28786 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
28787 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
28788 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
28789 @item
28790 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
28791 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
28792 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
28793 @end itemize
28794
28795 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
28796 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
28797 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
28798 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
28799 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
28800
28801 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
28802 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
28803
28804 @menu
28805 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
28806 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
28807 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
28808 descriptions.
28809 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
28810 @end menu
28811
28812 @node Retrieving Descriptions
28813 @section Retrieving Descriptions
28814
28815 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
28816 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
28817 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
28818 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
28819 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
28820 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
28821 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
28822 Format}.
28823
28824 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
28825 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
28826 specify a file are:
28827
28828 @table @code
28829 @cindex set tdesc filename
28830 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
28831 Read the target description from @var{path}.
28832
28833 @cindex unset tdesc filename
28834 @item unset tdesc filename
28835 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
28836 will use the description supplied by the current target.
28837
28838 @cindex show tdesc filename
28839 @item show tdesc filename
28840 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
28841 @end table
28842
28843
28844 @node Target Description Format
28845 @section Target Description Format
28846 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
28847
28848 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
28849 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
28850 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
28851 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
28852 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
28853 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
28854 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
28855
28856 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
28857 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
28858 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
28859 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
28860
28861 Here is a simple target description:
28862
28863 @smallexample
28864 <target version="1.0">
28865 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
28866 </target>
28867 @end smallexample
28868
28869 @noindent
28870 This minimal description only says that the target uses
28871 the x86-64 architecture.
28872
28873 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
28874 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
28875 are explained further below.
28876
28877 @smallexample
28878 <?xml version="1.0"?>
28879 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
28880 <target version="1.0">
28881 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
28882 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
28883 </target>
28884 @end smallexample
28885
28886 @noindent
28887 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
28888 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
28889 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
28890 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
28891 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
28892 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
28893 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
28894 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
28895 the version mismatch.
28896
28897 @subsection Inclusion
28898 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
28899 @cindex XInclude
28900 @ifnotinfo
28901 @cindex <xi:include>
28902 @end ifnotinfo
28903
28904 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
28905 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
28906 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
28907 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
28908 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
28909
28910 @smallexample
28911 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
28912 @end smallexample
28913
28914 @noindent
28915 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
28916 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
28917 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
28918 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
28919 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
28920 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
28921 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
28922 original description.
28923
28924 @subsection Architecture
28925 @cindex <architecture>
28926
28927 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
28928
28929 @smallexample
28930 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
28931 @end smallexample
28932
28933 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
28934 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
28935 Debugging Target}).
28936
28937 @subsection Features
28938 @cindex <feature>
28939
28940 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
28941 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
28942 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
28943 has this form:
28944
28945 @smallexample
28946 <feature name="@var{name}">
28947 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
28948 @var{reg}@dots{}
28949 </feature>
28950 @end smallexample
28951
28952 @noindent
28953 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
28954 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
28955 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
28956 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
28957
28958 @subsection Types
28959
28960 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
28961 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
28962 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
28963 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
28964 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
28965
28966 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
28967 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
28968 Types must be defined before they are used.
28969
28970 @cindex <vector>
28971 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
28972 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
28973 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
28974 @var{count}:
28975
28976 @smallexample
28977 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
28978 @end smallexample
28979
28980 @cindex <union>
28981 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
28982 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
28983 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
28984 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
28985
28986 @smallexample
28987 <union id="@var{id}">
28988 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
28989 @dots{}
28990 </union>
28991 @end smallexample
28992
28993 @subsection Registers
28994 @cindex <reg>
28995
28996 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
28997
28998 @smallexample
28999 <reg name="@var{name}"
29000 bitsize="@var{size}"
29001 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
29002 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
29003 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
29004 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
29005 @end smallexample
29006
29007 @noindent
29008 The components are as follows:
29009
29010 @table @var
29011
29012 @item name
29013 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
29014
29015 @item bitsize
29016 The register's size, in bits.
29017
29018 @item regnum
29019 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
29020 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
29021 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
29022 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
29023 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
29024 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
29025 in order of increasing register number.
29026
29027 @item save-restore
29028 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
29029 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
29030 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
29031 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
29032 ABI.
29033
29034 @item type
29035 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
29036 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
29037 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
29038 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
29039 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
29040 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
29041
29042 @item group
29043 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
29044 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
29045 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
29046 in @code{info registers}.
29047
29048 @end table
29049
29050 @node Predefined Target Types
29051 @section Predefined Target Types
29052 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
29053
29054 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
29055 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
29056 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
29057 types. The currently supported types are:
29058
29059 @table @code
29060
29061 @item int8
29062 @itemx int16
29063 @itemx int32
29064 @itemx int64
29065 @itemx int128
29066 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29067
29068 @item uint8
29069 @itemx uint16
29070 @itemx uint32
29071 @itemx uint64
29072 @itemx uint128
29073 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29074
29075 @item code_ptr
29076 @itemx data_ptr
29077 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
29078 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
29079 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
29080 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
29081 may be marked as data pointers.
29082
29083 @item ieee_single
29084 Single precision IEEE floating point.
29085
29086 @item ieee_double
29087 Double precision IEEE floating point.
29088
29089 @item arm_fpa_ext
29090 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
29091
29092 @end table
29093
29094 @node Standard Target Features
29095 @section Standard Target Features
29096 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
29097
29098 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
29099 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
29100 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
29101 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
29102 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
29103 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
29104 can recognize them.
29105
29106 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
29107 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
29108 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
29109 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
29110 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
29111 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
29112 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
29113 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
29114
29115 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
29116 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
29117 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
29118
29119 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
29120 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
29121 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
29122 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
29123
29124 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
29125 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
29126 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
29127
29128 @menu
29129 * ARM Features::
29130 * MIPS Features::
29131 * M68K Features::
29132 * PowerPC Features::
29133 @end menu
29134
29135
29136 @node ARM Features
29137 @subsection ARM Features
29138 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
29139
29140 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
29141 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
29142 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
29143
29144 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
29145 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
29146
29147 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
29148 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
29149 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
29150 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
29151
29152 @node MIPS Features
29153 @subsection MIPS Features
29154 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
29155
29156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
29157 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
29158 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
29159 on the target.
29160
29161 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
29162 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
29163 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29164
29165 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
29166 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
29167 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
29168 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29169
29170 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
29171 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
29172 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
29173
29174 @node M68K Features
29175 @subsection M68K Features
29176 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
29177
29178 @table @code
29179 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
29180 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
29181 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
29182 One of those features must be always present.
29183 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
29184 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
29185 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
29186 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
29187
29188 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
29189 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
29190 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
29191 @samp{fpiaddr}.
29192 @end table
29193
29194 @node PowerPC Features
29195 @subsection PowerPC Features
29196 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
29197
29198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
29199 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
29200 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
29201 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29202
29203 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
29204 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
29205
29206 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
29207 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
29208 and @samp{vrsave}.
29209
29210 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
29211 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
29212 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
29213 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
29214 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
29215 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
29216
29217 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
29218 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
29219 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
29220 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
29221 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
29222 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
29223 user.
29224
29225 @node Operating System Information
29226 @appendix Operating System Information
29227 @cindex operating system information
29228
29229 @menu
29230 * Process list::
29231 @end menu
29232
29233 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
29234 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
29235 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
29236 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
29237 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
29238 on a different aspect of target.
29239
29240 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
29241 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
29242 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
29243 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
29244
29245 @node Process list
29246 @appendixsection Process list
29247 @cindex operating system information, process list
29248
29249 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
29250 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
29251 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
29252 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
29253
29254 An example document is:
29255
29256 @smallexample
29257 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29258 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
29259 <osdata type="processes">
29260 <item>
29261 <column name="pid">1</column>
29262 <column name="user">root</column>
29263 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
29264 </item>
29265 </osdata>
29266 @end smallexample
29267
29268 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
29269 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
29270 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
29271 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
29272 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
29273
29274 @include gpl.texi
29275
29276 @raisesections
29277 @include fdl.texi
29278 @lowersections
29279
29280 @node Index
29281 @unnumbered Index
29282
29283 @printindex cp
29284
29285 @tex
29286 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
29287 % meantime:
29288 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
29289 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
29290 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
29291 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
29292 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
29293 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
29294 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
29295 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
29296 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
29297 \page\colophon
29298 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
29299 @end tex
29300
29301 @bye
This page took 0.782671 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.